kia, the company · kia, the company thank you for ... central door lock switch ... 2-3 interior...

370
kia, the company Thank you for becoming the owner of a new Kia vehicle. As a global car manufacturer focused on building high-quality, value for money prices, Kia Motors is dedicated to providing you with a customer service experience that exceeds your expectations. All information contained in this Owner’s Manual is accurate at the time of publication. However, Kia reserves the right to make changes at any time so that our policy of continual product improvement can be carried out. This manual applies to all Kia models and includes descriptions and explanations of optional as well as standard equipment. As a result, you may encounter material in this manual that is not applicable to your specific Kia vehicle. Drive safely and enjoy your Kia!

Upload: ngonhi

Post on 18-May-2019

223 views

Category:

Documents


0 download

TRANSCRIPT

kia, the company

Thank you for becoming the owner of a new Kia vehicle.As a global car manufacturer focused on building high-quality, valuefor money prices, Kia Motors is dedicated to providing you with acustomer service experience that exceeds your expectations.

All information contained in this Owner’s Manual is accurate at thetime of publication. However, Kia reserves the right to make changesat any time so that our policy of continual product improvement canbe carried out.

This manual applies to all Kia models and includes descriptions andexplanations of optional as well as standard equipment. As a result,you may encounter material in this manual that is not applicable toyour specific Kia vehicle.

Drive safely and enjoy your Kia!

i

Thank you for choosing a Kia vehicle.When you require service, remember that your dealer knowsyour vehicle best. Your dealer has factory-trained technicians,recommended special tools, genuine Kia replacement parts andis dedicated to your complete satisfaction.Because subsequent owners require this important informationas well, this publication should remain with the vehicle if it issold.This manual will familiarize you with operational, mainte-nance and safety information about your new vehicle. It is sup-plemented by a Warranty and Consumer Information manualthat provides important information on all warranties regardingyour vehicle.We urge you to read these publications carefully and follow therecommendations to help assure enjoyable and safe operationof your new vehicle.Kia offers a great variety of options, components and featuresfor its various models.Therefore, the equipment described in this manual, along withthe various illustrations, may not all be applicable to your par-ticular vehicle.

The information and specifications provided in this manualwere accurate at the time of printing. Kia reserves the right todiscontinue or change specifications or design at any timewithout notice and without incurring any obligation. If youhave questions, always check with your Kia Dealer.We assure you of our continuing interest in your motoringpleasure and satisfaction in your Kia vehicle.

© 2011 Kia Canada Inc.All rights reserved. Reproduction by any means, electronic ormechanical, including photocopying, recording, or by anyinformation storage and retrieval system or translation inwhole or part is not permitted without written authorizationfrom Kia Canada Inc..Printed in Korea

Foreword

ii

1

2

3

4

5

6

7

I

Introduction

Your vehicle at a glance

Features of your vehicle

Driving your vehicle

What to do in an emergency

Maintenance

Specifications

Index

table of contents

IIndex

Index

2I

Air bags···········································································3-81Air bag collision sensors ..........................................3-94Air bag warning label..............................................3-103Air bag warning light ..............................................3-101Curtain air bag ..........................................................3-93Driver's air bag ..........................................................3-91Front passenger’s air bag ..........................................3-92Side air bag................................................................3-92

Air cleaner·······································································6-16Alarm system ····································································3-7Antenna ·········································································3-191Anti-lock brake system (ABS)········································4-17Appearance care······························································6-46

Exterior care ······························································6-46Interior care ·······························································6-48

Armrest ··································································3-44, 3-47Ashtray··········································································3-186Audio remote control ····················································3-192Audio system ································································3-193Automatic climate control system ································3-156

Air conditioning ······················································3-163Instrument panel vents ············································3-163Outlet port locations················································3-161Rear climate control ················································3-164

Automatic transaxle ··························································4-5Shift lock system·························································4-9Sports mode·································································4-8

Aux, USB and iPod port ···············································3-191

Battery·············································································6-30Battery saver function ···················································3-134Before driving ···································································4-2Bottle holders, see cup holders ·····································3-187Brake system···································································4-14

Anti-lock brake system (ABS)··································4-17Parking brake·····························································4-15Power brakes ·····························································4-14

Brakes ·············································································6-17Bulb wattage ·····································································7-2

Capacities (Lubricants) ·····················································7-4Central door lock switch·················································3-13Changing tires ···································································5-9Chains

Safety chains ·····························································4-30Checking tire inflation pressure······································6-34Child restraint system ·····················································3-74

Tether anchor system·················································3-76

A

B

C

I 3

Index

Child-protector rear door lock ·······································3-15Cigarette lighter ····························································3-185Climate control air filter ················································6-19Climate control system (Automatic) ···························3-156

Air conditioning ·····················································3-163Climate control system (Manual) ································3-144

Air conditioning ·····················································3-149Clock (Digital) ·····························································3-190Clothes hanger ······························································3-185Combined instrument, see instrument cluster ·············3-114Compact spare tire replacement ····································6-36Compass mirror, see the Electric chromic

mirror (ECM) ····························································3-108Coolant ···········································································6-14Cooling fluid, see engine coolant ··································6-14Cruise control system ····················································4-11Cup holder ···································································3-186Curtain air bag ·······························································3-93

Dashboard, see instrument cluster ·······························3-114Dashboard illumination, see instrument

panel illumination ·····················································3-118Defogging (Windshield) ··············································3-170Defogging logic (Windshield) ·····································3-172Defroster ······································································3-142Defrosting (Windshield) ··············································3-170

Digital clock ·································································3-190Dimensions ······································································7-2Displays, see instrument cluster ··································3-114Display illumination, see instrument

panel illumination ·····················································3-118Door locks·······································································3-11

Central door lock switch ··········································3-13Child-protector rear door lock ·································3-15

Drinks holders, see cup holders ···································3-187Driver position memory system ·····································3-59Driver's air bag ·······························································3-91Driving at night ······························································4-27Driving in flooded areas ················································4-27Driving in the rain ··························································4-27

Economical operation ····················································4-25Electronic stability control (ESC)···································4-19Electric chromic mirror (ECM) ···································3-108Emergency starting ··························································5-3

Jump starting ······························································5-3Push starting ·······························································5-5

Emergency towing ·························································5-15Emergency while driving ·················································5-2Emission control system ················································6-49Engine compartment ······················································6-12Engine coolant ·······························································6-14

D

E

Index

4I

Engine number ·······························································4-36Engine oil ·······································································6-13Engine overheats ······························································5-5Engine temperature gauge ···········································3-117Exterior care ···································································6-46

Flat tire ·············································································5-6Changing tires ····························································5-9Compact spare tire ·····················································5-8Jack and tools ·····························································5-6Jacking instructions ····················································5-9Removing the spare tire ·············································5-6Storing the spare tire ··················································5-7

Floor mat anchor(s) ·····················································3-190Fluid

Brakes fluid ······························································6-17Washer fluid ·····························································6-18

Folding the rear seat back···············································3-50Front seat adjustment - manual ······································3-39Front seat adjustment - power ·······································3-40Front passenger’s air bag ················································3-92Fuel filler lid ··································································3-30Fuel gauge ····································································3-117Fuel requirements ····························································1-2Fuses ··············································································6-22

Fuse/relay panel description ····································6-25Main fuse ··································································6-24

Gauges···········································································3-115EcominderTM indicator ·········································3-116Engine temperature gauge ······································3-117Fuel gauge ······························································3-117Instrument panel illumination ································3-118Odometer ································································3-115Speedometer ···························································3-115Tachometer ·····························································3-116Trip odometer ··························································3-116

Glove box ·····································································3-184

Hazard warning flasher ················································3-143Hazardous driving conditions ········································4-26Headrest ································································3-42, 3-48Homelink® wireless control system ······························3-175Homelink® wireless control system with rearview

display········································································3-179Hood ···············································································3-29Horn ·············································································3-142How to use this manual ···················································1-2

F

G

H

I 5

Index

Ignition switch ·································································4-3Immobilizer system ·························································3-9Indicators and warnings ···············································3-125Instrument cluster ························································3-114Instrument panel illumination ······································3-118Instrument panel overview ···············································2-3Interior care ····································································6-48Interior features ····························································3-185

Ashtray ···································································3-186Cigarette lighter ······················································3-185Clothes hanger·························································3-188Cup holder ······························································3-186Digital clock ···························································3-190Floor mat anchr(s) ··················································3-190Power outlet ···························································3-189Shopping bag holder ···············································3-187Sunvisor ··································································3-188

Interior lights ·······························································3-131Dome light ······························································3-132Door courtesy lamp ················································3-134Glove box lamp ······················································3-134Map light ································································3-131Tailgate light ·························································3-133

Interior overview ······························································2-2

Jack and tools ···································································5-6Jump starting ····································································5-3

Key positions ···································································4-3Keys ·················································································3-3

LabelAir bag warning label ·············································3-103Engine number ·························································4-36Tire specification / pressure label ····························4-36Vehicle certification label ·········································4-35Vehicle identification number ··································4-35

Label information ··························································4-35Lighting ········································································3-134

Battery saver function ············································3-134Daytime running light ············································3-138Front fog light ·························································3-137High - beam operation ············································3-136Lighting control·······················································3-135Rescue mode function·············································3-135

K

J

L

I

Index

6I

Lubricant ·········································································6-44Recommended lubricants ········································· 6-44Recommended SAE viscosity number ···················· 6-45

Lubricants and fluids ······················································6-18Luggage net holder ······················································3-173Luggage rack, see roof rack ·········································3-174Lumbar support ······························································3-46

Main fuse ·······································································6-24Maintenance

Maintenance schedule ·················································6-3Maintenance services ················································· 6-2Owner maintenance ··················································6-10Tire maintenance ······················································6-38

Maintenance schedule·······················································6-3Maintenance services ·······················································6-2Manual climate control system ····································3-144

Air conditioning ·····················································3-149Instrument panel······················································3-147Outlet port locations················································3-146Rear climate control ···············································3-150

Mirrors ·········································································3-106Compass ······················································3-111, 3-119Conversation mirror ················································3-113Day/night rearview mirror ·····································3-108Electric chromic mirror (ECM) ·····························3-108

Inside rearview mirror ············································3-108Outside rearview mirror ·········································3-107

Neck restraints, see headrest ································3-42, 3-48

Odometer ·····································································3-115Oil (Engine) ···································································6-13Outside rearview mirror ···············································3-106Overheats ·········································································5-5Overloading·····································································4-34Owner maintenance ·······················································6-10

Parking brake ·································································4-15Passenger's front air bag ················································3-92Power adjustable pedals··················································3-61Power brakes ··································································4-14Power outlet ·································································3-189Power sliding door and power tailgate ···························3-17Power steering ····················································3-104, 6-19Power steering fluid level ···············································6-19Power window lock switch ············································3-28Pre-tensioner safety belt ················································3-72

O

P

M

N

I 7

Index

Rear seat adjustment ·······················································3-46Rear seat entertainment system ····································3-227Rear parking assist system ·············································4-21Rearview camera ····························································4-24Recommended cold tire inflation pressures ··················6-32Recommended lubricants ···············································6-44Recommended SAE viscosity number ··························6-45Remote keyless entry ·······················································3-4Road warning ···································································5-2Rocking the vehicle ·······················································4-26Roof antena ···································································3-191Roof rack ·····································································3-174

Safety belts ·····································································3-62Pre-tensioner safety belt ···········································3-72Lap/shoulder belt ······················································3-65

Safety belt warning light and chime·······························3-64Scheduled maintenance service

Maintenance schedule ·················································6-3Seat warmer ···································································3-45Seatback pocket ·····························································3-44Seat ·················································································3-37

Armrest ···························································3-44, 3-47Headrest ··························································3-42, 3-48Folding the rear seatback ··········································3-50

Front seat adjustment - manual ································3-39Front seat adjustment - power ··································3-40Lumbar support ························································3-46Rear seat adjustment ·················································3-46Seatback pocket ························································3-44Seat warmer ······························································3-45

Shift lock system ·····························································4-9Shopping bag holder ·····················································3-187Side air bag ····································································3-92Sirius satellite radio information ·································3-211Snow tires ······································································4-28Spare tire

Compact spare tire replacement ·······························6-36Removing the spare tire ·············································5-6Storing the spare tire ··················································5-7

Special driving conditions ·············································4-26Driving at night ························································4-27Driving in flooded areas ···········································4-27Driving in the rain ····················································4-27Hazardous driving conditions ··································4-26Rocking the vehicle ··················································4-26

Speedometer ·································································3-115Sports mode ·····································································4-8Starting the engine ···························································4-4Steering wheel ·····························································3-104

Power steering ························································3-104Tilt steering ····························································3-105

Storage compartment ···················································3-183Glove box ·······························································3-184

R

S

Index

8I

Side table ·································································3-185Sunglass holder ······················································3-184

Sunroof············································································3-33Sunvisor ·······································································3-188

Tachometer ···································································3-116Tailgate ···········································································3-15Tether anchor system ·····················································3-76Theft-alarm system ··························································3-7Tilt steering ··································································3-105Tire specification / pressure label ··································4-36Tires ··················································································7-3Tires and wheels ····························································6-32

Checking tire inflation pressure ·······························6-34Compact spare tire replacement ·······························6-36Recommended cold tire inflation pressures ·············6-32Tire care ···································································6-32Tire maintenance ······················································6-38Tire replacement ·······················································6-36Tire rotation ······························································6-35Tire sidewall labeling ···············································6-38Tire traction ······························································6-38Wheel alignment and tire balance ····························6-37Wheel replacement ···················································6-37

Towing ···········································································5-15Tie-down hook (for flatbed towing) ·························5-18

Trailer towing ·································································4-28Safety chains ····························································4-30

TransaxleAutomatic transaxle ···················································4-5

Trip computer ······························································3-119

Vehicle break-in process ··················································1-3Vehicle certification label ··············································4-35Vehicle identification number (VIN) ·····························4-35

Washer fluid level ···························································6-18Waste tray, see ashtray ·················································3-186Warnings and indicators ··············································3-125Wheel alignment and tire balance ·································6-37Wheel replacement ························································6-37Windows ········································································3-26

Power window lock switch ······································3-28Windshield defrosting and defogging ··························3-170

Defogging logic ······················································3-172Winter driving ································································4-28

Snow tires ·································································4-28Wiper blades ··································································6-20Wipers and washers ·····················································3-138

TV

W

1How to use this manual / 1-2Fuel requirements / 1-2Vehicle break-in process / 1-3

Introduction

Introduction

21

We want to help you get the greatestpossible driving pleasure from your vehi-cle. Your Owner’s Manual can assist youin many ways. We strongly recommendthat you read the entire manual. In orderto minimize the chance of death or injury,you must read the WARNING and CAU-TION sections spread throughout themanual.Illustrations complement the words in thismanual to best explain how to enjoy yourvehicle. By reading your manual, youlearn about features, important safetyinformation, and driving tips under vari-ous road conditions.The general layout of the manual is pro-vided in the Table of Contents. A goodplace to start is the index; it has an alpha-betical listing of all information in yourmanual.Sections: This manual has seven sec-tions plus an index. Each section beginswith a brief list of contents so you can tellat a glance if that section has the infor-mation you want.

You’ll find various WARNING’s,CAUTION’s, and NOTICE’s in this manu-al. These were prepared to enhance yourpersonal safety.You should carefully readand follow ALL procedures and recom-mendations provided in theseWARNING’s, CAUTION’s and NOTICE’s.

✽✽ NOTICEA NOTICE indicates interesting or help-ful information is being provided.

Your new Kia vehicle is designed to useonly unleaded fuel with a minimumOctane Rating of 87 Anti-Knock Index(AKI).

HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL

WARNING A WARNING indicates a situation inwhich harm, serious bodily injury ordeath could result if the warning isignored.

CAUTIONA CAUTION indicates a situation inwhich damage to your vehicle couldresult if the caution is ignored.

CAUTIONNEVER USE LEADED FUEL. Theuse of leaded fuel is detrimental tothe catalytic converter and willdamage the engine control sys-tem’s oxygen sensor and affectemission control.Never add any fuel system cleaningagents to the fuel tank other thanwhat Kia has specified. (Consult anAuthorized Kia Dealer for details.)

FUEL REQUIREMENTS

1 3

Introduction

Gasoline containing alcohol andmethanolGasohol, a mixture of gasoline andethanol (also known as grain alcohol),and gasoline or gasohol containingmethanol (also known as wood alcohol)are being marketed along with or insteadof leaded or unleaded gasoline.Do not use gasohol containing more than10% ethanol, and do not use gasoline orgasohol containing any methanol. Eitherof these fuels may cause drivability prob-lems and damage to the fuel system.Discontinue using gasohol of any kind ifdrivability problems occur.

Vehicle damage or driveability problemsmay not be covered by the manufactur-er’s warranty if they result from the useof:1. Gasohol containing more than 10%

ethanol.2. Gasoline or gasohol containing

methanol.3. Leaded fuel or leaded gasohol.

No special break-in period is needed. Byfollowing a few simple precautions for thefirst 1,000 km (600 miles) you may add tothe performance, economy and life ofyour vehicle.• Do not race the engine.• Do not maintain a single speed for long

periods of time, either fast or slow.Varying engine speed is needed toproperly break-in the engine.

• Avoid hard stops, except in emergen-cies, to allow the brakes to seat prop-erly.

• Avoid full-throttle starts.

CAUTIONNever use gasohol which containsmethanol. Discontinue use of anygasohol product which impairs dri-vability.

VEHICLE BREAK-IN PROCESS

2Interior overview / 2-2Instrument panel overview / 2-3

Your vehicle at a glance

Your vehicle at a glance

22

INTERIOR OVERVIEW

OVQ020001N

1. Door lock/unlock button ....................3-13

2. Driver position memory system*.......3-59

3. Seat adjust knob*..............................3-40

4. Outside rearview mirror control switch .............................................3-107

5. Power rear quarter window switches*...........................................3-26

6. Power window switches ....................3-26

7. Central door lock switch....................3-13

8. Power window lock switch.................3-28

9. Fuel filler lid release button...............3-30

10. Instrument panel illumination* ......3-118

11. Room light main control switch.....3-131

12. Power adjustable pedal control switch*.............................................3-61

13. Steering wheel tilt .........................3-105

14. Parking brake release lever*...........4-16

15. Fuse box .........................................6-20

16. Hood release lever .........................3-29

17. Parking brake pedal ........................4-16

18. Brake pedal.....................................4-14

19. Accelerator pedal..............................4-7

20. Seat.................................................3-37

* : if equipped

2 3

Your vehicle at a glance

INSTRUMENT PANEL OVERVIEW

1. Driver’s airbag ................................3-912. Light control / Turn signals ...........3-1353. Instrument cluster.........................3-1144. Wiper/Washer...............................3-1385. Auto cruise control* ........................4-116. Audio controls* .............................3-1927. Steering wheel .............................3-1048. Ignition switch...................................4-39. Digital clock ..................................3-19010. Climate control system* .............3-14411. Hazard warning flasher switch ...3-14312. Seat warmer* ...............................3-4513. Shift lever .......................................4-514. Cigar lighter or Power outlet* .....3-18615. Power outlet................................3-19016. Ashtray* ......................................3-18617. Passenger’s airbag.......................3-9218. Vent controls...............................3-14719. Glove box ...................................3-18420. Sunglass holder* ........................3-18421. Sunvisor .....................................3-18922. Power sliding door and power

tailgate controls*...........................3-1723. Sunroof* .......................................3-3324. Conversation mirror....................3-11325. Trip computer* ............................3-11926. Day/night rearview mirror ...........3-108* : if equipped

OVQ029002N

3

Keys / 3-3Remote keyless entry / 3-4Theft-alarm system / 3-7Immobilizer system / 3-9Door locks / 3-11Power sliding door and power tailgate / 3-17Window / 3-26

Hood / 3-29Fuel filler lid / 3-30Sunroof / 3-33Seat / 3-37Driver position memory system / 3-59Power adjustable pedals / 3-61Safety belts / 3-62Child restraint system / 3-74Air bags-advanced restraint system / 3-81Steering wheel / 3-104Mirrors / 3-106Instrument cluster / 3-114Gauges / 3-115Trip computer / 3-119Warnings and indicators / 3-125

Features of your vehicle

Interior lights / 3-131Lighting / 3-134

Wipers and washers / 3-138Horn / 3-142

Defroster / 3-142Hazard warning flasher / 3-143

Manual climate control system / 3-144Automatic climate control system / 3-156

Windshield defrosting and defogging / 3-170Luggage net holder / 3-173

Roof rack / 3-174Homelink® wireless control system / 3-175

Homelink® Wireless control system withrearview display / 3-179

Storage compartment / 3-183Interior features / 3-185

Antenna / 3-191Audio remote control / 3-192

Audio system / 3-193Sirius satellite radio information / 3-211Rear seat entertainment system / 3-227

Features of your vehicle3

3 3

Features of your vehicle

The key code number is stamped on theplate attached to the key set. Should youlose your keys, this number will enablean authorized Kia Dealer to duplicate thekeys easily. Remove the plate and store itin a safe place. Also, record the codenumber and keep it in a safe and handyplace, but not in the vehicle.

Key operationsMaster keyUsed to start the engine, lock and unlockthe doors, lock and unlock the glove boxand center console storage (if equipped).

KEYS

WARNING - Ignition keyLeaving children unattended in avehicle with the ignition key is dan-gerous even if the key is not in theignition. Children copy adults andthey could place the key in the igni-tion. The ignition key would enablechildren to operate power windowsor other controls, or even make thevehicle move, which could result inserious bodily injury or even death.Never leave the keys in your vehiclewith unsupervised children.

1VQA2001

WARNINGUse only Kia original parts for theignition key in your vehicle. If anaftermarket key is used, the ignitionswitch may not return to ON afterSTART. If this happens, the starterwill continue to operate causingdamage to the starter motor andpossible fire due to excessive cur-rent in the wiring.

Features of your vehicle

43

(1) Lock ( )All doors are locked if the lock buttonis pressed.If all doors are closed, the hazardwarning lights blink once to indicatethat all doors are locked. However, ifany door remains open, the hazardwarning lights are not operated. Afterthis, if all door are closed, the hazardwarning lights blink.If the lock button is pressed oncemore whithin 4 seconds after lockingall door by pressing the lock button,the hazard warning lights and hornwill operate once to indicate that alldoors are locked.

(2) Unlock ( ) Driver's door is unlocked if the unlockbutton is pressed once.The hazard warning lights will blinktwice to indicate that the driver's dooris unlocked.All doors are unlocked if the unlockbutton is pressed twice within 3 sec-onds.The hazard warning lights will blinktwice again to indicate that all doorsare unlocked.

After depressing this button, thedoors will be locked automaticallyunless you open any door within 30seconds.

(3) Power tailgate opening or closing( , if equipped)The tailgate is opened or closedautomatically if the button is pressedand held.The hazard warning lights will blinkand the chime will sound 3 times toindicate that the tailgate will swingupward or downward.

(4) Left power sliding door opening orclosing ( , if equipped)The left sliding door is opened orclosed automatically if the button ispressed and held.

(5) Right power sliding door opening orclosing ( , if equipped)The right sliding door is opened orclosed automatically if the button ispressed and held.

REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY (IF EQUIPPED)

1VQA2002B

1VQA2002A

1VQA2002

Type B

Type A

Type C

3 5

Features of your vehicle

✽✽ NOTICEThe power sliding door and power tail-gate are not opened by pressing the cor-responding button on the transmitterdirectly when all power sliding doorsand power tailgate are locked andclosed. To open the power sliding dooror power tailgate from outside vehicle,press the unlock button twice within 3seconds first and press correspondingpower sliding door or power tailgateopening button.

(6) Alarm ( )The horn sounds and hazard warninglights flash for about 27 seconds ifthis button is pressed and held. Tostop the horn and lights, press anybutton on the transmitter.

✽✽ NOTICEThe transmitter will not work if any offollowing occur:• The ignition key is in ignition switch.• You exceed the operating distance

limit (about 30 m [90 feet]).• The battery in the transmitter is

weak.• Other vehicles or objects may be

blocking the signal.• The weather is extremely cold.• The transmitter is close to a radio

transmitter such as a radio station oran airport which can interfere withnormal operation of the transmitter.

When the transmitter does not workcorrectly, open and close the door withthe ignition key. If you have a problemwith the transmitter, contact an autho-rized Kia Dealer.

Operational distance may vary depend-ing upon the area the transmitter is usedin. For example, if the vehicle is parkednear police stations, government andpublic offices, broadcasting stations, mil-itary installations, airports, or transmit-ting towers, etc.

CAUTIONThe power doors can be operatedwhen the engine is not running.However, the power doors consumelarge amounts of vehicle electricpower. To prevent the battery frombeing discharged, do not operatethem consecutively (more thanapproximately 10 times).

CAUTIONKeep the transmitter away fromwater or any liquid. If the keylessentry system is inoperative due toexposure to water or liquids, it willnot be covered by your manufactur-er vehicle warranty.

Features of your vehicle

63

This device complies with IndustryCanada Standard RSS-210. Operationis subject to the following two conditions:1. This device may not cause interfer-

ence, and 2. This device must accept any interfer-

ence, including interference that maycause undesired operation of thedevice.

Battery replacementTransmitter uses a 3 volt lithium batterywhich will normally last for several years.When replacement is necessary, use thefollowing procedure.1. Insert a slim tool into the slot and gen-

tly pry open the transmitter centercover (1).

2. Replace the battery with new one.When replacing the battery, make surethe battery positive “+” symbol facesup as indicated in the illustration.

3. Install the battery in the reverse orderof removal.

For replacement transmitters, see anAuthorized Kia Dealer for reprogram-ming.

✽✽ NOTICEThe keyless entry system transmitter isdesigned to give you years of trouble-free use, however it can malfunction ifexposed to moisture or static electricity.If you are unsure how to use your trans-mitter or replace the battery, contact anauthorized Kia dealer.

CAUTION• Using the wrong battery can

cause the transmitter to malfunc-tion. Be sure to use the correctbattery.

• To avoid damaging the transmit-ter, don't drop it, get it wet, orexpose it to heat or sunlight.

WARNINGChanges or modifications notexpressly approved by the partyresponsible for compliance couldvoid the user's authority to operatethe equipment.

1VQA2003

CAUTIONAn inappropriately disposed bat-tery can be harmful to the environ-ment and human health.Dispose the battery according toyour local law(s) or regulation.

3 7

Features of your vehicle

This system is designed to provide pro-tection from unauthorized entry into thecar. This system is operated in threestages: the first is the "Armed" stage, thesecond is the "Theft-alarm" stage, andthe third is the "Disarmed" stage. If trig-gered, the system provides an audiblealarm with blinking of the hazard warninglights.

Armed stagePark the car and stop the engine. Armthe system as described below.1. Remove the ignition key from the igni-

tion switch.2. Make sure that all doors, the engine

hood and tailgate are closed andlatched.

3. Lock the doors using the transmitter ofthe keyless entry system.

After completion of the steps above, thehazard warning lights will blink once toindicate that the system is armed.

If any door, tailgate or engine hoodremains open, the hazard warning lightswon’t operate and theft-alarm will notarm. After this, if all doors, tailgate andengine hood are closed, the hazardwarning lights blink once.The system can be armed by locking thedoors with the key from the front doors ortailgate. However, the hazard warninglights are not operated.

• If any door, tailgate or engine hoodremains open, the system will notbe armed. If this happens, re-armthe system as described previous.

• Do not arm the system until all pas-sengers have left the vehicle. If thesystem is armed while a passen-ger(s) remains in the vehicle, thealarm may be activated when theremaining passenger(s) leave thevehicle. If any door, tailgate orengine hood is opened within 30seconds after entering the armedstage, the system is disarmed toprevent unnecessary alarm.

THEFT-ALARM SYSTEM (IF EQUIPPED)

Armedstage

Theft-alarmstage

Disarmedstage

Features of your vehicle

83

Theft-alarm stageThe alarm will be activated if any of thefollowing occurs while the system isarmed.• A front or rear door is opened without

using the ignition key or transmitter.• The tailgate is opened without using

the ignition key or transmitter.• The engine hood is opened.The siren will sound and the hazardwarning lights will blink continuously for27 seconds, and repeat the alarm 3times unless the system is disarmed. Toturn off the system, unlock the doors withthe ignition key or transmitter.

✽✽ NOTICEAvoid trying to start the engine whilethe alarm is activated. The vehicle start-ing motor is disabled during the theft-alarm stage.

Disarmed stageThe system will be disarmed when thedoors are unlocked by depressing theunlock button on the transmitter orunlocked with the ignition key.After depressing unlock button, the haz-ard warning lights will blink twice to indi-cate that the system is disarmed.After depressing unlock button, if anydoor is not opened within 30 seconds,the system will be rearmed.If the system is not disarmed with theignition key or transmitter, insert the keyin the ignition switch, turn the key to theON position and wait for 30 seconds.Then the system will be disarmed.

CAUTION Do not change, alter or adjust thetheft-alarm system because it couldcause the theft-alarm system tomalfunction and should only beserviced by an authorized Kia deal-er.Malfunctions caused by improperalterations, adjustments or modifi-cations to the theft-alarm systemare not covered by your vehiclemanufacturer warranty.

3 9

Features of your vehicle

Your vehicle is equipped with an elec-tronic engine immobilizer system toreduce the risk of unauthorized vehicleuse.Your immobilizer system is comprised ofa small transponder in the ignition key,and antenna coil in the key cylinder andImmobilizer Control Unit (or SmartraUnit).With this system, whenever you insertyour ignition key into the ignition switchand turn it to ON, the antenna coil in theignition switch receives a signal from thetransponder in the ignition key and thensends the signal to the ECU (EngineControl Unit).The ECU checks the signal whether theignition key is valid.If the key is determined to be valid, theengine will start.If the key is determined to be invalid, theengine will not start.

To deactivate the immobilizersystem:Insert the ignition key into the key cylin-der and turn it to the ON position.

To activate the immobilizer sys-tem:Turn the ignition key to the OFF position.The immobilizer system activates auto-matically. Without a valid ignition key foryour vehicle, the engine will not start.

✽✽ NOTICEWhen starting the engine, do not use thekey with other immobilizer keys around.Otherwise the engine may not start ormay stop soon after it starts. Keep eachkey separately not to have any malfunc-tion after you receive your new vehicle.

✽✽ NOTICEIf you need additional keys or lose yourkeys, consult your authorized Kia dealer.

Limp home (override) procedureWhen you turn the ignition key to the ONposition, if the IMMO indicator goes offafter blinking 5 times, your transponderequipped in the ignition key is out of order.You cannot start the engine without thelime home procedure. To start the engine,you have to input your password by usingthe ignition switch.The following procedure is how to inputyour password of “2345” as an example.1. Turn the ignition key to the ON position.

The IMMO indicator ( ) will blink 5times and go off indicating the begin-ning of the limp home procedure.

2. Turn the ignition key to the ACC posi-tion.

IMMOBILIZER SYSTEM (IF EQUIPPED)

CAUTION Do not put metal accessories nearthe key or ignition switch.The engine may not start for themetal accessories may interrupt thetransponder signal from normallytransmitting.

WARNINGIn order to prevent theft of yourvehicle, do not leave spare keysanywhere in your vehicle. YourImmobilizer password is a cus-tomer unique password and shouldbe kept confidential. Do not leavethis number anywhere in your vehi-cle.

Features of your vehicle

103

3. To enter the first digit (in this example“2”), turn the ignition key to the ON andACC position twice. Perform the sameprocedure for the next digits between 3seconds and 10 seconds (for example,for “3”, turn the ignition ON and ACC 3times).

4. If all of the digits have been input suc-cessfully, you have to start the enginewithin 30 seconds. If you attempt tostart the engine after 30 seconds, theengine will not start and you will haveto input your password again.

After performing the limp home proce-dure, you have to see an authorized Kiadealer immediately to inspect and repairyour ignition key or immobilizer system.

This device complies with IndustryCanada Standard RSS-210. Operationis subject to the following two conditions:1. This device may not cause interfer-

ence, and 2. This device must accept any interfer-

ence, including interference that maycause undesired operation of thedevice.

CAUTIONThe transponder in your ignitionkey is an important part of theimmobilizer system. It is designedto give years of trouble-free service,however you should avoid expo-sure to moisture, static electricityand rough handling. Immobilizersystem malfunction could occur.

CAUTIONDo not change, alter or adjust theimmobilizer system because itcould cause the immobilizer sys-tem to malfunction and should onlybe serviced by an authorized Kiadealer.Malfunctions caused by improperalterations, adjustments or modifi-cations to the immobilizer systemare not covered by your vehiclemanufacturer warranty.

WARNINGChanges or modifications notexpressly approved by the partyresponsible for compliance couldvoid the user's authority to operatethe equipment.

3 11

Features of your vehicle

Operating door locks from out-side the vehicle • Turn the key toward rear of vehicle to

unlock and toward front of vehicle tolock.

• Turn the key toward front of vehicle tolock all doors.

• Turn the key to the right once to unlockthe driver’s door and to the right twicewithin 3 seconds to unlock all doors.

• Turn the key to the left once to unlockthe passenger’s door and to the lefttwice within 3 seconds to unlock alldoors. (if equipped)

• Doors can also be locked and unlockedwith the transmitter key (if equipped).

• Once the doors are unlocked, it may beopened by pulling the door handle.

• When closing the door, push the doorby hand. Make sure that doors areclosed securely.

✽✽ NOTICEIn cold and wet climates, door lock anddoor mechanisms may not work proper-ly due to freezing conditions.

• Once the doors are unlocked, it may beopened by pulling the door handle andsliding the door towards the rear of thevehicle.

DOOR LOCKS

1VQA2004

LockUnlock

Front doors

1VQA2005

Rear sliding doors

WARNING• If you don't close the door

securely, the door may openagain.

• Be careful that someone's bodyand hands are not trapped whenclosing the door.

WARNINGWhen the rear sliding door is notfully open, it is not latched and maymove unintentionally. This couldresult in a serious injury.

Features of your vehicle

123

• When the door is fully open, the doorwill lock into an open position. To closethe door, pull out the door handle (1)and sliding the door (2) towards thefront of vehicle.

• If the window on the rear sliding door isopen (more than 80 mm/3 in.), the rearsliding door will not open fully but willopen to the 3/4 position.

To lock a door without the key, push theinside door lock button (1) or door lockswitch (2) to the “Lock” position and closethe door (3).

✽✽ NOTICEIf the door is locked/unlocked multipletimes in rapid succession with either thevehicle key or door lock switch, the sys-tem may stop operating temporarily inorder to protect the circuit and preventdamage to system components.

OVQ036001N

1VQA2327

Front door

Rear door

CAUTIONThe left sliding door cannot beopened when the fuel filler lid isopen. However, if the fuel filler lid isopened after the door is openedslightly, the left sliding door can beslide rearward. Close the left slidingdoor to prevent possible damage tothe door or the fuel filler lid.

WARNINGAlways remove the ignition key,engage the parking brake, close allwindows and lock all doors whenleaving your vehicle unattended.

OVQ047205

Rear sliding doors

Slide

Pull

3 13

Features of your vehicle

Operating door locks from insidethe vehicleWith the door lock button• To unlock a door, pull the door lock but-

ton (1) to the “Unlock” position. If thedoor is unlocked, the red part (2) of thebutton becomes visible.

• To lock a door, push the door lock but-ton (1) to the “Lock” position. If the dooris locked, red part (2) of the buttonbecomes invisible.

• To open a door, pull the door handle(3).

• If the inner door handle of the frontdoor is pulled when the door lock but-ton is in lock position, the button isunlocked and door opens. (if equipped)

• Front doors cannot be locked if theignition key is in the ignition switch anddoor is open.

✽✽ NOTICE - Door lock malfunctionIf a power door lock ever fails to func-tion while you are in the vehicle, try oneor more of the following techniques toexit:• Operate the door unlock feature

repeatedly (both electronic and manu-al) while simultaneously pulling onthe door handle.

• Operate the other door locks and han-dles, front and rear.

• Lower a front window and use the keyto unlock the door from outside.

With central door lock switchThe central door locking switch is locatedon the front door arm rest. It is operatedby depressing the door lock switch. If anydoor is open when the switch isdepressed, the door will remain lockedwhen closed.

1VQA2007

1VQA2008

Front door

Rear door

Lock Unlock

Lock Unlock

OVQ026021N

Driver’s door

Features of your vehicle

143

• When pushing down on the front por-tion (1) of the switch, all vehicle doorswill lock.

• When pushing down on the rear por-tion (2) of the switch, all vehicle doorswill unlock.

• However, if the key is in the ignitionswitch and any front door is open, thedoors will not lock when the front por-tion of central door lock switch ispressed.

Auto door lock/unlock feature• All doors will be automatically locked

when shifting the transaxle shift leverout of P (Park) with engine is running.

• All doors will be automatically unlockedwhen shifting the transaxle shift leverinto P (Park) with engine is running.

1VQA2012

Passenger’s door (if equipped)

WARNING - Unlockedvehicles

Leaving your vehicle unlocked caninvite theft or possible harm to youor others from someone hiding inyour vehicle while you are gone.Always remove the ignition key,engage the parking brake, close allwindows and lock all doors whenleaving your vehicle unattended.

WARNING - Unattendedchildren

An enclosed vehicle can becomeextremely hot, causing death orsevere injury to unattended chil-dren or animals who cannot escapethe vehicle. Furthermore, childrenmight operate features of the vehi-cle that could injure them, or theycould encounter other harm, possi-bly from someone gaining entry tothe vehicle. Never leave children oranimals unattended in your vehicle.

WARNING - Doors• The doors should always be fully

closed and locked while the vehi-cle is in motion to prevent acci-dental opening of the door.Locked doors will also discour-age potential intruders when thevehicle stops or slows.

• Be careful when opening doorsand watch for vehicles, motorcy-cles, bicycles or pedestriansapproaching the vehicle in thepath of the door. Opening a doorwhen something is approachingcan cause damage or injury.

3 15

Features of your vehicle

Child-protector rear door lockThe child safety lock is provided to helpprevent children from accidentally open-ing the rear doors from inside the vehicle.The rear door safety locks should beused whenever children are in the vehi-cle.1. Open the rear door.2. Push the child safety lock located on

the front edge of the door to the “Lock”position. When the child safety lock isin the “Lock ( )” position, rear doorwill not open when the inner door han-dle is pulled inside the vehicle or thesub control button of the power slidingdoor is pressed.

3. Close the rear door.To open the rear door, pull the outsidedoor handle or push the main control but-ton of the power sliding door.Even though the doors may be unlocked,the rear door will not open by pulling theinner door handle or pushing the subcontrol button until rear door child safetylock is unlocked ( ).

TailgateOpening the tailgate• Tailgate is locked or unlocked with a

key. (if equipped)• To open the tailgate, insert the key into

the lock, turn it to the unlock positionand pull up the tailgate by pressing thehandle.You can also lock/unlock the latch (butnot release it) with the central door locksystem.

• If unlocked, the tailgate can be openedby pressing the handle and pulling it up.

WARNING - Rear doorlocks

If children accidentally open therear doors while the vehicle is inmotion, they could fall out and beseverely injured or killed.To preventchildren from opening the reardoors from the inside, the rear doorsafety locks should be used when-ever children are in the vehicle.

1VQA2013

Lock Unlock

OEP036009

Features of your vehicle

163

Closing the tailgateTo close the tailgate, lower and pushdown the tailgate firmly. Make sure thatthe tailgate is securely latched.

✽✽ NOTICE• In cold and wet climates, door lock

and door mechanisms may not workproperly due to freezing conditions.

• When jacking up the vehicle tochange a tire or repair the vehicle, donot operate the tailgate. This couldcause the tailgate to close improperly.

1VQA2010

WARNING - TailgateThe tailgate swings upward. Makesure no objects or people are nearthe rear of the vehicle when open-ing the tailgate.

CAUTIONMake certain that you close the tail-gate before driving your vehicle.Possible damage may occur to thetailgate lift cylinders and attachinghardware if the tailgate is notclosed prior to driving.

WARNING - Exhaustfumes

If you drive with the tailgate open,you will draw dangerous exhaustfumes into your vehicle which cancause serious injury or death tovehicle occupants.If you must drive with the tailgateopen, keep the air vents and all win-dows open so that additional out-side air comes into the vehicle.

WARNING - Rear cargoarea

Occupants should never ride in therear cargo area where no restraintsare available. To avoid injury in theevent of an accident or suddenstops, occupants should always beproperly restrained.

3 17

Features of your vehicle

(1) Left power sliding door main controlbutton

(2) Right power sliding door main controlbutton

(3) Power tailgate main control button*(4) Power ON/OFF button(5) Right power sliding door sub control

button(6) Left power sliding door sub control

button(7) Power tailgate sub control button*

*: if equipped

The power sliding doors and power tail-gate can be opened and closed automat-ically with the transmitter key, the maincontrol buttons on the overhead consoleor the sub control buttons on the centerpillar trim and the tailgate.When the power ON/OFF button (PWR)is OFF (not depressed), the power slid-ing door and power tailgate can beopened and closed manually by pullingthe door handles from inside or outsidevehicle.However, it is possible to control thedoors and tailgate with the transmitter orthe main control buttons on the overheadconsole even though the power ON/OFFbutton (PWR) is OFF (not depressed).

✽✽ NOTICEIf the power sliding door or power tail-gate is open approximately 6 hours, theECU will enter Sleep mode to conservebattery power and the door or tailgatemight not close automatically. Close thedoor or tailgate manually and thenoperate the door or tailgate with thepower operating system.

✽✽ NOTICEIn cold and wet climates, power slidingdoors and tailgate may not work prop-erly due to freezing conditions.

✽✽ NOTICEWhen the sliding doors are opened man-ually (power OFF), more effort will berequired to open and close than on non-power sliding doors.

POWER SLIDING DOOR AND POWER TAILGATE (IF EQUIPPED)

1VQA2014

OVQ036002N

1VQA2016

On the center pillar trim

On the tailgate

On the overhead console

WARNINGNever leave children or animalsunattended in your vehicle.Children or animals might operatethe power sliding door or powertailgate that could result in injury tothemselves or others or damage tothe vehicle.

Features of your vehicle

183

✽✽ NOTICE• The power sliding door and power

tailgate can be operated when theengine is not running. However thepower operation consumes largeamounts of vehicle electric power. Toprevent the battery from being dis-charged, do not operate them exces-sively e.g.: more than approximately10 times repeatedly.

• To prevent the battery from being dis-charged, do not leave the power slid-ing door and power tailgate at openposition for a long lime.

• Do not apply excessive force whileoperating the power sliding door orpower tailgate. This could cause dam-age to the power sliding door or powertailgate.

• Do not modify or repair any part ofthe power sliding door or power tail-gate by yourself. This must be done byan authorized Kia dealer.

• When jacking up the vehicle tochange a tire or repair the vehicle, donot operate the power sliding door orpower tailgate. This could cause thepower sliding door or power tailgateto operate improperly.

Automatic stop and reversalIf the power opening or closing is blockedby an object or part of the body, thepower sliding door and power tailgate willdetect the resistance, then the chime willsound 3 times, and stop movement ormove to the full open position to allow theobject to be cleared.However, if the resistance is weak suchas an object that is thin or soft, or thedoor is near latched position, the auto-matic stop and reversal may not detectthe resistance and closing operation willcontinue. Also, if the power sliding dooror power tailgate is forced by strongimpact, the automatic stop and reversalmay operate.If the automatic stop and reversal featureoperates continuously more than twiceduring one opening or closing operation,the power sliding door or power tailgatemay stop at that position. At this time,close the doors manually and operatethe door automatically again.

1VQA2346

1VQA2347

3 19

Features of your vehicle

How to reset the power sliding doorand power tailgateIf the battery has been discharged or dis-connected, the related fuse has beenreplaced or disconnected, and the powersliding door or power tailgate doesn'twork properly, the power sliding door andpower tailgate must be reset as follows:1. Put the shift lever in the P (Park) for

automatic transaxle.2. Close the sliding door's windows and

fuel filler lid.

3. Pull the SHUNT connector on the dri-ver's side fuse panel and reinstall itafter 1 minute.

4. Close the sliding door or tailgate man-ually.

5. Open the sliding door or tailgate com-pletely using the transmitter or maincontrol button on the overhead con-sole.

6. Close the sliding door or tailgate com-pletely using the transmitter or maincontrol button on the overhead con-sole.

For the left/right power sliding doors andpower tailgate, follow above steps toreset.If the power sliding door or power tailgatedoesn't work properly after above proce-dure, have the system checked by anauthorized Kia dealer.

WARNING• Never intentionally place any

object or part of your body in thepath of the power sliding door orpower tailgate to make sure theautomatic stop operates.

• Make sure rear passengers areseated and there are no people orobjects around the door beforeoperating the power sliding door.

• Make sure all faces, arms, hands,body parts and any other obstruc-tions are safely out of the waybefore operating the power slid-ing doors or power tailgate.

• Never place any object or part ofyour body in the path of thepower sliding door or power tail-gate. This could result in seriousinjury or cause damage to thevehicle.

• Make sure there are no people orobjects around the door beforeoperating the power sliding dooror power tailgate. Have rear pas-sengers or cargo get in or out ofthe vehicle after the door is openfully and stopped.

1VQA4005

On the driver’s side fuse panel

Features of your vehicle

203

Power ON/OFF button• When the power ON/OFF button

(PWR) is ON (depressed), the powersliding door and power tailgate can becontrolled with the sub control buttonson the center pillar trim or tailgate.Also, the doors can be opened andclosed automatically by pulling theinside or outside door handles.

• When the power ON/OFF button(PWR) is OFF (not depressed), thepower sliding door and power tailgatecan not be controlled with the sub con-trol buttons or door handles. However,the doors can be controlled with thetransmitter or the main control buttonson the overhead console even thoughthe power ON/OFF button (PWR) isOFF (not depressed).Also, the doors can be opened andclosed manually by pulling the inside oroutside door handles. ✽✽ NOTICE

Close the sliding door and tailgate, andkeep the power ON/OFF button (PWR)in the OFF (not depressed) positionbefore washing the vehicle in an auto-matic car wash.

✽✽ NOTICEWhen the sliding doors are opened man-ually (power OFF), more effort will berequired to open and close than on non-power sliding doors.

1VQA2017

WARNINGDo not allow children to play withthe power sliding door or powertailgate. Keep the power ON/OFFbutton (PWR) in the OFF (notdepressed) position when not inuse. Serious injury or death canresult from unintentional poweroperation by child.

3 21

Features of your vehicle

Power sliding door operation• Push the corresponding main control

button on the overhead console toopen or close the power sliding door.However, the power sliding door willnot open with the transmitter or themain control button when all powersliding doors and power taligate arelocked and closed.

• When the power ON/OFF button(PWR) is ON (depressed), do as fol-lows to open or close the power slidingdoors:- Push the corresponding sub control

button on the center pillar trim.- Pull the door handle from inside or

outside vehicle.- If the sub control button is pushed

while the door is locked or child safe-ty lock is engaged, the chime soundsonce, and the power sliding door willnot open.

- If the door handle is pulled frominside or outside while the door islocked or child safety lock isengaged, the power sliding door willnot open. However, the power slidingdoor can be opened by pulling theoutside door handle while the door isunlocked and child safety lock isengaged.

• When the power ON/OFF button(PWR) is OFF (not depressed), thepower sliding door can not be con-trolled with the sub control buttons ordoor handles, and if the sub controlbutton is pushed, chime sounds once.However, the doors can be openedand closed manually by pulling thedoor handles from inside or outsidevehicle.

• On a steep grade, the power slidingdoor will slide faster when closing. Andthe drive unit motor may operate addi-tionally for a moment after the door isclosed. This is a normal operation toensure door closing, not a malfunction.

1VQA2018

On the overhead console

OVQ036003N

On the center pillar trim

Features of your vehicle

223

OVQ036004

WARNINGIf your vehicle is facing downwardon a steep grade (15 percent ormore), the door may not stay openand could slam shut, possibly injur-ing someone. To make sure thedoor does not slam shut, turn onthe power sliding door feature.Then if the door closes, it will closeunder the control of the power doorsystem.

WARNINGIf children accidentally open thepower sliding doors while the vehi-cle is in motion, they could fall outand be severely injured or killed. Toprevent children from opening thepower sliding doors from theinside, the child safety locks shouldbe used whenever children are inthe vehicle.

WARNINGWhen the rear passenger operatesthe power sliding door, make surethere are no people or objectsaround the door, and have all occu-pants get in or out of the vehicleafter the door is open fully andstopped.

WARNING• Let the rear passengers get in or

out of the vehicle after the door isopen fully. Sudden closing couldcause a serious injury.

• Close the door by pulling thedoor handle after the door is openfully. Do not pull the door handlewhile rear passengers are gettingin or out. The door could sudden-ly close by itself and cause a seri-ous injury.

• It takes about 5 seconds for thepower sliding door to close andlatch completely.Sudden starting or acceleratingthe vehicle before the door closesand latches completely couldcause it to open the door andresult in a serious injury or dam-age to cargo. Do not start thevehicle before the door closesand latches completely.

3 23

Features of your vehicle

• If the window on the power sliding dooris open (more than 80 mm/3 in.), thepower sliding door will not power openfully but will open to the 3/4 positionand the chime will sound 3 times. Toclose the door, use the transmitter ormain control button with the powerON/OFF button in OFF position (notdepressed), or sub control button ordoor handle with the power ON/OFFbutton in ON position (depressed).

• The left power sliding door cannot beopened while the fuel filler lid is openfully. If the main or sub control button ispushed, the chime sounds once. Also,if the fuel filler lid open button ispushed while the left power slidingdoor is opening, the chime soundsonce.

✽✽ NOTICEIf the fuel filler lid is opened when theleft sliding door is not closed completely,the door may be opened. Close the leftsliding door before refueling to preventpossible damage to the door or the fuelfiller lid.

• If the power sliding door is not closedand latched completely after powerclosing operation, the chime sounds 3times. Open and close the door again.

• If the power sliding door is operatedwhile the door is in partially openedposition (less than 300 mm/12 in.), thedoor is automatically opened fully.

• If the power sliding door is operatedwhile the door is in half-opened posi-tion (more than 300 mm/12 in.), thedoor is automatically closed complete-ly.

• If the power sliding door is operatedagain while the door is closing, thedoor is automatically opened fully.

• If the power sliding door is operatedagain while the door is opening, thedoor is automatically closed complete-ly. However, If the power sliding door isoperated again when the door is in par-tially opened position (less than 300mm/12 in.), the door is opened contin-uously.

• The half-opened power sliding door isautomatically opened or closed fully bypushing the door forward or backwardwithout pulling the door handle whilethe power ON/OFF button is in ON(depressed). However, when the dooris in partially opened position (lessthan 300 mm/12 in.), the door is notclosed automatically.

WARNINGDo not leave the power sliding doorin a partially opened position. Closethe window and then open the doorfully. A partially opened door is heldand then released after 10 minutes.The chime sounds 3 times to indi-cate the door is released. If thevehicle is stopped on a downwardslope, it may move and cause aninjury.

Features of your vehicle

243

Power sliding door non-opening condi-tionsThe power sliding door is not automati-cally opened, but closed under the fol-lowing conditions. If the main or sub con-trol button is pushed for power openingoperation, the chime sounds once.When the ignition switch is in the ONposition,1.Vehicle is moving above 5 km/h (3 mph).2. The gearshift lever is not in P (Park) for

automatic transaxle.

Power tailgate operation (if equipped)• Push the power tailgate main control

button on the overhead console toopen or close the power tailgate.However, the power tailgate will notopen with the transmitter or the maincontrol button when all power slidingdoors and power tailgate are lockedand closed.

• When the power tailgate is operatedwith the main or sub control button ortransmitter, the chime sounds and haz-ard warning lights flash 3 times.

• When the power ON/OFF button(PWR) is ON (depressed), do as fol-lows to open or close the power tail-gate:- Pushing the sub control button on the

bottom of the tailgate will close thepower tailgate automatically.

- Pressing and pulling up the tailgatehandle slightly will open the powertailgate automatically when the tail-gate is unlocked.

1VQA2019

On the overhead console

1VQA2016A

On the tailgate

WARNINGDo not open the sliding doors whilethe vehicle is in motion. Passengersor cargo may be ejected from thevehicle, possibly resulting in prop-erty damage, severe injury, ordeath.

3 25

Features of your vehicle

• When the power ON/OFF button(PWR) is OFF (not depressed), thepower tailgate can not be controlledwith the sub control buttons or tailgatehandle, and if the sub control button ispushed, the chime sounds once.However, the tailgate may be openedmanually by pulling the exterior handleand lifting the tailgate upward. The tail-gate may be manually closed by push-ing the tailgate downward.

• If the power tailgate is not closed andlatched completely after power closingoperation, the chime sounds 3 times.

• If the power tailgate is operated whilethe tailgate is in partially opened posi-tion (less than 20 degrees), the tailgateis automatically opened fully.If the power tailgate is operated whilethe tailgate is in half-opened position(more than 20 degrees), the tailgate isautomatically closed completely.

• If the power tailgate is operated againwhile the tailgate is closing, the tailgateis automatically opened fully.

• If the power tailgate is operated againwhile the tailgate is opening, the tail-gate is automatically closed complete-ly. However, if the power tailgate buttonis pressed again when the tailgate isopen less than 20 degrees, the tailgatewill continue to open.

Power tailgate non-opening condi-tionsThe power tailgate will not open auto-matically, but will close under the follow-ing conditions. If the main or sub controlbutton is pushed for power opening oper-ation, the chime sounds once.When the ignition switch is in the ONposition,1.Vehicle is moving above 5 km/h (3 mph).2. The gearshift lever is not in P (Park) for

automatic transaxle.

WARNINGEven though the power ON/OFFbutton (PWR) is in the OFF (notdepressed) position, the tailgatewill still be propelled upward bymechanical force if the tailgate ismanually opened more than 20degrees beyond the fully closedposition. In addition, if the tailgateis manually closed to the secondarylatch position, the tailgate will beelectrically moved to the fullylatched position. Make sure thatface, arms, hands, and otherobstructions are safely out of theway before operating the tailgate.

WARNINGMake sure there are no people orobjects around the tailgate beforeoperating the power tailgate. Waituntil the tailgate is open fully andstopped before loading or unload-ing cargo or passengers from thevehicle.

WARNINGMake sure the tailgate is closedfirmly before driving. If the tailgateis open, you will draw dangerousexhaust fumes into your vehiclewhich can cause serious injury ordeath to vehicle occupants.

Features of your vehicle

263

Power windows (1) Driver’s door power window switch(2) Front passenger’s door power win-

dow switch(3) Rear door (left) power window switch(4) Rear door (right) power window

switch(5) Power rear quarter window (left)

switch*(6) Power rear quarter window (right)

switch*(7) Power window lock switch(8) Window opening and closing(9) Automatic power window down

(Driver’s window)

*: if equipped

✽✽ NOTICEIn cold and wet climates, power win-dows may not work properly due tofreezing conditions.

WINDOWS

OVQ030005N

3 27

Features of your vehicle

The ignition switch must be in the ONposition for power windows to operate.Each door has a power window switchthat controls that door’s window.However, the driver has a power windowlock switch which can block the operationof passenger windows.The power windows can be operated forapproximately 30 seconds after the igni-tion key is removed or turned to the ACCor LOCK position. However, if the frontdoors are opened, the power windowscannot be operated even within the 30seconds after the ignition key removal.

✽✽ NOTICEWhile driving with the rear windowsdown or with the sunroof in an open (orpartially open position), your vehiclemay demonstrate a wind buffeting orpulsation noise. This noise is a normaloccurrence and can be reduced or elim-inated by taking the following actions.If the noise occurs with one or both ofthe rear windows down, partially lowerboth front windows approximately oneinch. If you experience the noise withthe sunroof open, slightly reduce the sizeof the sunroof opening.

Window opening and closingThe driver’s door has a master powerwindow switch that controls all the win-dows in the vehicle.• To open or close a window, press down

(8) or pull up (8) the front portion of thecorresponding switch.

• To open or close a rear quarter win-dow, push (8) the correspondingswitch.

CAUTION• To prevent the power window

system from the possibility ofdamage, do not open or close twowindows at the same time. Thiswill also ensure the longevity ofthe fuse.

• Never try to operate the mainswitch on the driver's door andthe individual door windowswitch in opposing directions atthe same time. If this is done, thewindow will stop and cannot beopened or closed.

WARNING - Windows• Always double check to make

sure all arms, hands, head andother obstructions are safely outof the way before closing a win-dow.

• Do not allow children to play withthe power windows. Keep the dri-ver’s door power window lockswitch in the LOCK position(depressed). Serious injury canresult from unintentional windowoperation by the child.

• Do not extend face or arms out-side through the window openingwhile driving.

Features of your vehicle

283

Automatic power window down (driver’s window)Depressing the power window switchmomentarily to the second detent posi-tion (9) completely lowers the driver’swindow even when the switch isreleased. To stop the window at thedesired position while the window is inoperation, pull up the switch momentarilyto the opposite direction of the windowmovement.If the power window is not operated cor-rectly, the automatic power window sys-tem must be reset as follows:1. Turn the ignition key to ON position.2. Close driver’s window and continue

pulling up on driver’s power windowswitch for at least 1 second after thewindow is completely closed.

Power window lock switch • The driver can disable the power win-

dow switches on a passenger door orrear quarter trim by depressing thepower window lock switch located onthe driver’s door to LOCK (pressed).

• When the power window lock switchis ON, the driver’s master controlcannot operate the passenger doorpower windows or rear quarter win-dows either.

Manual flip - open (rear quarterwindows, if equipped)To open the quarter windows, pull therear portion of the latch out. Swing thelatch forward and out, then lock it into theopen position by pushing outward untilyou hear a click. To close the windows,pull the handle inward. Then push thehandle rearward until you hear a click.

✽✽ NOTICEIn cold and wet climates, rear quarterpanel windows may not work properlydue to freezing conditions.

1VQA2024OVQ026023N

3 29

Features of your vehicle

Opening the hood 1. Pull the release lever to unlatch the

hood. The hood should pop openslightly.

2. Go to the front of the vehicle, raise thehood slightly, pull the secondary latch(1) inside of the hood center and lift (2)the hood.

3. Raise the hood. It will raise completelyby itself after it has been raised abouthalfway.

Closing the hood1. Before closing the hood, check the fol-

lowing:• All filler caps in engine compartment

must be correctly installed.• Gloves, rags or any other com-

bustible material must be removedfrom the engine compartment.

2. Lower the hood halfway and pushdown to securely lock in place.

HOOD

WARNING - Hood• Before closing the hood, ensure

that all obstructions are removedfrom the hood opening. Closingthe hood with an obstruction pre-sent in the hood opening mayresult in property damage orsevere personal injury.

• Do not leave gloves, rags or anyother combustible material in theengine compartment. Doing somay cause a heat-induced fire.

1VQA2028 1VQA2029 WARNING Make sure the hood is properlylocked before driving.

WARNINGOpen the hood after turning off theengine on a flat surface, shifting theshift lever to the P(Park) positionfor automatic transaxle and to the1st(First) gear or R(Reverse) formanual transaxle, and setting theparking brake.

Features of your vehicle

303

1. Stop the engine.2. To open the fuel filler lid, push the

release button located on the driver’slower door.

3. Pull the fuel filler lid out to open.4. To remove the cap, turn the fuel tank

cap counterclockwise.5. Refuel as needed.6. To install the cap, turn it clockwise until

it “clicks”. This indicates that the cap issecurely tightened.

7. Close the fuel filler lid and push it light-ly and make sure that it is securelyclosed.

FUEL FILLER LID

OVQA022026

WARNING To avoid injury from sharp edges, itis recommended that protectivegloves be worn if there is a need toopen the fuel filler door manually.

WARNING - RefuelingIf pressurized fuel sprays out, it cancover your clothes or skin and thussubject you to the risk of fire andburns. Always remove the fuel capcarefully and slowly. If the cap isventing fuel or if you hear a hissingsound, wait until the conditionstops before completely removingthe cap.

1VQA2025

3 31

Features of your vehicle

WARNING - Refueling dan-gers

Automotive fuels are flammablematerials. When refueling, pleasenote the following guidelines care-fully. Failure to follow these guide-lines may result in severe personalinjury, severe burns or death by fireor explosion.• Before refueling note the location

of the Emergency Gasoline Shut-Off, if available, at the gas stationfacility.

• Before touching the fuel nozzle,you should eliminate potentiallydangerous static electricity dis-charge by touching another metalpart of the vehicle, a safe distanceaway from the fuel filler neck, noz-zle, or other gas source.

(Continued)

(Continued)• Do not get back into a vehicle

once you have begun refuelingsince you can generate staticelectricity by touching, rubbing orsliding against any item or fabric(polyester, satin, nylon, etc.)capable of producing static elec-tricity. Static electricity dischargecan ignite fuel vapors resulting inrapid burning. If you must re-enter the vehicle, you shouldonce again eliminate potentiallydangerous static electricity dis-charge by touching a metal partof the vehicle, away from the fuelfiller neck, nozzle or other gaso-line source.

• When using a portable fuel con-tainer be sure to place the con-tainer on the ground prior to refu-eling. Static electricity dischargefrom the container can ignite fuelvapors causing a fire. Once refu-eling has begun, contact with thevehicle should be maintaineduntil the filling is complete.

(Continued)

(Continued)Use only portable plastic fuelcontainers designed to carry andstore gasoline.

• Do not use cellular phones whilerefueling. Electric current and/orelectronic interference from cellu-lar phones can potentially ignitefuel vapors causing a fire.

• When refueling, always shut theengine off. Sparks produced byelectrical components related tothe engine can ignite fuel vaporscausing a fire. Once refueling iscomplete, check to make sure thefiller cap and filler door aresecurely closed, before startingthe engine.

• DO NOT use matches or a lighterand DO NOT SMOKE or leave a litcigarette in your vehicle while at agas station especially duringrefueling. Automotive fuel is high-ly flammable and can, when ignit-ed, result in fire.

(Continued)

Features of your vehicle

323

When fuel filler lid does not openwith the release buttonIf the fuel filler lid does not open usingthe remote fuel filler lid release, you canopen it manually. Unsnap and remove thepanel in the cargo area. Pull the handleoutward.

(Continued)• If a fire breaks out during refuel-

ing, leave the vicinity of the vehi-cle, and immediately contact themanager of the gas station andthen contact the local fire depart-ment or 911. Follow any safetyinstructions they provide.

CAUTION• Make sure to refuel your vehicle

according to the “Fuel require-ments” suggested in section 1.

• Check to make sure the fuel fillercap is securely closed after refu-eling. A loose fuel filler cap maycause the "Check Engine"(Malfunction Indicator) light in theinstrument panel to illuminateunnecessarily.

• If the fuel filler cap requiresreplacement, use only a genuineKia cap or the equivalent speci-fied for your vehicle. An incorrectfuel filler cap can result in a seri-ous malfunction of the fuel sys-tem or emission control system.

• Do not spill fuel on the exteriorsurfaces of the vehicle. Any typeof fuel spilled on painted surfacesmay damage the paint.

• If the fuel filler lid will not open incold weather because the areaaround it is frozen, push or lightlytap the lid.

OVQ036007N

3 33

Features of your vehicle

(1) Slide button(2) Tilt button(3) Close buttonIf your vehicle is equipped with this fea-ture, you can slide or tilt your sunroofwith the sunroof control buttons locatedon the overhead console.

✽✽ NOTICEIn cold and wet climates, sunroof maynot work properly due to freezing con-ditions.

The sunroof can only be opened, closed,or tilted when the ignition switch is in theON position.The sunroof can be operated for approx-imately 30 seconds after the ignition keyis removed or turned to the ACC orLOCK position. However, if the front dooris opened, the sunroof cannot be operat-ed even within the 30 seconds after theignition key is removed or turned to theACC or LOCK position.

✽✽ NOTICEThe sunroof cannot slide when it is inthe tilt position nor can it be tilted whilein an open or slide position.

Sliding the sunroof

SUNROOF (IF EQUIPPED)

1VQA2031

1VQA2032

CAUTIONDo not continue to press the sun-roof control button(s) after the sun-roof is in the fully open, closed, ortilt position(s). Damage to the motoror system components could occur.

1VQA2030

Features of your vehicle

343

OpenAutoslideTo use the autoslide feature, momentari-ly (less than 0.4 second) press the slidebutton on the overhead console.The sunroof will slide all the way open. Tostop the sunroof sliding at any point,press any sunroof control button.

Manual slidePress the slide button on the overheadconsole and hold it until the sunroof isopened to the desired position.

CloseTo close the sunroof, press the close but-ton on the overhead console and hold ituntil the sunroof is closed.

Tilting the sunroof

OpenAutotiltTo use the autotilt feature, momentarily(less than 0.4 second) press the tilt but-ton on the overhead console. The sun-roof will tilt all the way open. To stop thesunroof tilting at any point, press anysunroof control button.

Manual tilt Press the tilt button on the overhead con-sole and hold it until the sunroof isopened to the desired position.

CloseTo close the sunroof, press the close but-ton on the overhead console and hold ituntil the sunroof is closed.

OVQ049034

1VQA2035

3 35

Features of your vehicle

Sunshade The sunshade will be opened with theglass panel automatically when the glasspanel is slid.You will have to close it man-ually if you want it closed.

1VQA2039

WARNING - Sunroof• Do not extend face, neck, arms or

body outside through the sunroofopening while driving.

• Make sure hand and face aresafely out of the way before clos-ing a sunroof.

CAUTION• Do not press any sunroof control

button longer than necessary.Damage to the motor or systemcomponents could occur.

• Periodically remove any dirt thatmay accumulate on the guide rail.

• If you try to open the sunroofwhen the temperature is belowfreezing or when the sunroof iscovered with snow or ice, theglass or the motor could be dam-aged.

• While using sunroof for a longtime, a dust between sunroof androof panel can make a noise.Open the sunroof and removeregularly the dust using cleancloth.

• The sunroof is made to slidetogether with sunshade. Do notleave the sunshade closed whilethe sunroof is open.

Features of your vehicle

363

Resetting the sunroofWhenever the vehicle battery is discon-nected or discharged, you have to resetyour sunroof system as follows:

1. Turn the ignition key to the ON posi-tion.

2. According to the position of the sun-roof, do as follows.1) in case that the sunroof has closed

completely or been tilted :Press the tilt button until the sun-roof has tilted upward completely.

2) in case that the sunroof has slide-opened:Press and hold the close button(for more than 5 seconds) until thesunroof has closed completely.Press the tilt button until the sun-roof has tilted upward completely.

3. Release the tilt button.

4. Press and hold the tilt button (formore than 10 seconds) until the sun-roof has returned to the original posi-tion of tilt after it is raised a little high-er than the maximum tilt position.Then, release the button.

5. Press and hold the tilt button (formore than 5 seconds) until the sun-roof is operated as follows;

TILT DOWN → SLIDE OPEN →SLIDE CLOSE

Then, release the button.

When this is complete, the sunroof sys-tem is reset.

3 37

Features of your vehicle

Front seat(1) Forward and backward(2) Seatback angle(3) Seat cushion height (Driver’s seat)*(4) Seat warmer*(5) Headrest(6) Armrest(7) Lumbar support (Driver’s seat)*

Rear seats(8) Forward and backward (9) Seatback angle(10) Headrest(11) Armrest(12) Stowing*

* if equipped

SEAT

OVQ036201N

Long wheelbase

Short wheelbase

Power seat Manual seat

WARNING - Loose objectsLoose objects in the driver’s footarea could interfere with the opera-tion of the foot pedals, possiblycausing an accident. Do not placeanything under the front seats.

Features of your vehicle

383

(Continued)• Always drive and ride with your

seatback upright and the lap por-tion of the safety belt snug andlow across the hips. This is thebest position to protect you incase of an accident.

• In order to avoid unnecessaryand perhaps severe airbaginjuries, always sit as far back aspossible from the steering wheelso that your chest is at least 250mm (10 inches) away from thesteering wheel.

WARNING - Driver’s seat• Never attempt to adjust seat while

the vehicle is moving. This couldresult in loss of control, and anaccident causing death, seriousinjury, or property damage.

• Do not allow anything to interferewith the normal position of theseatback. Storing items against aseatback or in any other wayinterfering with proper locking ofa seatback could result in seriousor fatal injury in a sudden stop orcollision.

(Continued)

WARNING - Uprightingseat

When you return the seatback to itsupright position, hold the seatbackand return it slowly and be surethere are no other occupantsaround the seat. If the seatback isreturned without being held andcontrolled, the back of the seatcould spring forward resulting inaccidental injury to a person struckby the seatback.

WARNING - Rear Seatback• The rear seatback must be

securely latched. If not, passen-gers and objects could be thrownforward resulting in seriousinjury or death in the event of asudden stop or collision.

• Luggage and other cargo shouldbe laid flat in the cargo area. Ifobjects are large, heavy, or mustbe piled, they must be secured.Under no circumstances shouldcargo be piled higher than theseatbacks.

(Continued)

(Continued)Failure to follow these warningscould result in serious injury ordeath in the event of a suddenstop, collision or rollover.

• No passenger should ride in thecargo area or sit or lie on foldedseatbacks while the vehicle ismoving. All passengers must bein seats and restrained properlywhile riding.

• When resetting the seatback tothe upright position, make sure itis securely latched by pushing itforward and backwards.

• To avoid the possibility of burns,do not remove the carpet in thecargo area. Emission controlsbeneath this floor generate highexhaust temperatures.

• Use extreme caution so thathands or other objects are notcaught in the seat mechanismswhile the seat is moving.

• Do not put a cigarette lighter onthe floor or seat. When you oper-ate the seat, gas may gush out ofthe lighter and cause fire.

3 39

Features of your vehicle

Front seat adjustment - manualForward and backwardTo move the seat forward or backward:1. Pull the seat slide adjustment lever

under the front edge of the seat cush-ion up and hold it.

2. Slide the seat to the position youdesire.

3. Release the lever and make sure theseat is locked in place.

Adjust the seat before driving, and makesure the seat is locked securely by tryingto move forward and backward withoutusing the lever. If the seat moves, it is notlocked properly.

Seatback angleTo recline the seatback:1. Lean forward slightly and lift up on the

seatback recline lever located on theoutside of the seat, at the rear.

2. Carefully lean back on the seat andadjust the seatback of the seat to theposition you desire.

3. Release the lever and make sure theseatback is locked in place. (The leverMUST return to its original position forthe seatback to lock.)

1VQA2041 1VQA2043

WARNING - Driver respon-sibility for front seat pas-senger

Riding in a vehicle with a front seat-back reclined could lead to seriousor fatal injury in an accident. If afront seat is reclined during an acci-dent, the occupant’s hips may slideunder the lap portion of the safetybelt applying great force to theunprotected abdomen. Serious orfatal internal injuries could result.The driver must advise the frontpassenger to keep the seatback inan upright position whenever thevehicle is in motion.

Features of your vehicle

403

Seat cushion height (for driver’s seat)To change the height of the seat cushion,push the lever up or down located on theoutside of the seat cushion.• To lower the seat cushion, push down

the lever several times.• To raise the seat cushion, pull up the

lever several times.

Front seat adjustment - powerThe front seat can be adjusted by usingthe control knob on the front door. Beforedriving, adjust the seat to the properposition so as to easily control the steer-ing wheel, pedals and switches on theinstrument panel.

1VQA2328

WARNINGThe power seats are operable withthe ignition OFF.Therefore, children should never beleft unattended in the car.

CAUTION• Power seats are driven by an

electric motor. Stop operatingonce the adjustment is complet-ed. Excessive operation maydamage the electrical equipment.

• When in operation, the powerseats consume large amounts ofelectrical power.To prevent unnec-essary charging system drain,don’t adjust the power seatslonger than necessary while theengine is not running.

• Do not operate two or more powerseat control buttons at the sametime. Doing so may result inpower seat motor or electricalcomponent malfunction.

1VQA2044

3 41

Features of your vehicle

Forward and backward Push the control knob forward or back-ward to move the seat to the desiredposition. Release the knob once the seatreaches to the desired position.

Seatback anglePush the control knob forward or back-ward to move the seatback to the desiredangle. Release the knob once the seatreaches to the desired position.

1VQA2045 1VQA2047

WARNING - Driver respon-sibility for front seat pas-senger

Riding in a vehicle with a front seat-back reclined could lead to seriousor fatal injury in an accident. If afront seat is reclined during an acci-dent, the occupant’s hips may slideunder the lap portion of the safetybelt applying great force to theunprotected abdomen. Serious orfatal internal injuries could result.The driver must advise the frontpassenger to keep the seatback inan upright position whenever thevehicle is in motion.

Features of your vehicle

423

Seat cushion height (for driver’s seat)Push the control knob up to raise ordown to lower the seat cushion. Releasethe knob once the seat reaches to thedesired position.

Headrest (front)The driver's and front passenger's seatsare equipped with a headrest for theoccupant's safety and comfort.The headrest not only provides comfortfor the driver and front passenger, butalso helps to protect the head and neckin the event of a collision.

OVQ039046 OVQ039300N-1

WARNING• For maximum effectiveness in

case of an accident, the headrestshould be adjusted so the middleof the headrest is at the sameheight of the center of gravity ofan occupant's head.Generally, the center of gravity ofmost people's head is similar withheight of the top of their eyes.Also, adjust the headrest as closeto your head as possible. For thisreason, the use of a cushion thatholds the body away from theseatback should not be recom-mended.

• Do not operate vehicle with theheadrests removed as injury tothe occupants may occur in theevent of an accident. Headrestsmay provide protection againstneck injuries when properlyadjusted.

• Do not adjust the headrest posi-tion of the driver's seat while thevehicle is in motion.

3 43

Features of your vehicle

Active headrest (if equipped)The active headrest is designed to moveforward and upward during a rear impact.This helps to prevent the driver's andfront passenger’s head from movingbackward and thus helps prevent neckinjuries.

Forward and backward adjustment (if equipped)The headrest may be adjusted forward tothree different positions by pulling theheadrest forward. To adjust the headrestbackward, pull it fully forward to the far-thest position and release it. Adjust theheadrest so that it properly supports thehead and neck.

Adjusting the height up and downTo raise the headrest, pull it up to thedesired position (1). To lower the head-rest, push and hold the release button (2)on the headrest support and lower theheadrest to the desired position (3).

1VQH3900N 1VQA2049 1VQA2050

WARNINGA gap between the seat and theheadrest release button may appearwhen seating on the seat or whenyou push or pull the seat. Be carefulnot to get your finger, etc. caught inthe gap.

Features of your vehicle

443

RemovalTo remove the headrest, raise it as far asit can go then press the release button (1)while pulling upward (2).To reinstall the headrest, put the headrestpoles (3) into the holes while pressing therelease button (1). Then adjust it to theappropriate height.

Armrest (if equipped)The front seats have the armrest locatedon the side of seatback.To use the armrest, swing down the arm-rest to the lowest position.

Seatback pocketA seatback pocket is provided on theback of the front passenger and driversseatbacks.

WARNINGMake sure the headrest locks inposition after adjusting it to proper-ly protect the occupants.

OVQ039001 OVQ027052

WARNING - Seatbackpockets

Do not put heavy or sharp objectsin the seatback pockets. In an acci-dent they could come loose fromthe pocket and injure vehicle occu-pants.

OVQ028053

3 45

Features of your vehicle

Seat warmer (if equipped)The seat warmer is provided to warm thefront seats during cold weather. With theignition switch in the ON position, pusheither of the switches to warm the driver'sseat or the front passenger's seat.During mild weather or under conditionswhere the operation of the seat warmeris not needed, keep the switches in theOFF position.

✽✽ NOTICEWith the seat warmer switch in the ONposition, the heating system in the seatturns off or on automatically depend

❈ The location of the seat warmer switch maybe changed depending on your model.

OVQ039010N

CAUTIONFor proper operation of the occu-pant classification system:• Do not place any items cumula-

tively weighing over 1 kg (2.2 lbs)in the seatback pocket or on theseat.

• Do not hang onto the front pas-senger seat.

CAUTION• When cleaning the seats, do not

use an organic solvent such asthinner, benzene, alcohol andgasoline. Doing so may damagethe surface of the heater or seats.

• To prevent overheating the seatwarmer, do not place anything onthe seats that insulates againstheat, such as blankets, cushionsor seat covers while the seatwarmer is in operation.

• Do not place heavy or sharpobjects on seats equipped withseat warmers. Damage to the seatwarming components couldoccur.

Features of your vehicle

463

Lumbar support (driver’s seat only)(if equipped)You can adjust the lumbar support bymoving the lever on the outside of the dri-ver’s seatback. Pivoting the lever increas-es or decreases the lumbar support.

Rear seat adjustmentAdjusting the seat forward and back-ward - 2nd row seatTo move the seat forward or backward:1. Pull the seat slide adjustment lever

under the front edge of the seat cush-ion up and hold it.

2. Slide the seat to the position youdesire.

3. Release the lever and make sure theseat is locked in place.

Adjust the seat before driving, and makesure the seat is locked securely by tryingto move forward and backward withoutusing the lever. If the seat moves, it is notlocked properly.

WARNING - Seat heaterburns

Passengers should use extremecaution when using seat warmersdue to the possibility of excessheating or burns. The seat warmermay cause burns even at low tem-peratures, especially if used forlong periods of time. In particular,the driver must exercise extremecare for the following types of pas-sengers:1. Infants, children, elderly or hand-

icapped persons, or hospital out-patients

2. Persons with sensitive skin orthose that burn easily

3. Fatigued individuals4. Intoxicated individuals5. Individuals taking medication

that can cause drowsiness orsleepiness (sleeping pills, coldtablets, etc.)

1VQA2042 OVQ030203N

3 47

Features of your vehicle

Seatback angleTo recline the seatback:1. Lean forward slightly and lift up on the

seatback recline lever (or strap) locat-ed on the outside of the seat at therear.

2. Carefully lean back on the seat andadjust the seatback of the seat to theposition you desire.

3. Release the lever (or strap) and makesure the seatback is locked in place.(The lever MUST return to its originalposition for the seatback to lock.)

ArmrestThe 2nd row seats have the armrestlocated on the side of seatback.To use the armrest, swing down the arm-rest to the lowest position.

OVQ027052

OVQ030204N

OVQ036205N

2nd row seat

3rd row seat

Features of your vehicle

483

Headrest (rear)The rear seat(s) is equipped with head-rests in all the seating position for theoccupant's safety and comfort.The headrest not only provides comfortfor the passengers, but also helps to pro-tect the head and neck in the event of acollision. For best protection, adjust theheadrest so its center is as high as yourears.

Adjusting the height up and downTo raise the headrest, pull it up to thedesired position (1). To lower the head-rest, push and hold the release button (2)on the headrest support and lower theheadrest to the desired position (3).

WARNING• For maximum effectiveness in

case of an accident, the headrestshould be adjusted so the middleof the headrest is at the sameheight of the center of gravity ofan occupant's head.Generally, the center of gravity ofmost people's head is similar withheight of the top of their eyes.Also, adjust the headrest as closeto your head as possible. For thisreason, the use of a cushion thatholds the body away from theseatback should not be recom-mended.

• Do not operate vehicle with theheadrests removed as injury tothe occupants may occur in theevent of an accident. Headrestsmay provide protection againstneck injuries when properlyadjusted.

• Do not adjust the headrest posi-tion of the driver's seat while thevehicle is in motion.

OVQ039300N-3

1VQA2050

1VQA2057

2nd row seat

3rd row seat

3 49

Features of your vehicle

RemovalTo remove the headrest, raise it as far asit can go then press the release button(1) while pulling upward (2).To reinstall the headrest, put the headrestpoles (3) into the holes while pressing therelease button (1). Then adjust it to theappropriate height.

Full flat seatWhen the vehicle is parked, you canplace the front seat in a reclined position,nearly flat.1. Move the rear seat to the farthest rear-

ward position.2. Move the front seat to the farthest for-

ward position.3. Remove the headrest.4. Recline the seatback as far as it can

go to allow the rear seat passenger tosupport their legs in the reclined posi-tion.

WARNINGMake sure the headrest locks inposition after adjusting it to proper-ly protect the occupants.

1VQA2329

OVQ039001

OVQ039002

2nd row seat

3rd row seat

Features of your vehicle

503

Folding the rear seatbackThe rear seatbacks fold forward to pro-vide additional cargo space and to pro-vide access to the cargo area.

To fold the rear seat:- 2nd row seat1. Lower the headrest to the lowest posi-

tion.

2. Pull the seatback recliner (or strap)and double-fold the seat forward.

3. Push down the seat backward firmly tolock the catches into the rear anchorsuntil an audible "click" is heard.

OVQ030211N OVQ036209NWARNING - Full flat seat

Never allow a passenger to use thefull flat seat feature while the vehi-cle is in motion because severeinjury or death could occur in anaccident.

WARNING - Uprightingseat

When you return the seatback to itsupright position, hold the seatbackand return it slowly. If the seatbackis returned without holding it, theback of the seat could spring for-ward resulting in accidental injuryfrom being struck by the seatback.

3 51

Features of your vehicle

4. Make sure the green mark on the rearseat cushion frame is visible and thecatches are locked in position by mov-ing the seat forward and backward orlifting the front portion of the seat. If thegreen mark is invisible and the seatmoves, it is not locked properly.

- 3rd row seat1. Lower the headrest to the lowest posi-

tion.2. Hold the seatback and pull out the

folding strap.3. Fold the seatback forward and down

firmly until it clicks into place.

To unfold the rear seat:1. Pull up the seatback recline lever (or

strap).2. Lift and push the seatback backward

firmly until it clicks into place.Make sure the seatback is locked inplace.

3. Return the rear safety belt to the prop-er position.

Double-folding the rear seat - 2nd row seatTo fold the rear seat:1. Lower the headrest to the lowest position.2. Move the seat to rear-most position.3. Double-fold the rear seat forward by

pull up the seatback recline lever (orstrap).

OVQ036208NOVQ036210N OVQ030211N

2nd row seat

Features of your vehicle

523

4. Pull the folding strap out of the pocketlocated under the seat cushion. (2ndrow seat)

5. Lift the entire folded seat forward andtie the folded seat to the assist handleusing the strap. (2nd row seat)

To unfold the rear seat1. Untie the strap from the assist handle

and insert the strap into the pocket.(2nd row seat)

2. Push down the seat backward firmly tolock the catches into the rear anchorsuntil an audible “click” is heard.

3. Make sure the green mark on the rearseat cushion frame is visible and thecatches are locked in position by mov-ing the seat forward and backward orlifting the front portion of the seat. If thegreen mark is invisible and the seatmoves, it is not locked properly.

4. Pull up the seatback recline lever (orstrap).

5. Lift and push the seatback backwardfirmly until it clicks into place.Make sure the seatback is locked inplace.

6. Return the rear safety belt to the prop-er position.

OVQ036213N

OVQ036209N

OVQ036210NOVQ036212N

2nd row seat

3 53

Features of your vehicle

Removing the rear seat- 2nd row seatTo remove a rear seat:1. Double-fold the rear seat forward by

pulling up the seatback recline lever(or strap).

2. 2nd row seatPull up the catch release lever underthe front of the seat cushion whilereclining the folded seat rearwardslightly to release the front catchesfrom the anchors.

✽✽ NOTICEOnly use the strap to remove the seat.3. Remove the entire seat from the floor.

OVQ030211N

2nd row seat

OVQ036214N

2nd row seat

OVQ036215L

2nd row seat

Features of your vehicle

543

To install the rear seat:1. Put the front anchor strikers along the

front anchors on the floor.2. Insert two front anchor strikers into the

front anchors.

3. Lift the rear portion of the seat cushionthen push down firmly to lock thecatches into the rear anchors until anaudible “click” is heard.

4. Make sure the green mark on the rearseat cushion frame is visible and thecatches are locked in position by mov-ing the seat forward and backward orlifting the front portion of the seat. If thegreen mark is invisible and the seatmoves, it is not locked properly.

5. Pull up the seatback recline lever (orfolding strap).

6. Lift and push the seatback backwardfirmly until it clicks into place.Make sure the seatback is locked inplace.

7. Return the rear seat belt to the properposition.

OVQ036209N OVQ036210NOVQ036216N

3 55

Features of your vehicle

If the rear catches of the seat are lockedinto the rear anchors (2) while the frontcatches are not locked into the frontanchors (1), do the followings to releasethe rear catches from the rear anchors.

1. Lift the seatback (2) while pulling upthe seatback recline lever (1) and pushthe seatback backward firmly until itclicks into place. Be careful not to foldthe seat backward because the frontcatches are not locked.

2. Pull out the seatback recline strap (4)while lifting up the rear portion of theseat cushion (3).

3. Then the seatback will be folded for-ward and rear catches will be released(5).

4. Remove the seat while lifting up therear portion of seat cushion (6).

OVQ037401N/OVQ037402NOVQ036400L OVQ037403N

Features of your vehicle

563

Stowing the rear seat- 3rd row seatThe rear seat can be folded and stowedin the luggage compartment to provideadditional cargo space.

To stow the rear seat:1. Lower the headrest to the lowest posi-

tion.2. Fold the seatback by pulling out the

folding strap.3. Pull the seat by using the stowing

strap.4. Stow the seat by pushing down firmly.

OVQ036219N

OVQ036220N

WARNING• Make sure there is no body or

object around the seat and becareful not to injure your hands orbody under the seat or in the mov-ing parts when stowing or rein-stalling the seat.

• Do not sit on the seat stowed withthe seatback upright in the lug-gage compartment. Sitting on theunstable and unlocked seat couldcause serious injuries in an acci-dent.

OVQ036218N

3 57

Features of your vehicle

To use the rear seat:1. Lift the seat by pulling out the stowing

strap.

2. Release the strap and push the seatforward firmly until it clicks into place toinsert the catches into the anchors.

✽✽ NOTICEDo not push down the upper part of theseatback when pushing the seat for-ward. Doing so can prevent the catchesfrom being locked in position.

3. Make sure the catches are locked inposition by moving the seat forwardand backward or lifting the front por-tion of the seat. If the seat moves, it isnot locked properly.

4. Pull out the folding strap.5. Lift and pull the seatback backward

firmly until it clicks into place.Make sure the seatback is locked inplace.

6. Return the rear safety belt to the prop-er position.

OVQ036222N OVQ036223NOVQ036221N

Features of your vehicle

583

WARNING - CargoCargo should always be secured toprevent it from being thrown aboutthe vehicle in a collision and caus-ing injury to the vehicle occupants.Special care should be taken ofobjects placed in the rear seats,since those may hit the front seatoccupants in a frontal collision.

CAUTION - Rear safetybelts

When returning the rear seatbacksto the upright position, rememberto return the rear shoulder belts totheir proper position. Routing thesafety belt webbing through therear safety belt guides will helpkeep the belts from being trappedbehind or under the seats.

WARNING - Cargo loadingMake sure the engine is off, thetransaxle is in P and the parkingbrake is applied whenever loadingor unloading cargo. Failure to takethese steps may allow the vehicle tomove if shift lever is inadvertentlymoved to another position.

CAUTION - Avoid damag-ing rear safety bucklesWhen you fold the rear seatback orput luggage on the rear seat cush-ion, insert the buckle in the pocketbetween the rear seatback andcushion. Doing so can prevent thebuckle from being damaged by therear seatback or luggage.

CAUTIONBefore changing seat position, slipthe seat belt into the trim panel andclose the power outlet cap.

1VQA2190A

1VQA2074B/1VQA2074C

2nd row 3rd row

3 59

Features of your vehicle

A driver position memory system is pro-vided to store and recall the driver seat,outside rearview mirror and adjustablepedal positions with a simple buttonoperation. By saving the desired posi-tions into the system memory, differentdrivers can reposition the driver seat,outside rearview mirror and adjustablepedal based upon their driving prefer-ence.If battery is disconnected, the positionmemory will be lost and the driving posi-tions should be restored in the system.

Storing positions into memoryusing the buttons on the doorStoring driver’s seat positions1. Shift the transaxle lever into P while

the ignition switch is ON.2. Adjust the driver seat, outside

rearview mirror and adjustable pedalto positions comfortable for the driver.

3. Press SET button on the control panel.The system will beep once.

4. Press one of the memory buttons (1 or2) within 5 seconds after pressing theSET button. The system will beeptwice when memory has been suc-cessfully stored.

Recalling positions from memory1. Shift the transaxle lever into P while

the ignition switch is ON.2. To recall the position in memory, press

the desired memory button (1 or 2).The system will beep once, then thedriver seat, outside rearview mirrorand adjustable pedal will automaticallyadjust to the stored positions.

Adjusting one of the control knobs for thedriver seat, outside rearview mirror andadjustable pedal while the system isrecalling the stored positions will causethe movement for that component to stopand move in the direction that the controlknob is moved. Other components willcontinue position recalling.

DRIVER POSITION MEMORY SYSTEM (IF EQUIPPED)

WARNING Never attempt to operate the driverposition memory system while thevehicle is moving.This could result in loss of control,and an accident causing death,serious injury, or property damage.

WARNING Use caution when recalling adjust-ment memory while sitting in thevehicle. Push the seat position con-trol knob to the desired positionimmediately if the seat moves toofar in any direction.

OVQ039094

Features of your vehicle

603

Storing and recalling with trans-mitterStoring with the transmitterRemove the key from the ignition switchand lock all the doors using the transmit-ter. The driver seat, outside rearview mir-ror and adjustable pedal positions will bestored in the system memory.

Driver’s position recalling with trans-mitterUnlock the door with the transmitter,positions stored in the system memorywill be recalled automatically.

✽✽ NOTICEThe buzzer sounds 10 times if there is amalfunction of the memory system.Have the driver position memory systemchecked by an authorized Kia dealer.

Easy access functionWhen the AUTO button is ON (the indi-cator light illuminates) with the shift leverin P position, the system will move thedriver’s seat forward or rearward auto-matically so you can comfortably enterand exit the vehicle.• It will move driver’s seat rearward when

the ignition key is removed.• It will move driver’s seat forward when

the ignition key is inserted.

Reverse parking aid function (if equipped)While the vehicle is moving backward,the outside rearview mirror(s) will movedownward to aid reverse parking.According to the position of the outsiderearview mirror switch (1), the outsiderearview mirror(s) will operate as follows:

OVQ039095 1VQA2109

3 61

Features of your vehicle

L/R : When the remote control outsiderearview mirror switch is selected tothe L (left) or R (right) position, bothoutside rearview mirrors will movedownward.

Neutral : When the remote control out-side rearview mirror switch isplaced in the middle position,the outside rearview mirrorswill not operate while the vehi-cle is moving backward.

✽✽ NOTICEThe outside rearview mirrors will auto-matically revert to their original posi-tions under the following conditions:1. Ignition switch is in the LOCK posi-

tion.2. Shift lever is moved to any position

except R.3. Remote control outside rearview mir-

ror switch is placed in the middleposition.

To adjust the position of the acceleratorand brake pedals, push the switch withthe shift lever in the P position.

If you push the ▲ portion of the switch,the pedals move toward the driver.If you push the ▼ portion of the switch,the pedals move away from the driver.

Setting the adjustable pedal posi-tion1. Be sure the parking brake is engaged.2. Move the accelerator and brake ped-

als to the front most position by push-ing the ▼ portion of the switch.

3. Adjust the seat position and the steer-ing wheel angle properly.

4. Move the pedals toward you until youcan fully depress the brake pedal bypushing the ▲ portion of the switch.

5. Depress the pedals a few times to getused to the feel after adjusting.

POWER ADJUSTABLE PEDALS (IF EQUIPPED)

1VQA2066

WARNING• Adjust the pedals after parking

the vehicle on level ground. Neverattempt to adjust the pedals whilethe vehicle is moving.

• Never adjust the pedals with yourfoot on the accelerator pedal asthis may result in increasing theengine speed and acceleration.

• Make sure that you can fullydepress the brake pedal beforedriving. Otherwise, you may notbe able to hold down the brakepedal firmly in an emergencystop.

Features of your vehicle

623

Safety belt restraint system

We strongly recommend that the driverand all passengers be properlyrestrained at all times by using the safetybelts provided with the vehicle. Properuse of the safety belts decreases the riskof severe injury or death in accidents orsudden stops. In most states, and inCanada, the law requires their use.

All seats have lap/shoulder belts. Inertiallocks in the safety belt retractors allow allof the lap/shoulder safety belts to remainunlocked during normal vehicle opera-tion. This allows the occupants somefreedom of movement and increasedcomfort while using the safety belts. If aforce is applied to the vehicle, such as astrong stop, a sharp turn, or a collision,the safety belt retractors will automatical-ly lock the safety belts.Since the inertial locks do not require acollision in order to lock up, you maybecome aware of the safety belts lockingwhile braking or going around sharp cor-ners.Always use the rear seat position(s) toinstall your child restraint(s).

The rear (or front passenger) safety beltsuse a special auto-lock feature designedto allow a child restraint to be used inthese positions without an added lockingclip. They normally lock only underextreme or emergency conditions (emer-gency lock mode). However they can beadjusted so that they remain fixed andlocked when a child restraint system isplaced in these positions. (Use this auto-lock mode only to secure a childrestraint, never for passengers restrainedby the safety belts.) The drivers safety belt can only operatein the emergency lock mode.

Safety belts provide the best restraintwhen:• The seatback is upright.• The occupant is sitting upright (not

slouched).• The lap belt is snug across the hips.• The shoulder belt is snug across the

chest.• The knees are straight forward.

SAFETY BELTS

WARNING - Safety beltsTo minimize the risk of serious orfatal injury in an accident, the driverand all passengers should use theappropriate safety restraints fortheir age and size. The presence ofair bags does not change the needto be properly restrained by a safe-ty belt or size-appropriate childrestraint. In fact, air bags aredesigned to work the best whenpassengers are correctly restrainedin the vehicle.• Be sure you are familiar with the

information in this section,including the information oninfant and child restraints.

• Read the safety warnings on thesun visors of your vehicle also.

WARNING - Child restraintin front seat

Never install a child restraint sys-tem in the front passenger position,as an inflating air bag could causeserious or fatal injury to a child inthat position.

3 63

Features of your vehicle

WARNING - After a colli-sion

• Lap/shoulder belt assembliesmay be stretched or damagedwhen subjected to the stress andforces of a collision.

• The entire restraint systemshould be inspected followingany collision. All belts, retractors,anchors and hardware damagedby a collision should be replacedbefore the vehicle is operatedagain.

WARNING - Cargo area Passengers should never beallowed to ride in the cargo area ofa vehicle. No safety belts are pro-vided for the cargo area. Personsriding in the vehicle without a fas-tened safety belt are much morelikely to suffer serious bodily injuryor death during an accident.

WARNING - Twisted beltsA twisted or jammed safety beltcannot restrain you properly. If youcannot untwist or unjam the safetybelt, have an authorized Kia dealerservice it immediately. Never driveor ride with a twisted or jammedsafety belt.

WARNING - Belt useSafety belts must be used correctlyto work properly in an accident.Each seating position in your vehi-cle has a specific safety belt assem-bly that includes a buckle andtongue designed to be used togeth-er.Failure to heed these warnings andfollow these instructions willincrease the risk and severity ofinjuries and the likelihood of deathin an accident.

(Continued)

(Continued)• Use the shoulder portion of the

safety belt on the outside shoul-der only. Never wear the shoulderportion under the arm or place itbetween your back and seatback.

• Never swing the safety beltaround your neck to fit over theinside shoulder.

• Never wear the shoulder portionof the safety belt across the neckor face.

• Wear the lap portion as low aspossible. Be sure that the lap beltfits snugly around the hips.Never wear a lap portion of alap/shoulder belt over your waist;it should always go over thestronger area of your hips.

• Never use a single safety belt formore than one person.

• The front seatbacks shouldalways remain in a comfortable,upright position when the vehicleis moving.

Features of your vehicle

643

Safety belt warning light and chimeIf the driver's safety belt is not fastenedwhen the key is turned ON or if it is dis-connected after the key is turned ON, thesafety belt warning light will blink until thebelt is fastened.If the driver's safety belt is not fastenedwhen the key is turned ON or if it isunfastened after the key is ON, the safe-ty belt warning chime will sound forapproximately 6 seconds.

WARNING - Safety beltcare

• A damaged belt may not give youthe protection you need in anaccident.

• Inspect your safety belts periodi-cally for excessive wear or dam-age. Pull out each belt fully andlook for fraying, cuts, burns orother damage. Pull the safety beltout and let it retract a number oftimes. Make sure that thelap/shoulder belts return smooth-ly and easily into the retractor.

• Check the latches to make surethey latch and release withoutinterference or delay.

• Never close the doors on any partof the lap or shoulder belt.

• Any belt not in good condition orin good working order should bepromptly replaced.

WARNING Never close the doors on any partof the lap or shoulder belt. It candamage the safety belt or bucklewhich could increase the risk ofinjury in case of an accident.

1GQA2083

WARNING• When you fasten the seat belt, be

careful not to latch the seat belt inbuckles of other seat. It's very dan-gerous and you may not be pro-tected by the seat belt properly.

• Do not unfasten the seat belt anddo not fasten and unfasten theseat belt repeatedly while driving.This could result in loss of con-trol, and an accident causingdeath, serious injury, or propertydamage.

• When fastening the seat belt,make sure that the seat belt doesnot pass over objects that arehard or can break easily.

• Make sure there is nothing in thebuckle. The seat belt may not befastened securely.

3 65

Features of your vehicle

Lap/shoulder beltTo fasten the lap/shoulder belt:1. Grasp the buckle and tongue plate.2. Slowly pull the lap/shoulder belt out

from the retractor.

3. Insert the tongue plate (1) into theopen end of the buckle (2) until anaudible “click” is heard, indicating thebelt is locked in the buckle.

4. Position the lap portion (2) of the beltacross your lap as LOW ON THE HIPSas possible to reduce the risk of slidingunder it during an accident. Adjust thebelt to a SNUG FIT by pulling up onthe shoulder portion (1) of the safetybelt. The belt retractor is designed totake up excess webbing automaticallyand to maintain tension on the belt. Foryour safety, do not put any excessslack into the safety belt at any loca-tion.

✽✽ NOTICEIf you are not able to pull out the safetybelt from the retractor, firmly pull thebelt out and release it. Then you will beable to pull the belt out smoothly.

1GHA2262 1VQH2263 1VQH2264

Features of your vehicle

663

5. Adjust the shoulder anchor position toyour size. To raise the anchor position,push the anchor up (1). To lower theanchor position, press (2) the button(A) and slide the anchor down (3).After adjustment, make sure theanchor is locked in position. (ifequipped)

If the height of the adjusting seat belt istoo near your neck, you will not be gettingthe most effective protection. The shoul-der portion should be adjusted so that itlies across your chest and midway overyour shoulder nearest the door and notyour neck.

To unfasten the lap/shoulder belt:Press the release button on the buckleand allow the belt to slowly retract.

4GQB0338

WARNING• The height adjuster must be in

the locked position when thevehicle is moving.

• The misadjustment of height ofthe shoulder belt could reducethe effectiveness of the seat beltin a crash.

1VQA2068

1st / 2nd row

3 67

Features of your vehicle

3 Point rear center belt - 3rd rowTo fasten the rear center belt1. Extract the tongue plate from the hole

on the belt assembly cover and slowlypull the tongue plates out from theretractor.

2. Insert the tongue plate (A) into theopen end of the buckle (C) until anaudible “click" is heard, indicating thelatch is locked. Make sure the belt isnot twisted.

3. Pull the tongue plate (B) and insert thetongue plate (B) into the open end ofthe buckle (D) until an audible “click” isheard, indicating the latch is locked.Make sure the belt is not twisted.

1VQH3903

CAUTION - Cargo Be sure that the cargo is securelyloaded in the rear cargo area.Failing to do so may damage therear center safety belt in suddenstop or certain collisions.

OVQ036225N OVQ036097N

Features of your vehicle

683

There will be an audible “click” when thetab locks in the buckle. The safety beltautomatically adjusts to the proper lengthonly after the lap belt is adjusted manu-ally so that it fits snugly around your hips,if you lean forward in a slow, easymotion, the belt will extend and let youmove around. If there is a sudden stop orimpact, the belt will lock into position. Itwill also lock if you try to lean forward tooquickly.

When using the rear center seat belt, thebuckle with the “CENTER” mark must beused.

To unfasten the rear center belt 1. Press the release button on the buckle

(D) and remove the tongue plate (B)from the buckle (D).

2. Retract the rear center seatbelt.

WARNINGWhen using the rear safety centerbelt, you must lock all tongue platesand buckles. If any tongue plate orbuckle is not locked, it will increasethe chance of injury in the event ofcollision.

OVQ036226N 1VQH3904

3 69

Features of your vehicle

3. Insert the key or similar small rigiddevice into the web release button (E)on the anchor connector. Pull up onthe seat belt web (A) and allow thewebbing to retract automatically.

4. Insert the tongue plate (A) into thehole on the belt assembly cover.

Stowing the rear safety belt The rear safety belt can be stowed in thepocket between the rear seatback andcushion when not in use.

OVQ036098N

OVQ036227N

CAUTIONWhen using the seat belt, use itafter taking it out of the guides. Ifyou pull the seat belt when it isstored in the guides, it may damagethe guides and/or belt webbing.

OVQ036099N

3rd row seat

Features of your vehicle

703

Proper use and care of the safetybelt system To ensure that the safety belts providethe maximum protection, please followthese instructions:• Use the belts at all times - even on

short trips.• If the safety belt is twisted, straighten it

prior to use.• Keep sharp edges and damaging

objects away from the belts.• Periodically inspect belt webbing,

anchors, buckles and all other parts forsigns of wear and damage. Replacedamaged, excessively worn or ques-tionable parts immediately.

• To clean the belt webbing, use a mildsoap solution recommended for clean-ing upholstery or carpets. Follow theinstructions provided with the soap.

• Do not make modifications or additionsto the safety belt.

• After wearing a safety belt, make sureit fully retracts to the stowed position.Do not allow the belt to get caught inthe door when you close it.

Restraint women Pregnant women should wear lap/shoul-der belt assemblies whenever possibleaccording to specific recommendationsby their doctors. The lap portion of thebelt should be worn AS SNUGLY ANDLOW AS POSSIBLE.

Infants and small children To increase their safety, infants andyoung children should always berestrained by a restraint systemapproved for their age and size.Never allow a child to stand or kneel onthe seat of a moving vehicle. Never allowa safety belt to be placed around both achild and an adult or around two childrenat the same time.It is best for children to be seated in therear seats.Many companies manufacture childrestraint systems (often called childseats) for infants and small children. Anacceptable child restraint system mustalways satisfy Canadian Motor VehicleSafety Standards. Make sure that anychild-restraint system you use in yourvehicle is labelled as complying withFederal Safety Standards.The child-restraint system should bechosen to fit both the size of the child andthe size of the vehicle seat. Be sure to fol-low any instructions provided by thechild-restraint system manufacturerwhen installing the child-restraint system.

WARNING - Pregnantwomen

Pregnant women must never placethe lap portion of the safety beltover the area of the abdomen wherethe fetus is located or above theabdomen where the belt couldcrush the fetus during an impact.

WARNING - Belt cleaningDo not bleach or dye the webbingbecause this may weaken the web-bing fibers and cause them to failwhen restraining an occupant in acollision.

3 71

Features of your vehicle

Larger children As children grow, they may need to usenew child-restraint systems, includinglarger child seats or booster seats, whichare appropriate for their increased size.A child who has outgrown available child-restraint systems should use the beltsprovided in the vehicle. When seated inthe rear outboard seats, the child shouldbe restrained by the lap/shoulder belt.If the shoulder belt portion slightly touch-es the child’s neck or face, try placing thechild closer to the center of the vehicle. Ifthe shoulder belt still touches their faceor neck they need to be returned to achild restraint system. In addition, after-market devices are available from inde-pendent manufacturers which help pullthe shoulder belt down and away fromthe child’s face or neck.

WARNING - Infants andyoung children

• Infants and young children are atmuch greater risk of serious injuryor death in an accident or suddenstop if they are unrestrained orrestrained improperly. Follow allinstructions in this section and theinstructions that came with anapproved child safety system. Thechild restraint must be correctlyinstalled in the vehicle, and thechild must be correctly placed inthe child restraint.

• All children under 12 are safest inthe back seat.

• Never install a rear facing infantseat in the front passenger posi-tion. The baby will be injured orkilled by the air bag if it deploys.

• Never allow a child to stand orkneel on the seat of a moving vehi-cle.

WARNING - Shoulder beltson small children

• Never allow a shoulder belt to bein contact with a child’s neck orface while the vehicle is inmotion.

• If safety belts are not properlyworn and adjusted on children,there is a risk of death or seriousinjury.

WARNING - Children onlaps

Never hold a child on your lap or inyour arms in a moving vehicle.Even a very strong person cannothold onto a child in the event ofeven a minor collision.

WARNING - Hot metalparts

Safety belts and seats can becomehot in a vehicle that has beenclosed during warm/hot weather;they could burn a child. Check seatcovers and buckles before youplace a child anywhere near them.

Features of your vehicle

723

Pre-tensioner safety belt Your vehicle is equipped with driver's andfront passenger's pre-tensioner safetybelts. The purpose of the pre-tensioner isto make sure that excess slack is takenup in certain frontal collisions. The pre-tensioners may activate along with thefront air bags in frontal collisions basedon angle of impact, seat belt usage andimpact severity.

✽✽ NOTICEThe pre-tensioner seat belt is installed atthe front seats, and the sensor isequipped inside the buckle, where pres-ence of passenger is sensed by the fas-tening of the seat belts. Therefore, pre-tensioner will not activate if the passen-ger is not fastened with the seat belts.Likewise, it will activate if buckled evenwithout a passenger in the seat. Pre-ten-sioner seat belt is designed to activatewhen the seatbelt is in use. To ensure thepretensioner seatbelts activate in eventof a possible seatbelt buckle switch mal-function, the system is designed to acti-vate regardless of whether a seat belt isin use or if no seat belt use is detectedwithin 6 seconds of turning the ignitionswitch ON.

The seat belt pre-tensioner system con-sists mainly of the following components.Their locations are shown in the illustra-tion.(1) SRS air bag warning light(2) Seatbelt pre-tensioner assembly(3) SRS air bag control module

WARNING - Safety beltadjustment

To obtain maximum benefit from apre-tensioner seat belt:• The safety belt must be worn cor-

rectly.• The safety belt must be adjusted

to the correct position.

1LDE3100OED030300

WARNINGFor your safety, be sure that the beltwebbing is not loose or twisted andalways sit properly on your seat.

3 73

Features of your vehicle

Load limiter (if equipped)When the pre-tentioner activates, if thesystem senses excessive seat belt ten-sion on the driver or passenger’s seatbelt, the load limiter inside the pre-ten-sioner will release some of the pressureon the affected seat belt.

WARNING - Air bag/pre-tensioner warning light

If the SRS air bag warning lightdoes not illuminate when the igni-tion key is turned to “ON”, or if itremains illuminated after approxi-mately 6 seconds, or if it illuminateswhile the vehicle is being driven,please have an authorized Kia deal-er inspect the pre-tensioner and airbag system as soon as possible.

WARNING - Hot partsThe pre-tensioner assembly mecha-nism may become hot during acti-vation. Do not touch the pre-ten-sioner seat belt assembly for sever-al minutes after they have been acti-vated.

WARNING If the vehicle or pre-tensioner seatbelt must be discarded, contact anauthorized Kia dealer.

WARNING - Replacingused pre-tensioners

• Pre-tensioners are designed tooperate once. After activation,pre-tensioner seat belts must bereplaced. All seat belts, of anytype, should always be replacedafter they have been worn duringa collision.

• Do not attempt to replace the pre-tensioners yourself. This must bedone by an authorized Kia dealer.

WARNING - Damaging thepre-tensioners

• Do not hit or strike the pre-ten-sioner assemblies, especiallywith a tool or heavy object.

• Do not attempt to service orrepair the pre-tensioners.

WARNING - Air bag/Pre-tensioner dust

When the air bags and pre-tension-ers are activated, a loud noise maybe heard and fine dust, which mayappear to be smoke, may be visiblein the passenger compartment.Thisdust is not toxic. The dust maycause skin irritation and should notbe breathed for prolonged periods.Ventilate the vehicle after impactand wash your hands and face thor-oughly after an accident.

Features of your vehicle

743

We strongly recommend the use of achild seat or infant seat for small childrenand babies, and it is required by law inalmost all states. This child seat or infantseat should be of appropriate size for thechild and should be installed in accor-dance with the manufacturer's instruc-tions.Children riding in the car should sit onthe rear seat and must always be proper-ly restrained to minimize the risk of injuryin an accident, sudden stop or suddenmaneuver. According to accident statis-tics, children are safer when properlyrestrained in the rear seats than in thefront seat.Child restraint systems are designed tobe secured in vehicle seats by lap beltsor the lap belt portion of a lap/shoulderbelt or by a LATCH system (if equipped).Children could be injured or killed in acrash if their restraints are not properlysecured. For small children and babies, achild seat or infant seat must be used.Before buying a particular child restraintsystem, make sure it fits your car andseat belts, and fits your child. Follow allthe instructions provided by the childseat manufacturer when installing thechild restraint system.

CHILD RESTRAINT SYSTEM

WARNING - Childrestraints

• A child restraint system must beplaced in the rear seat. Neverinstall a child or infant seat on thefront passenger's seat.Should an accident occur andcause the passenger air bag todeploy, it could severely injure orkill an infant or child seated in thefront seat.

• Since a safety belt or childrestraint system can become veryhot if it is in a closed vehicle, besure to check the seat cover andbuckles before placing a childthere.

(Continued)

(Continued)• When the child restraint system

is not in use, store it in the lug-gage area or fasten it with a safe-ty belt so that it will not be thrownforward in the case of a suddenstop or an accident.

• Children who are too large to bein a child restraint should sit inthe rear seat and be restrainedwith the available lap/shoulderbelts.

• When using the vehicleslap/shoulder safety belts, alwaysmake sure that the shoulder beltportion is positioned midwayover the shoulder, never acrossthe neck or behind the back. Thelap belt portion of the lap/shoul-der belt must always be posi-tioned as low as possible on thechild's hips and as snug as pos-sible.

• If the vehicle’s safety belt will notproperly fit the child, you mustuse an appropriate child restraintor booster seat in the rear.

(Continued)

1JBH3051

3 75

Features of your vehicle

Installing a child restraint system For safety reasons, we recommend thatthe child restraint system be used in therear seats.

Since all passenger safety belts movefreely under normal conditions and onlylock under extreme or emergency condi-tions (emergency lock mode), you mustmanually change these safety belts tothe auto lock mode to secure a childrestraint.

WARNING - Child seatinstallation

• Before installing the childrestraint system, read the instruc-tions supplied by the childrestraint system manufacturer.

• If the safety belt does not operateas described in this section, havethe system checked immediatelyby your authorized Kia dealer.

• Failure to observe this manual'sinstructions regarding childrestraint system and the instruc-tions provided with the childrestraint system could increasethe chance and/or severity ofinjury in an accident.

WARNINGNever place a rear-facing childrestraint in the front passengerseat, because of the danger that aninflating passenger side air bagcould impact the rear-facing childrestraint and kill the child.

(Continued)• Never allow a child to stand up or

kneel while the vehicle is moving.• Never use an infant carrier or

child seat that "hooks" over aseatback. It will not provide ade-quate protection in an accident.

• Never allow a child to be heldwhile they are in a moving vehi-cle, as this could result in seriousinjury to the child in the event ofan accident or a sudden stop.Holding a child in a moving vehi-cle does not provide the childwith any protection during anaccident, even if the person hold-ing the child is wearing a seatbelt.

• After an accident, have an autho-rized KIA dealer check the childrestraint system, seat belt, tetheranchor and lower anchor.

• If there is not enough space toplace the child restraint systembecause of the driver's seat,install the child restraint systemin the rear right seat.

Features of your vehicle

763

Securing a child restraint seat Tether anchor system Child restraint hook holders are locatedon the back of the rear seat cushions.

1. Route the child restraint seat strapover the seatback.For vehicles with adjustable headrest,route the tether strap under the head-rest and between the headrest posts,otherwise route the tether strap overthe top of the seatback.

2. Connect the tether strap hook to theappropriate child restraint hook holderand tighten to secure the seat.

WARNING - Tether strapIf the tether strap is secured incor-rectly, the child restraint seat may notbe restrained properly in the event ofa collision. Do not mount more thanone child restraint seat to a tetheranchorage, since the anchorage canthen fail in a collision.

WARNING - Child restraintcheck

Check that the child restraint sys-tem is secure by pushing andpulling it in different directions.Incorrectly fitted child restraintsmay swing, twist, tip or come awaycausing death or injury.

OVQ036230R

OVQ036228N

OVQ037229N

2nd row seat

3rd row seat

3 77

Features of your vehicle

Child seat lower anchorsSome child seat manufacturers makechild restraint seats that are labeled asLATCH or LATCH-compatible childrestraint system. LATCH stands for"Lower Anchors and Tethers forChildren". These seats include two rigidor webbing mounted attachments thatconnect to two LATCH anchors at specif-ic seating positions in your vehicle. Thistype of child restraint seat eliminates theneed to use seat belts to attach the childseat in the rear seats.

LATCH anchors have been provided inyour vehicle. The LATCH anchors arelocated in the left and right outboard rearseating positions. Their locations areshown in the illustration. There is noLATCH anchor provided for the centerrear seating position.The LATCH anchors are located betweenthe seatback and the seat cushion of therear seat left and right outboard seatingpositions.

WARNING - Child restraint anchorage

• Child restraint anchorages aredesigned to withstand only thoseloads imposed by correctly fittedchild restraints. Under no circum-stances are they to be used foradult seat belts or harnesses orfor attaching other items orequipment to the vehicle.

• The tether strap may not workproperly if attached somewhereother than the correct tetheranchor.

OVQ036231NOVQ037300N-1

Features of your vehicle

783

Follow the child seat manufacturer’sinstructions to properly install childrestraint seats with LATCH or LATCH-compatible attachments.Once you have installed the LATCH childrestraint, assure that the seat is properlyattached to the LATCH and tetheranchors. Also, test the child restraint seatbefore you place the child in it. Tilt theseat from side to side. Also try to tug theseat forward. Check to see if the anchorshold the seat in place.

Placing a passenger safety beltinto the auto lock mode The use of the auto lock mode willensure that the normal movement of thechild in the vehicle does not cause thesafety belt to be pulled out and loosenthe firmness of its hold on the childrestraint system. To secure a childrestraint system, use the following proce-dure.

WARNINGIf the child restraint is not anchoredproperly, there is a significant riskof a child being seriously injured orkilled in a collision.

WARNING - LATCH loweranchors

LATCH lower anchors are only to beused with the left and right rear out-board seating positions. Neverattempt to attach an LATCHequipped seat in the center seatingposition. You may damage theanchors or the anchors may fail andbreak in a collision.

WARNINGInstall the child restraint seat fullyrearward against the seatback withthe seatback in a vertical position,not reclined.

WARNING• When using the vehicle's

"LATCH" system to install a childrestraint system in the rear seat,all unused vehicle rear seat beltmetal latch plates or tabs must belatched securely in their seat beltbuckles and the seat belt webbingmust be retracted behind thechild restraint to prevent the childfrom reaching and taking hold ofunretracted seat belts. Unlatchedmetal latch plates or tabs mayallow the child to reach the unre-tracted seat belts which mayresult in strangulation and a seri-ous injury or death to the child inthe child restraint.

• Do not place anything around thelower anchors. Also make surethat the seat belt is not caught inthe lower anchors.

CAUTIONDo not allow the rear seat belt web-bing to get scratched or pinched bythe Child-seat latch and LATCHanchor during the installation.

3 79

Features of your vehicle

Installing a child restraint system bylap/shoulder belt

To install a child restraint system on theoutboard or center rear seats, do the fol-lowing:1. Place the child restraint system in the

seat and route the lap/shoulder beltaround or through the restraint, follow-ing the restraint manufacturer’sinstructions. Be sure the safety beltwebbing is not twisted.

2. Fasten the lap/shoulder belt latch intothe buckle. Listen for the distinct “click”sound.

Position the release button so that it iseasy to access in case of an emergency.

3. Pull the shoulder portion of the safetybelt all the way out. When the shoulderportion of the safety belt is fullyextended, it will shift the retractor tothe “Auto Lock” (child restraint) mode.

E2MS103005 E2BLD310 MMSA3028

Features of your vehicle

803

4. Slowly allow the shoulder portion ofthe safety belt to retract and listen foran audible “clicking” or “ratcheting”sound. This indicates that the retractoris in the “Auto Lock” mode. If no distinctsound is heard, repeat steps 3 and 4.

5. Remove as much slack from the beltas possible by pushing down on thechild restraint system while feeding theshoulder belt back into the retractor.

6. Push and pull on the child restraintsystem to confirm that the safety belt isholding it firmly in place. If it is not,release the safety belt and repeatsteps 2 through 6.

7. Double check that the retractor is inthe “Auto Lock” mode by attempting topull more of the safety belt out of theretractor. If you cannot, the retractor isin the “Auto Lock” mode.

To remove the child restraint, press therelease button on the buckle and thenpull the lap/shoulder belt out of therestraint and allow the safety belt toretract fully.

When the safety belt is allowed toretract to its fully stowed position, theretractor will automatically switchfrom the “Auto Lock” mode to theemergency lock mode for normaladult usage.

MMSA3029 MMSA3030

WARNING - Auto lockmode

The lap/shoulder belt automaticallyreturns to the “emergency lockmode” whenever the belt is allowedto retract fully. Therefore, the pre-ceding seven steps must be fol-lowed each time a child restraint isinstalled.If the safety belt is not placed in the“Auto lock” mode, severe injury ordeath could occur to the childand/or other occupants in the vehi-cle in a collision, since the childrestraint will not be effectively heldin place.

3 81

Features of your vehicle

AIR BAG - ADVANCED SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM

Driver’s air bag Front passenger’sair bag

Curtain Air bag

SRS control module

OVQ031094N-1/1VQA2076/OVQ028077/OVQ037900N/OVQ036017N/OVQ031700/1VQA2323/1VQA2080/OVQ036096N/OVQ036095N/1VQA2081

Side air bag

Occupant classi-fication system

Front seat positionsensor

Side impact sensor

Front impact sensor

Features of your vehicle

823

(1) Driver’s air bag(2) Front passenger’s air bag(3) Side air bag*(4) Curtain Air bag*(5) Side impact sensor*(6) Front impact sensor(7) Occupant classification system (8) Front seat position sensor(9) SRS Control Module

■ Air bag inflation conditions■ Air bag non-inflation conditions■ Air bag warning light■ SRS care■ Air bag warning label

*: if equipped

What your air bag system doesDriver’s air bag and front passenger’s airbag are designed to supplement the pro-tection offered by the safety belt in cer-tain frontal collisions. Likewise, side airbag and curtain air bags are designed tosupplement the protection offered by thesafety belt in side collisions. Safety beltsare designed to reduce the injury of thedriver or passengers in case of impact orcollision. No safety belt or air bag systemcan completely eliminate injuries thatmay cause in collisions or impacts. Tohelp reduce impact on driver or passen-gers in any collision, safety belts must becorrectly worn.

What your air bag system doesnot doThe air bag system is designed to sup-plement the protection offered by thesafety belt system. IT IS NOT A SUB-STITUTE FOR THE SAFETY BELT.

The importance of using safety beltsThere are four very important reasons touse safety belts even with an air bag sup-plemental restraint system. They:• help keep you in the proper position

(away from the air bag) when it inflates.• reduce the risk of harm in rollover, side

impact (vehicles not equipped withside and curtain air bags) or rearimpact collisions, because an air bag isnot designed to inflate in such situa-tions and even a side curtain air bag isdesigned to inflate only in certain sideimpact collisions.

• reduce the risk of harm in frontal orside collisions which are not severeenough to actuate the air bag supple-mental restraint system.

• reduce the risk of being ejected fromyour vehicle.

3 83

Features of your vehicle

Occupant classification systemThe occupant classification systemdetects the presence of a passenger inthe front passenger's seat and will turn offthe front passenger's air bag under cer-tain conditions.The occupant classification system isdesigned to detect the presence of aproperly-seated occupant and determineif the front passenger's air bag should beenabled (may inflate) or not.Only the front passenger front air bag andfront passenger side air bag are con-trolled by the Occupant ClassificationSystem.

WARNING - Air bags &safety belts

• Even in vehicles with air bags,you and your passengers mustalways wear the safety belts pro-vided in order to minimize the riskand severity of injury in the eventof a collision or rollover.

• Always wear your safety belt. Itcan help keep you away from theair bags during heavy brakingjust before a collision.

• If occupants are not wearing safe-ty belts or correctly seated, theycannot be protected, and thusface serious injury or death.

• Driver’s and front passenger’s airbag are designed to inflate only incertain frontal collision, and sideand curtain air bags are designedto inflate in certain side impacts.Frontal air bags will generally notprovide protection in side impacts(vehicles not equipped with sideand curtain air bags) or rearimpacts, rollovers, less severefrontal collisions.They will not pro-vide protection from later impactsin a multi-impact collision.

(Continued)

(Continued)• If your vehicle has been subject-

ed to flood conditions (e.g.soaked carpeting/standing wateron the floor of the vehicle, etc.) orif your vehicle has become flooddamaged in any way, do notattempt to start the vehicle or putthe key in the ignition before dis-connecting the battery.Disregarding this precaution maycause air bag deployment, whichcould result in serious personalinjury or death. If your vehicle issubjected to flooded conditions,before starting the vehicle, havethe vehicle towed to an autho-rized Kia dealer for inspectionand necessary repairs.

OVQ036096N

Features of your vehicle

843

Main components of occupant classi-fication system• Detection devices located under the

front passenger seat frame.• Electronic system to determine

whether passenger air bag systems(both front and side) should be activat-ed or deactivated.

• A indicator light ocated on the instru-ment panel which illuminates the words“PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF” passen-ger air bag system is deactivated.

• The instrument panel air bag indicatorlight is interconnected with the occu-pant classification system.

If there is no passenger in the front pas-senger seat or if the passenger in thefront passenger seat is very light, (suchas a child), the front PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator may illuminate.When this indicator is ON, the front pas-senger’s air bag will not operate.If there is no passenger in the front pas-senger's seat, the PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF indicator comes on, and thesystem shuts off not only the front pas-senger's front air bag but also the frontpassenger’s side air bag.

Always be sure that you and all vehicleoccupants are seated and restrainedproperly (sitting upright with the seat inan upright position, centered on the seatcushion, with the person's legs comfort-ably extended, feet on the floor, andwearing the safety belt properly) for themost effective protection by the air bagand the safety belt.• The OCS may not function properly if

the passenger takes actions which candefeat the detection system. Theseinclude:

(1) Failing to sit in an upright position.(2) Leaning against the door or center

console.(3) Sitting towards the sides or the front

of the seat.(4) Putting legs on the dashboard or rest-

ing them on other locations whichreduce the passenger weight on thefront seat.

(5) Improperly wearing the safety belt.(6) Reclining the seat back.

OVQ038012N

3 85

Features of your vehicle

• The "PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF"indicator illuminates after the ignitionkey is turned to the "ON" position orafter the engine is started. If the frontpassenger seat is unoccupied or isoccupied by very small person, or isoccupied by someone who is improp-erly seated, the "PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF" indicator will remain illumi-nated. If the front passenger seat isoccupied by someone of adult size andbody shape, the "PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF" indicator will turn off afterapproximately 4 seconds.

• If the front passenger's seat is unoccu-pied, the “PASSENGER AIR BAGOFF” indicator will turn on, and thefront passenger's air bag will notdeploy in frontal crashes.

• If the “PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF”indicator illuminates, the front passen-ger’s air bag will not deploy in frontalcrashes.

• If the front passenger’s seat is occu-pied by a person of adult size, the“PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF” indica-tor is not illuminated and the front pas-senger’s air bag will deploy in frontalcrashes.

Condition and operation in the front passenger occupant classification system

Condition detected bythe occupant classifi-

cation system

1. Adult *1

2. Child*2 or child

restraint system

3. Unoccupied

Off

On

On

Off

Off

Off

Activated

Deactivated

"PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF" indicator

lightSRS warning light

Front passengerair bag

Deactivated

Indicator/Warning light Devices

*1 The system detects a person who is generally adult size as an adult, thus allowing the pas-senger air bag to deploy. When a smaller adult sits in the front passenger seat, the systemmay detect their body shape as that of a child, thus preventing air bag deployment.

*2 When a larger child who has outgrown a child restraint system sits in the front passenger seat,the system may recognize him/her as an adult depending on his/her body shape or seatingposition, thus permitting air bag deployment.

CAUTION If the "PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF" indicator illuminates or blinks continuous-ly when a person of adult size sits in the front passenger's seat, it could bebecause that person isn't sitting properly in the seat. If this happens, turn thevehicle off, make sure the seat back is not reclined, have the passenger cen-ter on the seat cushion, with legs comfortably extended, and the safety beltproperly positioned. Restart the vehicle and have the person remain in thisposition long enough to allow the system to detect the person and activate thepassenger air bag.

Features of your vehicle

863

WARNING• Even though your vehicle is

equipped with the occupant clas-sification system, do not install achild restraint system in the frontpassenger seat. The child couldbe severely injured or killed if theair bag deploys. Children areafforded the most protection inthe event of an accident whenthey are restrained by the properrestraint system in the rear seat.

• If the "PASSENGER AIR BAGOFF" indicator is illuminatedwhen the front passenger's seatis occupied by a person of adultsize who is seated properly, or ifthe "PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF"indicator" is not illuminated whenthe front passenger's seat isunoccupied or occupied by a verysmall person, the occupant clas-sification system is not workingproperly. Have your vehicle imme-diately inspected by your Kiadealer if the occupant classifica-tion system is not working prop-erly.

(Continued)

(Continued)• If a very low weight adult is seat-

ed in the front passenger seat, theoccupant classification systemmay or may not turn off the rightfront passenger air bag, depend-ing upon the person's seatingposition and body type. Everyonein your vehicle should wear asafety belt properly -- whether ornot there is an air bag for that per-son.

• If the front seat passengerchanges their seating position(for example, by not sittingupright, by sitting on the edge ofthe seat, or by otherwise beingout of position), the "PASSEN-GER AIR BAG OFF" indicator maybe turned on, and the passengerair bag may not deploy in a colli-sion. Always be sure to sit prop-erly in the front passenger seatand wear the safety belt properlyand do not do any of the follow-ing.

(Continued)

CAUTION If the occupant classification sys-tem is not working properly, the airbag warning light on the instrumentpanel will illuminate because thepassenger’s air bag is connectedwith the occupant classificationsystem. If there is a malfunction ofthe occupant classification system,the "PASSENGER AIR BAG OFF"indicator will not illuminate and thefront passenger's air bag will deployin either a side or frontal crasheseven if there is child or no occupantin the front passenger's seat.Have an authorized Kia dealerinspect the occupant classificationsystem with the SRS air bag systemas soon as possible if any of follow-ing occur;• The SRS air bag warning light

does not illuminate when the igni-tion key is turned to "ON" posi-tion.

• The SRS air bag warning lightremains illuminated after illumi-nating or blinking for approxi-mately 6 seconds.

• The SRS air bag warning light illu-minates while the vehicle is beingdriven.

3 87

Features of your vehicle

1KMN3663

1KMN3664

1KMN3665

- Never sit with hips shiftedtowards the front of the seat.

- Never lean on the door or centerconsole.

- Never sit on one side of the frontpassenger seat.

- Never place feet on the dash-board.

(Continued)

OVQ036013N

1KMN3662

- Never put a heavy load in thefront passenger seat or seatbackpocket.

- Never excessively recline thefront passenger seatback.

OVQ036014N

- Never place feet on the front pas-senger seatback.

(Continued)

Features of your vehicle

883

✽✽ NOTICE• If luggage or other objects are placed

on the front passenger's seat or if thetemperature of the seat changes whilethe seat is unoccupied, the "PASSEN-GER AIR BAG OFF" indicator mayblink. These conditions do not indi-cate a problem.

• Do not put heavy objects on the frontpassenger's seat. This may cause frontpassenger air bag deployment in theevent of an accident, thus increasingyour repair costs.

WARNING• The front seat passenger air bag

is much larger than the steeringwheel air bag and inflates withconsiderably more force. It canseriously hurt or kill a passengerwho is not in the proper positionand wearing the safety belt prop-erly. The front passengers shouldalways move their seat as farback as practical and sit back intheir seat.

• It is essential that the front pas-senger always wears their safetybelts, even when the vehicle ismoving in a parking lot or up a dri-veway into garage.

(Continued)

(Continued)Any other such replacement ormodification could adverselyaffect the operation of the occu-pant classification system andyour advanced air bags. For thesame reason, do not attach any-thing to the seat, dashboard ordoor, even temporarily. If the sys-tem is adversely affected, it couldcause severe personal injuries ordeath in a collision.

• Do not put a heavy load in the frontpassenger seatback pocket or onthe front passenger seat. Do nothang onto the front passengerseat. Do not hang any items suchas seatback table on the front pas-senger seatback. Do not place feeton the front passenger seatback.Do not place any items under thefront passenger seat. Any of thesecould interfere with proper sensoroperation.

(Continued)

• Kia does not endorse nor will itsupport any changes to any partor structure of the vehicle thatcould affect the advanced air bagsystem, including the occupantclassification system.Specifically, the front passengerseat, dashboard or door shouldnot be replaced except by anauthorized Kia dealer using origi-nal Kia parts designed for thisvehicle and model.

(Continued)

1KMN3666

- Always sit in a proper seatingposition.

3 89

Features of your vehicle

Air bag system components The main components of your SRS are:• To indicate that your vehicle is

equipped with air bags, the corre-sponding air bag covers are markedwith “SRS AIR BAG”.- Driver’s air bag - Passenger’s air bag - Side air bag - Curtain air bag

• A diagnostic system that continuallymonitors the system operation.

• An indicator light to warn you of a pos-sible problem with the system.

• Emergency power backup in case yourcar’s electrical system is disconnectedin a crash.

The SRS uses a collection of sensors togather information about the driver’s seatposition, the driver’s and front passenger’ssafety belt usage and impact severity.The driver’s seat position sensor, whichis installed on the seat track, determine ifthe seat is fore or aft of a reference posi-tion. Similarly, the safety belt usage sen-sors determine if the driver and front pas-senger’s safety belts are fastened. Thesesensors provide the ability to control theSRS deployment based on how close thedriver’s seat is to the steering wheel,whether or not the safety belts are fas-tened, and the severity of the impact.

(Continued)• If the driver brakes the vehicle

heavily prior to an impact, unbelt-ed occupants will be thrown for-ward. If the front passenger is notwearing the safety belts, they willbe directly in front of the storagecompartment when deploymentoccurs. In that situation, seriousinjury or death is possible.

• Never allow front passenger toput their hands, feet or face on orclose to the instrument panel. Inthe event of air bag deployment,such a mispositioned occupantwould be likely to suffer severeinjury or death.

• Never allow children, pregnantwomen or weak persons to sit inthe front passenger seat. Do notput child restraint system on thefront passenger's seat either.They may be seriously injured bythe air bag inflation when air bagdeploys.

(Continued)

(Continued)• Do not put objects or stickers on

the instrument panel. Do notapply any accessory to the frontwindshield. Do not install after-market mirrors or accessories onthe factory-installed rearview mir-ror. Any of these could interferewith the deployment of the air bagor could hit your body at highspeed and cause severe bodilyinjury and even death.

Features of your vehicle

903

The advanced SRS offers the ability tocontrol the air bag inflation with two lev-els. A first stage level is provided for mod-erate-severity impacts. A second stagelevel is provided for more severe impacts.According to the impact severity, seatingposition and safety belt usage, theSRSCM (SRS Control Module) controlsthe air bag inflation. Failure to properlywear safety belts can increase the riskor severity of injury in an accident.Additionally, your SRS is equipped withan occupant classification system in thefront passenger’s seat. The occupantclassification system detects the pres-ence of a passenger in the front passen-ger’s seat and will turn off the front pas-senger’s air bag under certain conditions.For more detail, see “OccupantClassification System” in this section.

CAUTION If the seat position sensor is notworking properly, the SRS air bagwarning light on the instrumentpanel will illuminate even if there isno malfunction of the SRS air bagsystem, because the SRS air bagwarning light is connected with theseat position sensor. If the SRS airbag warning light does not illumi-nate when the ignition key is turnedto the "ON" position, if it remainsilluminated after illuminating orblinking for approximately 6 sec-onds, or if it illuminates while thevehicle is being driven, have anauthorized Kia dealer inspect theseat position sensor and theadvanced SRS air bag system assoon as possible.

WARNING• Modification to the seat structure

can adversely affect the seatposition sensor and cause the airbag to deploy at a different levelthan should be provided.

• Failure to properly wear safetybelts can increase the risk orseverity of injury by causing theair bags to deploy at a differentlevel than should be provided.

• Do not place any objects under-neath the front seats which coulddamage the seat position sensoror interfere with the occupantclassification system.

• Do not place any objects that maycause magnetic fields near thefront seat. These may cause amalfunction of the seat positionsensor.

(Continued)

3 91

Features of your vehicle

Driver’s air bagYour vehicle is equipped with anAdvanced Supplemental Restraint (AirBag) System and lap/shoulder belts atboth the driver and passenger seatingposition.The driver’s air bag is stored in the cen-ter of the steering wheel.

(Continued)• Ignoring the SRS indicator light

(air bag indicator and passengerair bag off indicator) can result inserious or fatal injury if the airbags occupant classification sys-tem or pre-tensioners do not workproperly. Have your car checkedby a dealer as soon as possible ifthe SRS warning light alerts youto a potential problem.

• Sitting improperly or out of posi-tion can result in serious or fatalinjury in a crash. All occupantsshould sit upright in their seatswith their feet on the floor untilthe vehicle is parked and the igni-tion key is removed.

WARNING• You must always sit as far back

from the steering wheel air bag aspossible (chest at least 250 mm(10 inches) away from the steer-ing wheel), while still maintaininga comfortable seating position forgood vehicle control, in order toreduce the risk of injury or deathin a collision.

• Never place objects over the airbag storage compartments orbetween the air bags and your-self. Due to the speed and force ofthe air bag inflation, such objectscould hit your body at high speedand cause severe bodily injuryand even death.

• Do not put stickers or ornamentson the steering wheel cover.These may interfere with thedeployment of the air bag.HLZ2120

1VQA2076

Features of your vehicle

923

Front passenger’s air bagFront passenger’s air bag is stored in theinstrument panel on the glove box.Since you cannot know which air bagswill deploy or from what direction, neverput any objects or ornaments on theinstrument panel.

Side air bag (if equipped)Side air bags are stored in the left side ofthe driver’s seat, right side of the frontpassenger’s seat.If air bag inflation conditions are met(side collision), they will inflate.

OVQ028077

HLZ2121

WARNING• Do not use any accessory seat

covers for the vehicle equippedwith side air bags.Use of seat covers could interferewith side air bag deployment.If seat or seat cover is damaged,have the vehicle checked andrepaired by an authorized Kiadealer. Inform them that yourvehicle is equipped with side airbags and an occupant detectionsystem.

• Do not make modifications oradditions to the seats. If inappro-priate seats are used, unexpectedinjury may result in due to themalfunction of the air bag sys-tem.

• Do not allow the passengers tolean their heads or bodies ontodoors, put their arms on thedoors, stretch their arms out ofthe window, or place objectsbetween the doors and passen-gers when they are seated onseats equipped with side and/orcurtain air bags.

OVQ037900N

OVQ032310N

3 93

Features of your vehicle

Curtain air bag (if equipped)Curtain air bags are located along bothsides of the roof rails above the front andrear doors.It is designed to help protect the heads ofthe front seat occupants and the rear out-board seat occupants in certain sideimpact collisions.

• If the curtain air bag deploys, itremains inflated for approximately 3seconds. The curtain air bag deploy-ment occurs only on the side of thevehicle affected by the impact.

• The side air bags (side and curtain airbags) are not designed to deploy dur-ing collisions from the front or rear ofthe vehicle or in most rollover situa-tions.

• The curtain air bags are designed todeploy only during certain side-impactcollisions, depending on the crashseverity, angle, speed and impact. Thecurtain air bags are not designed todeploy in all side impact situations.

WARNING• In order for side air bags (side

and curtain air bags) to provideits best protection, both front seatoccupants and both outboardrear occupants should sit in anupright position with the seatbelts properly fastened.Importantly, children should sit ina proper child restraint system inthe rear seat.

(Continued)

(Continued)• When children are seated in the

rear outboard seats, they must beseated in the proper childrestraint system. Make sure to putthe child restraint system as faraway from the door side as possi-ble, and secure the child restraintsystem in a locked position.

• Do not allow the passengers tolean their heads or bodies ontodoors, put their arms on thedoors, stretch their arms out ofthe window, or place objectsbetween the doors and passen-gers when they are seated onseats equipped with side and/orcurtain air bags.

• Never try to open or repair anycomponents of the side curtainair bag system. This should onlybe done by an authorized Kiadealer.

Failure to follow the above men-tioned instructions can result ininjury or death to the vehicle occu-pants in an accident.

OVQ036017N

OVQ032093N

Features of your vehicle

943

Why didn’t my air bag go off in acollision? (Inflation and non-inflation conditionsof the air bag)There are many types of accidents inwhich the air bag would not be expect-ed to provide additional protection.These include rear impacts, second orthird collisions in multiple impactaccidents, as well as low speedimpacts. In other words, just becauseyour vehicle is damaged and even if itis totally unusable, don’t be surprisedthat the air bags did not inflate.

Air bag collision sensors(1) SRS control module(2) Front impact sensor

(3) Side impact sensor (if equipped)(4) Side impact sensor (if equipped)

Air bag collision sensors(1) SRS control module(2) Front impact sensor

(3) Side impact sensor (if equipped)(4) Side impact sensor (if equipped)

OVQ031902N-1/1VQA2081/1VQA2080/OVQ031700/1VQA2323

3 95

Features of your vehicle

Air bag inflation conditionsFront air bag Front air bags are designed to inflatewhen the impact is delivered to front col-lision sensors depending on the intensity,speed or angles of impact of the frontcollision - generally from an area a littleto the left to a little to the right of straightahead.

1VQA2084

WARNING• Do not hit or allow any objects to

impact the locations where air bagor sensors are installed.This may cause unexpected airbag deployment, which couldresult in serious personal injuryor death.

• If the installation location orangle of the sensors is altered inany way, the air bags may deploywhen they should not or they maynot deploy when they should,causing severe injury or death.Therefore, do not try to performmaintenance on or around the airbag sensors. Have the vehiclechecked and repaired by anauthorized Kia dealer.

(Continued)

(Continued)• Problems may arise if the sensor

installation angles are changeddue to the deformation of frontbumper, body or B/C pillar whereside collision sensors areinstalled. Have the vehiclechecked and repaired by anauthorized Kia dealer.

• Your vehicle has been designedto absorb impact and deploy theair bag(s) in certain collisions.Installing aftermarket bumperguards or replacing a bumperwith non-genuine parts mayadversely affect your vehiclescollision and air bag deploymentperformance.

Features of your vehicle

963

Side air bags (if equipped)Side air bags (side and/or curtain airbags) are designed to inflate when animpact is detected by side collision sen-sors depending on the strength, speed orangles of impact of side impact of sideimpact collision or rollover.

Although the front air bags (driver’s andfront passenger’s air bags) are designedto inflate only in frontal collision, it mayinflate in any collision if front impact sen-sors detect a sufficient impact. Side airbags (side and/or curtain air bags) aredesigned to inflate only in side impactcollision, it may inflate in any collision ifside impact sensors detect a sufficientimpact.If the vehicle chassis is impacted bybumps or objects on unimproved roadsor sidewalks, air bags may deploy. Drivecarefully on unimproved roads or on sur-faces not designed for vehicle traffic toprevent unintended air bag deployment.To protect occupants, front air bags orpre-tensioner seat belts may deploy incertain side impact collisions.

Air bag non-inflation conditions• In certain low-speed collisions the air

bags may not deploy. The air bags aredesigned not to deploy in such casesbecause the risk of injuries which canbe caused by the air bags exceeds thebenefits they provide in protectingoccupants.

OVQ036018N

OVQ032016N

1VQA2086

3 97

Features of your vehicle

• Frontal air bags are not designed toinflate in rear collisions, because occu-pants are moved backward by theforce of the impact. In this case, the airbags do not provide proper protection.

• Front air bags may not inflate in sideimpact collision, because occupantsmove to the direction of the collision,and thus in side impacts, frontal air bagdeployment does not provide occupantprotection.However, side or curtain air bags mayinflate depending on the intensity, vehi-cle speed and angles of impact.

• In a slant or angled collision, the forceof impact may direct the occupants in adirection between the front and side airbags, and thus the sensors may notdeploy any air bags.

1VQA2089OVQ036018NOUN036087

Features of your vehicle

983

• Just before impact, drivers often brakeheavily. Such heavy braking lowers thefront portion of the vehicle causing it to“ride” under a vehicle with a higherground clearance. Air bags may notinflate in this "under-ride" situationbecause deceleration forces that aredetected by sensors may be signifi-cantly altered by such “under-ride” col-lisions.

• Air bags may not inflate in rollover acci-dents because air bag deploymentwould not provide proper protection tothe occupants.However, side air bags may inflatewhen the vehicle is rolled over by aside impact collision, if the vehicle isequipped with side air bags and cur-tain air bags.

• Air bags may not inflate if the vehiclecollides with objects such as utilitypoles or trees, where the point ofimpact is concentrated to one area andthe full force of the impact is not deliv-ered to the sensors.

1VQA2090 1VQA2091 1VQA2092

3 99

Features of your vehicle

Air bag system operation• Air bag only operates when the ignition

switch is turned to the ON or STARTpositions.

• Air bags inflate instantly in the event ofserious frontal or side collision (ifequipped with side air bag or curtainair bag) in order to help protect theoccupants from serious physical injury.

• There is no single speed at which theair bags will inflate.Generally, air bags are designed toinflate by the severity of a collision andits direction. These two factors deter-mine whether the sensors send out anelectronic deployment/inflation signal.

• Air bag deployment depends on anumber of factors including vehiclespeed, angles of impact and the densi-ty and stiffness of the vehicles orobjects which your vehicle hits in thecollision. However, factors are not limit-ed to those mentioned above.

• The front air bags will completelyinflate and deflate in an instant.It is virtually impossible for you to seethe air bags inflate during an accident.It is much more likely that you will sim-ply see the deflated air bags hangingout of their storage compartments afterthe collision.

• In order to help provide protection in asevere collision, the air bags mustinflate rapidly. The speed of air baginflation is a consequence of theextremely short time in which a collisionoccurs and the need to get the air bagbetween the occupant and the vehiclestructures before the occupant impactsthose structures. This speed of inflationreduces the risk of serious or life-threatening injuries in a severe collisionand is thus a necessary part of air bagdesign.However, air bag inflation can alsocause injuries which normally caninclude facial abrasions, bruises andbroken bones, and sometimes moreserious injuries because that inflationspeed also causes the air bags toexpand with a great deal force.

• There are even circumstancesunder which contact with the steer-ing wheel air bag can cause fatalinjuries, especially if the occupantis positioned excessively close tothe steering wheel.

Features of your vehicle

1003

Noise and smokeWhen the air bags inflate, they make aloud noise and they leave smoke andpowder in the air inside of the vehicle.This is normal and is a result of the igni-tion of the air bag inflator. After the airbag inflates, you may feel substantial dis-comfort in breathing due to the contact ofyour chest to both the safety belt and theair bag, as well as from breathing thesmoke and powder. We strongly urgeyou to open your doors and/or win-dows as soon as possible after impactin order to reduce discomfort and pre-vent prolonged exposure to thesmoke and powder.Though smoke and powder are non-toxic, it may cause irritation to the skin(eyes, nose and throat etc). If this is thecase, wash and rinse with the cold waterimmediately and consult the doctor if thesymptom persists.

WARNING - Seated positioning

• Driver should sit as far back (atleast 250 mm (10 inches) away)from the steering wheel air bag aspossible to reduce the risk ofinjury or death in a collision. Thefront passenger should alwaysmove their seat as far back aspossible and sit back in theirseat.

• Air bag inflates instantly in anevent of collision, passengersmay be injured by the air bagexpansion force if they are not inproper position.

• Air bag inflation may causeinjuries which normally includefacial or bodily abrasions, injuriesby the broken glasses or burns bythe explosives.

WARNINGWhen the air bags deploy, the airbag related parts in steering wheeland/or instrument panel and/or inboth sides of the roof rails abovethe front and rear doors are veryhot. To prevent injury, do not touchthe air bag storage areas internalcomponents immediately after anair bag has inflated.

3 101

Features of your vehicle

Installing a child restraint on afront passenger’s seat is forbid-den.Never place a rear-facing child restraintin the front passenger’s seat. If the airbag deploys, it would impact the rear-fac-ing child restraint, causing serious orfatal injury.In addition, do not place front-facing childrestraint in the front passenger’s seateither. If the front passenger air baginflates, it would cause serious or fatalinjuries to the child.

Air bag warning lightThe purpose of the air bag warning lightin your instrument panel is to alert you ofa potential problem with your air bag -Supplemental Restraint System (SRS).When the ignition switch is turned ON,the indicator light should blink or illumi-nate for approximately 6 seconds, thengo off.Have the system checked if:• The light does not turn on briefly when

you turn the ignition ON.• The light stays on after the engine

starts.• The light comes on while the vehicle is

in motion.

1JBH3051

WARNING• Never put child restraint in the

front passenger’s seat. If the frontpassenger air bag inflates, itwould cause serious or fatalinjuries.

• When children are seated in therear outboard seats in which sideair bags are equipped, be sure toput the child restraint system asfar away from the door side aspossible, and secure the childrestraint system to be locked inposition.Inflation of side or curtain air bagcould cause serious injury ordeath due to the expansionimpact.

W7-147

Features of your vehicle

1023

SRS careYour Supplemental Restraint System isvirtually maintenance-free. There are noparts which you can service.You must have the system servicedunder the following circumstances:• If an air bag ever inflates, the air bag

must be replaced. Do not try to removeor discard the air bag by yourself. Thismust be done by an authorized Kiadealer.

• If the air bag warning indicator lightalerts you to a problem, have the airbag system checked as soon as possi-ble. Otherwise, your air bag systemmay be ineffective.

When repairing or scrapping thevehicles • Repairing steering wheel, instrument

panel, center console or roofs, orinstalling car audio around center con-sole or painting front metal sheet coulddisable the air bag system. Have themchecked by an authorized Kia dealer.

• When leaving the vehicle at an autho-rized Kia dealer, inform the facility thatthe vehicle is equipped with air bagsystem, and leave the owner’s manualin the vehicle.

• Since air bag system contains explo-sive chemical substances, contact anauthorized Kia dealer when scrappingthe vehicle.

WARNING - No mainte-nance or repair

• Do not modify your steeringwheel, seat or any other part ofthe Supplemental RestraintSystem. Modification could makethe system inoperable.

• Do not work on the system’s com-ponents or wiring. This couldcause the air bags to inflate inad-vertently, possibly seriously injur-ing someone.Working on the sys-tem could also disable the sys-tem so that the air bags would notdeploy in a collision.

• Any work on the SRS system,such as removing, installing,repairing, or any work on thesteering wheel must be per-formed by a qualified Kia techni-cian. Improper handling of the airbag system may result in seriouspersonal injury or death.

WARNING - No modifica-tion

Do not modify any part of the airbag system. Modification couldmake the air bag system ineffectiveor could cause unnecessarydeployment.

3 103

Features of your vehicle

Air bag warning labelAir bag warning labels which are now required by the Canadian Motor Vehicle Safety Standard (CMVSS) are attached to alert dri-ver and passengers of potential risk of air bag system.Note that these government warnings focus on the risk to children, Kia also wants you to be aware of the risks which adults areexposed to. Those have been described in previous pages.

OVQ039411/OVQ039020N/1VQA2096

(if equipped)

Features of your vehicle

1043

Power steeringPower steering uses energy from theengine to assist you in steering the vehi-cle. If the engine is off or if the powersteering system becomes inoperative,the vehicle may still be steered, but it willrequire increased steering effort.Should you notice any change in theeffort required to steer during normalvehicle operation, have the power steer-ing checked by an Authorized Kia Dealer.

✽✽ NOTICEIf the vehicle is parked for extendedperiods outside in cold weather (below -10 °C/14 °F), the power steering mayrequire increased effort when the engineis first started. This is caused byincreased fluid viscosity due to the coldweather and does not indicate a mal-function.When this happens, increase the engineRPM by depressing accelerator until theRPM reaches 1,500 rpm then release orlet the engine idle for two or three min-utes to warm up the fluid.

STEERING WHEEL

CAUTION• Never hold the steering wheel

against a stop (extreme right orleft turn) for more than 5 secondswith the engine running. Holdingthe steering wheel for more than5 seconds in either position maycause damage to the power steer-ing pump.

• If the power steering drive beltbreaks or if the power steeringpump malfunctions, the steeringeffort will greatly increase.

3 105

Features of your vehicle

Tilt steering A tilt steering wheel allows you to adjustthe steering wheel before you drive. Youcan also raise it to the highest level togive your legs more room when you exitand enter the vehicle.

The steering wheel should be positionedso that it is comfortable for you to drive,while permitting you to see the instru-ment panel warning lights and gauges.

To change the steering wheel angle, pullup the lock release lever (1), adjust thesteering wheel to the desired angle (2),then release the lock-release lever tolock the steering wheel in place. Be sureto adjust the steering wheel to thedesired position before driving.

WARNING • Never adjust the angle of the

steering wheel while driving. Youmay lose your steering controland cause an accident that givesrise to severe personal injury ordeath.

• After adjusting, push the steeringwheel both up and down to becertain it is locked in position.

OVQ036021N

Features of your vehicle

1063

Outside rearview mirror Be sure to adjust mirror angles beforedriving.Your vehicle is equipped with both left-hand and right-hand outside rearviewmirrors. The mirrors can be adjustedremotely with the remote switch. The mir-ror heads can be folded back to preventdamage during an automatic car wash orwhen passing in a narrow street.

Folding the outside rearview mirrorTo fold outside rearview mirror, grasp thehousing of mirror and then fold it towardthe rear of the vehicle.

MIRRORS

WARNING - Rearview mir-rors

• The right outside rearview mirroris convex. Objects seen in themirror are closer than theyappear.

• Use your interior rearview mirroror direct observation to deter-mine the actual distance of fol-lowing vehicles when changinglanes.

CAUTIONDo not scrape ice off the mirrorface; this may damage the surfaceof the glass. If ice should restrictmovement of the mirror, do notforce the mirror for adjustment. Toremove ice, use a deicer spray, or asponge or soft cloth with very warmwater.

OVQ040110CAUTIONIf the mirror is jammed with ice, donot adjust the mirror by force. Usean approved spray de-icer (not radi-ator antifreeze) to release thefrozen mechanism or move thevehicle to a warm place and allowthe ice to melt.

3 107

Features of your vehicle

Outside rearview mirror heater (if equipped) The outside rearview mirror heater isactuated in connection with the rear win-dow defroster. To heat the outsiderearview mirror glass, push the button forthe rear window defroster.The rearview mirror heater (and rear win-dow defroster) will not operate unless theengine is running.The outside rearview mirror glass will beheated for defrosting or defogging andwill give you improved rear vision ininclement weather conditions. Push thebutton again to turn the heater off. Theoutside rearview mirror heater automati-cally turns off after 20 minutes.

Electric remote control The electric remote control mirror switchallows you to adjust the position of theleft and right outside rearview mirrors. Toadjust the position of either mirror, movethe lever (1) to R or L to select the rightside mirror or the left side mirror, thenpress a corresponding point ( ) on themirror adjustment control to position theselected mirror up, down, left or right.After adjustment, put the lever into neu-tral position to prevent the inadvertentadjustment.

CAUTION• The mirrors stop moving when

they reach the maximum adjust-ing angles, but the motor contin-ues to operate while the switch isdepressed. Do not depress theswitch longer than necessary, themotor may be damaged.

• Do not attempt to adjust the out-side rearview mirror by hand.Doing so may damage the parts.

1VQA2108

Features of your vehicle

1083

Inside rearview mirror Adjust the rearview mirror to center onthe view through the rear window. Makethis adjustment before you start driving.

Day/night rearview mirrorMake this adjustment before you startdriving and while the day/night lever is inthe day position.Pull the day/night lever toward you toreduce glare from the headlights of vehi-cles behind you during night driving.Remember that you lose some rearviewclarity in the night position.

Electric chromic mirror (ECM)(if equipped)The electric rearview mirror automatical-ly controls the glare from the headlightsof the car behind you in nighttime or lowlight driving conditions. The sensormounted in the mirror senses the lightlevel around the vehicle, and through achemical reaction, automatically controlsthe headlight glare from vehicles behindyou.When the engine is running, the glare isautomatically controlled by the sensormounted in the rearview mirror.Whenever the shift lever is shifted intoreverse (R), the mirror will automaticallygo to the brightest setting in order toimprove the drivers view behind the vehi-cle.

WARNING - Rear visibilityDo not place objects in the rear seator cargo area which would interferewith your vision out the rear win-dow.

CAUTIONWhen cleaning the mirror, use apaper towel or similar materialdampened with glass cleaner. Donot spray glass cleaner directly onthe mirror as that may cause the liq-uid cleaner to enter the mirror hous-ing.

OVQ028105

Day

Night

Day/Night lever

WARNING Do not adjust the rearview mirrorwhile the vehicle is moving. Thiscould result in loss of control, andan accident which could causedeath, serious injury or propertydamage.

WARNING Do not modify the inside mirror anddo not install a wide mirror. It couldresult in injury, during an accidentor deployment of the air bag.

3 109

Features of your vehicle

Type ATo operate the electric rearview mirror• The mirror defaults to the ON position

whenever the ignition switch is turnedon.

• Press the ON/OFF button (1) to turnthe automatic dimming function off.The mirror indicator light will turn off.Press the ON/OFF button (1) to turnthe automatic dimming function on.The mirror indicator light will illuminate.

Type BTo operate the electric rearview mirror• The mirror defaults to the ON position

whenever the ignition switch is turnedon.

• Press the ON/OFF button (1) to turnthe automatic dimming function offunless vehicle is in reverse.The mirror indicator light will turn off.Press the ON/OFF button (1) to turnthe automatic dimming function onunless vehicle is in reverse.The mirror indicator light will illuminate.

• Press the ON/OFF button (1) to turnrearview display off while vehicle is inreverse,.Press the ON/OFF button (1) to turnrearview display on while vehicle is inreverse.

1KMA3084 OVQ020601N

Rearview display

Indicator Sensor

Features of your vehicle

1103

Type CTo operate the electric rearview mirror(with homelink wireless control sys-tem)Press the I button (1) to turn the auto-matic- dimming function on. The mirrorindicator light will illuminate.Press the O button (2) to turn the auto-matic- dimming function off. The mirrorindicator light will turn off.

Type DTo operate the electric rearview mirror(with homelink wireless control sys-tem, rearview display and compass)• The mirror defaults to the ON position

whenever the ignition switch is turnedon.

• Press the ON/OFF button (1) to turnthe automatic dimming function offunless vehicle is in reverse.The mirror indicator light will turn off.

• Press the ON/OFF button (1) to turnthe automatic dimming function onunless vehicle is in reverse.The mirror indicator light will illuminate.

• Press the ON/OFF button (1) to turnrearview display off while vehicle is inreverse.Press the ON/OFF button (1) to turnrearview display on while vehicle is inreverse.

OVQ036025N OVQ032360N

Rearview display

Compass display

3 111

Features of your vehicle

Compass (if equipped)To operate Compass featurePress and release the button (2), thenthe vehicle's directional heading will bedisplayed.Pressing and releasing the button againwill turn off the display.

Heading display- E : East- W : West- S : South- N : Northex) NE : North East

Calibration procedurePress and hold the button (2) between 9and 12 seconds. Release the buttonwhen a "C" appears in the display, whichindicates the compass needs calibration.1. Driving the vehicle in a circle at less

than 8km/h 2 times or until the com-pass heading appears.

2. Driving in a circle in right-handeddirection and opposite direction arepossible, and if the calibration is com-pleted, the compass heading willappear.

3. Keep driving in a circle until a compassheading appears.

Setting the compass zone1.Determine the desired Zone Number

based upon your current location onthe Zone Maps below.

2.Press and hold the button (2) for morethan 6 but less than 9 seconds, thecurrent Zone Number will appear onthe display.

3.Pressing and holding the button (2)again will cause the numbers to incre-ment (Note: they will repeat …13, 14,15, 1, 2, …). Releasing the buttonwhen the desired Zone Numberappears on the display will set the newZone.

4.Within about 5 seconds the compasswill start displaying a compass headingagain.

Features of your vehicle

1123

Re-calibrating the Compass.There are some conditions that cancause changes to the vehicle's magneticfield. Items such as installing a ski rack ora CB antenna or even some body repairwork on the vehicle can cause changesto the vehicle's magnetic field. In thesesituations, the compass will need to bere-calibrated to quickly correct for thesechanges. To re-calibrate the compass:1.Press and hold the button (2) between

9 and 12 seconds. Release the buttonwhen a "C" appears in the display,which indicates the compass needscalibration.

2.To re-calibrate the compass, drive thevehicle is 2 complete circles at lessthan 5 MPH.

B520C05NF

3 113

Features of your vehicle

Conversation mirrorThe mirror is a convenient feature to helpthe front passenger talk with rear pas-sengers without turning the head or bodyrearward.To use the mirror, push the cover andopen it.Adjust mirror angle to the desired posi-tion.Close the cover after use.

WARNINGDo not adjust the mirror angle ortalk with rear passengers for a longtime while driving. You may loseyour steering control and causesevere personal injury or accidents.

OVQ028107

Features of your vehicle

1143

INSTRUMENT CLUSTER

1. Tachometer 2. Turn signal indicators3. Speedometer4. Engine temperature gauge5. Warning and indicator lights6. Shift position indicator

(Automatic transaxle only)7. Odometer/Trip odometer8. Fuel gauge

OVQ030026C/OVQ030027C

■■ Type A

■■ Type B

3 115

Features of your vehicle

Speedometer The speedometer indicates the forwardspeed of the vehicle.

Odometer/Trip odometerYou can choose the odometer, tripodometer A and trip odometer B bypressing the reset button.

* : if equipped

OdometerThe odometer indicates the total dis-tance the vehicle has been driven.

GAUGES

OVQ036404N OVQ039032N

odometer ➝ TRIP A➝ TRIP B

ECOMINDERTM INDICATOR (ECO ON/OFF)*

OVQ021124

Features of your vehicle

1163

Trip odometerTRIP A: Trip odometer ATRIP B: Trip odometer BThe trip odometer indicates the distanceof individual trips selected by the driver.Trip odometer A and B can be reset to 0by pressing the reset button for 1 secondor more, and then releasing.

ECOMINDERTM INDICATOR ECO ON/OFF mode (if equipped)You can turn the ECOMINDERTM indica-tor (which is identified on your instrumentdashboard by the “ECO” name) on/off onthe instrument cluster in this mode.If you push the TRIP button more than 1second in the ECOMINDERTM indicatorECO ON mode, then ECO OFF is dis-played in the screen and the ECO indica-tor turns off.If you want to display the ECOMINDERTM

indicator ECO again, press the TRIP but-ton more than 1 second in the ECO OFFmode and then ECO ON mode is dis-played in the screen.When you press the TRIP button lessthan 1 second in the ECO mode, themode is changed to odometer.

Tachometer The tachometer indicates the approxi-mate number of engine revolutions perminute (rpm).Use the tachometer to select the correctshift points and to prevent lugging and/orover-revving the engine.The tachometer pointer may move slight-ly when the ignition switch is in ACC orON position with the engine OFF. Thismovement is normal and will not affectthe accuracy of the tachometer once theengine is running.

CAUTIONDo not operate the engine withinthe tachometer's RED ZONE.This may cause severe engine dam-age.

OVQ036406NOVQ020125OVQ021125

3 117

Features of your vehicle

Engine temperature gauge This gauge shows the temperature of theengine coolant when the ignition switchis ON.Do not continue driving with an overheat-ed engine. If your vehicle overheats, referto “Overheating” in the Index.

Fuel gaugeThe fuel gauge indicates the approxi-mate amount of fuel remaining in the fueltank.Fuel tank capacity : 80 liters (21 US gallons)The fuel gauge is supplemented by a lowfuel warning light, which will illuminatewhen the fuel tank is nearly empty.

OVQ036033N

WARNING - Fuel gaugeRunning out of fuel can exposevehicle occupants to danger.You must stop and obtain addition-al fuel as soon as possible after thewarning light comes on or when thegauge indicator comes close to theE level.

CAUTIONAvoid driving with a very low fuellevel. If you run out of fuel, it couldcase the engine to misfire andresult in excessive loading of thecatalytic converter.

CAUTIONIf the gauge pointer moves beyondthe normal range area toward the“H” position, it indicates overheat-ing that may damage the engine.

OVQ039031N

Features of your vehicle

1183

Instrument panel illumination(if equipped)When the vehicle’s parking lights or head-lights are on, rotate the illumination con-trol knob to adjust the instrument panelillumination intensity.The instrument cluster (Type B) illumina-tion intensity can be adjusted by rotatingthe control knob with the headlight switchin any position when the ignition switch isin ON position.

1VQA2126

3 119

Features of your vehicle

The trip computer is a microcomputer-controlled driver information system thatdisplays information related to driving,including compass, distance to empty,driving time, average fuel consumptionand outside temperature on the displaywhen the ignition switch is in ON posi-tion. All stored driving information is resetif the battery is disconnected.

Mode selectionThe compass is always displayed untilthe display is turned off.Push the MODE button to select distanceto empty, driving time, average fuel con-sumption and outside temperature func-tions.

Compass (if equipped)The vehicle compass displays the direc-tion the vehicle is heading.Heading display- E : East- W : West- S : South- N : Northex) NE : North East

✽✽ NOTICEIf new vehicle is first driven, performcalibration procedure as follows.

TRIP COMPUTER (IF EQUIPPED)

OVQ020318Driving time (ET)

Average fuel consumption(AVG)

Outside temperature

OFF

Distance to empty (RANGE)

1VQA2211

Features of your vehicle

1203

Calibration procedureThe compass may not indicate the cor-rect compass direction when you are dri-ving in certain areas (tunnel, parkinggarage, underground parking lot, neartransformer substation, etc.), and the fol-lowing may occur:• The compass headings become inac-

curate.• The compass heading doesn't change

when the vehicle changes direction.• Some compass headings are not dis-

played.• The compass headings are inaccurate

in long distance driving.If the vehicle's compass headingsbecome inaccurate continuously, thecompass should be manually calibratedas follows:

1. Move the vehicle away from any largesteel structures or power generatingcables or equipment.

2. Check the terrestrial deviation anglevalue by pressing and holding theMODE button for 4.5 seconds until thecurrent terrestrial deviation anglevalue appears in the display.

3. If the terrestrial deviation angle valueis different for your country, set the cor-rect angle referring to “Setting thecompass zone” and perform the“Calibration procedure” again.

4. Make sure the vehicle windshieldwipers are turned off.

5. Press and hold the MODE buttonagain for 2~4.5 seconds until the “turn”appears and “DIR” blinks in the displayand release the button.

6. Drive your vehicle in at least 1 com-plete (either clockwise or counter-clockwise) circle at less than 5 km/h (3mph) within 10 minutes until the com-pass heading appears.

7. If the vehicle’s compass headingsbecome inaccurate again, repeatsteps 1 through 6 above.

✽✽ NOTICEIf you press the MODE button beforethe calibration is completed or the vehi-cle is not rotated within 10 minutes after“turn” appears and “DIR” blinks, thecorrection will be cancelled.

1VQA2316

3 121

Features of your vehicle

Setting the compass zoneThis compass must be set to compen-sate for the variation between true northand magnetic north. To set variation:1. Find your current location and terres-

trial deviation angle value on the zonemap.

2. Press and hold the MODE button for4.5 seconds. The current terrestrialdeviation angle value will appear in thedisplay.

3. Release the MODE button and pressthe RESET button repeatedly until thecorrect terrestrial deviation angle valuefor your location appears in the display.

4. Press and hold the MODE button formore than 1 second, and then the dis-play will show a compass direction.

✽✽ NOTICEIf you press the MODE button for lessthan 1 second before new compass zoneis set, the correction is cancelled.Also, if the correction is not completedwithin 30 seconds, the current terrestri-al deviation angle value will blink for 2seconds and the correction is cancelled.

✽✽ NOTICE1. Do not install a ski rack, antenna, etc.

that is attached to the vehicle using amagnet as anything attached to theroof of the vehicle with a magnet willeffect compass operation.

2. If the compass deviates from the cor-rect indication after repeated adjust-ment, have the compass checked at anauthorized dealer.

3. The compass may not indicate thecorrect compass point in tunnels orwhile driving up or down a steep hill.

(The compass returns to the correctcompass point when the vehicle movesto an area where the geomagnetism isstabilized.)

1VQA2317

Features of your vehicle

1223

Compass zone map

3 123

Features of your vehicle

Distance to empty (“RANGE”shown on display)This mode indicates the estimated dis-tance to empty based on the current fuelin the fuel tank and the amount of fueldelivered to the engine. When theremaining distance is below 50 km (30miles), a blinking “----” symbol will be dis-played.The meter’s working range is from 50 to1500 km (30 to 1500 miles).

✽✽ NOTICE• If the vehicle is not on level ground or

the battery power has been interrupt-ed, the “Distance to empty” functionmay not operate correctly.The trip computer may not registeradditional fuel if less than 6 liters (1.6gallons) of fuel are added to the vehi-cle.

• The fuel consumption and distance toempty values may vary significantlybased on driving conditions, drivinghabits, and condition of the vehicle.

• The distance to empty value is an esti-mate of the available driving distance.This value may differ from the actualdriving distance available.

Driving time (“ET” shown on dis-play)This mode indicates the total time trav-eled since the last driving time reset.Even if the vehicle is not in motion, thedriving time keeps going while the engineis running.The meter’s working range is from0:00~99:59.Pressing the RESET button for less than4 seconds, when the driving time is beingdisplayed, clears the driving time to zero.

OVQ020320OVQ020319

Features of your vehicle

1243

Average fuel consumption (“AVG”shown on display)This mode calculates the average fuelconsumption from the total fuel used andthe distance since the last average con-sumption reset. The total fuel used is cal-culated from the fuel consumption input.For an accurate calculation, drive morethan 500 m (0.3 miles).The meter's working range is from 0.0 to99.9 l/100 km (0.0 to 99.9 miles per gal-lon).Pressing the RESET button for less than4 seconds, when the average fuel con-sumption is being displayed, clears theaverage fuel consumption to “- -” until thevehicle is moved to 500 m (0.3 miles).

Outside temperatureThis mode indicates the outside temper-ature around the vehicle.The meter’s working range is from -40°C to 60°C (-40°F~140°F).

Unit conversionThe unit on each mode can be changedby pushing the RESET button for morethan 4 seconds as follows:• Distance to empty: km ↔ MI• Average fuel consumption: l/100km ↔

MPG• Outside temperature: °C ↔ °FThe units on the mode of distance toempty and average fuel consumption arechanged together. However, the outsidetemperature mode display units arechanged separately.

OVQ020323OVQ020321 OVQ020322

3 125

Features of your vehicle

Checking operation All warning lights are checked by turningthe ignition switch ON (do not start theengine). Any light that does not illuminateshould be checked by an Authorized KiaDealer.After starting the engine, check to makesure that all warning lights are off. If anyare still on, this indicates a situation thatneeds attention. When releasing theparking brake, the brake system warninglight should go off. The fuel warning lightwill stay on if the fuel level is low.

ECOMINDERTM indica-tor (if equipped)

The ECOMINDERTM indicator is a systemthat illuminates “ECO” when the driverhas reached optimum fuel efficiency.• The ECOMINDERTM indicator will turn

the ECO light green on the instrumentpanel when you are driving fuel effi-ciently in the ECO ON mode.If you don't want the indicator dis-played, you can turn the ECO ONmode to OFF mode by pressing theTRIP button.For ECO ON/OFF Mode operation,please refer to the previous page.

• Fuel efficient driving can be influencedby driving habits and road conditions.

• The indicator will not display while in P(Park), N (Neutral) or R (Reverse).

WARNINGS AND INDICATORS

ECOMINDERTM WARNINGDon't keep watching the “ECO”ECOMINDERTM indicator while dri-ving. It may distract you while dri-ving and cause an accident thatcould result in severe personalinjury.

ECO

Features of your vehicle

1263

Air bag warning light

This warning light will illuminate forapproximately 6 seconds each time youturn the ignition switch to the ON posi-tion.If this indicator does not go out, or if it illu-minates while the vehicle is being driven,see an authorized Kia Dealer for immedi-ate service.

Anti-lock brake system(ABS) warning light

This light illuminates if the key is turnedto ON and goes off in approximately 3seconds if the system is operating nor-mally.If the light stays on, you may have aproblem with your ABS system. Contactan authorized Kia dealer as soon as pos-sible.

Electronic brake forcedistribution (EBD) sys-tem warning light

If two warning lights illumi-nate at the same time whiledriving, your vehicle has aproblem with ABS and EBDsystem.In this case, your ABS system and regu-lar brake system may not work normally.Have the vehicle checked by anAuthorized Kia Dealer as soon as possi-ble.

Safety belt warning light

If the driver's safety belt is not fastenedwhen the key is turned ON or if it isunfastened after the key is turned ON,the safety belt warning light blinks untilthe belt fastened.

Safety belt warning chime (if equipped)If the driver's safety belt is not fastenedwhen the ignition key is turned ON or if itis unfastened after the key is ON, thesafety belt warning chime will sound forapproximately 6 seconds. At this time, ifthe safety belt is fastened, the chime willstop at once.

High beam indicator

This indicator illuminates when the head-lights are on and in the high beam posi-tion or when the turn signal lever is pulledinto the Flash-to-Pass position.

WARNINGIf the both ABS and Brake warninglights are ON and stay ON, yourvehicle’s brake system will not worknormally. So you may experience anunexpected and dangerous situa-tion during sudden braking. In thiscase, avoid high speed driving andabrupt braking. Have your vehiclechecked by Authorized Kia Dealeras soon as possible.

3 127

Features of your vehicle

Engine oil pressurewarning

This warning light indicates the engine oilpressure is low.If the warning light illuminates while dri-ving:1. Drive safely to the side of the road and

stop.2. With the engine off, check the engine

oil level. If the level is low, add oil asrequired.

If the warning light remains on afteradding oil or if oil is not available, call anAuthorized Kia Dealer.

Parking brake & brakefluid warning Parking brake warning This light is illuminated when the parkingbrake is applied with the ignition switch inthe START or ON position. The warninglight should go off when the parkingbrake is released while engine is run-ning.Low brake fluid level warningIf the warning light remains on, it mayindicate that the brake fluid level in thereservoir is low.If the warning light remains on:1. Drive carefully to the nearest safe

location and stop your vehicle.2. With the engine stopped, check the

brake fluid level immediately and addfluid as required. Then check all brakecomponents for fluid leaks.

3. Do not drive the vehicle if leaks arefound, the warning light remains on orthe brakes do not operate properly.Have it towed to any Authorized KiaDealer for a brake system inspectionand necessary repairs.

To check bulb operation, check whetherthe parking brake and brake fluid warninglight illuminates when the ignition switchis in the ON position.

Parking start warning chimeIf you drive over 10 km/h (6 mph) with theparking brake applied, the parking startwarning chime will sound.

Front fog light indicator(if equipped)

This light comes on when the front foglights are ON.

Shift pattern indicators(if equipped)

The individual indicators illuminate toshow the automatic transaxle shift leverselection.

CAUTIONIf the engine is not stopped imme-diately after the engine oil pressurewarning light is illuminated, severedamage could result.

WARNINGDriving the vehicle with a warninglight on is dangerous. If the brakewarning light remains on, have thebrakes checked and repaired imme-diately by an authorized Kia Dealer.

Features of your vehicle

1283

Taillight indicator (if equipped)

This light comes on when the taillightsare ON.

Charging system warning

This warning light indicates a malfunctionof either the generator or electricalcharging system.If the warning light comes on while thevehicle is in motion:1. Drive to the nearest safe location.2. With the engine off, check the genera-

tor drive belt for looseness or break-age.

3. If the belt is adjusted properly, a prob-lem exists somewhere in the electricalcharging system. Have an AuthorizedKia Dealer correct the problem assoon as possible.

Tailgate openwarning light

This warning light comes on when thetailgate is not closed securely.

Door ajar warning light

This warning light illuminates when adoor is not closed securely with the igni-tion in any position.

Door ajar warning chime If a door or tailgate is opened while dri-ving the vehicle over 10 km/h (6 mph),the warning chime will sound.

Immobilizer indicator (if equipped)

This light illuminates when the immobiliz-er key is inserted and turned to the ONposition to start the engine.At this time, you can start the engine.Thelight goes out after the engine is running.If this light blinks when the ignition switchis in the ON position before starting theengine, have the system checked by anauthorized Kia Dealer.

Low fuel level warning

This warning light indicates the fuel tankis nearly empty. When it comes on, youshould add fuel as soon as possible.Driving with the fuel level warning light onor with the fuel level below “E” can causethe engine to misfire and damage thecatalytic converter.

3 129

Features of your vehicle

Malfunction indicatorlamp (MIL) (checkengine light)This indicator light is part of the EngineControl System which monitors variousemission control system components. Ifthis light illuminates while driving, it indi-cates that a potential problem has beendetected somewhere in the emissioncontrol system.Generally, your vehicle will continue to bedrivable, but have the system checked byan authorized Kia Dealer promptly.

✽✽ NOTICE A loose fuel filler cap may cause the OnBoard Diagnostic System MalfunctionIndicator Light ( ) in the instrumentpanel to illuminate unnecessarily.Always make sure that the fuel filler capis tight.

Low washer fluid levelwarning indicator(if equipped) This warning light indicates the washerfluid reservoir is near empty. Refill thewasher fluid as soon as possible.

ESC indicator (Electronic StabilityControl) (if equipped)The ESC indicator will illuminate whenthe ignition switch is turned ON, butshould go off after approximately 3 sec-onds. When the ESC is on, it monitorsthe driving conditions and under normaldriving conditions, the ESC indicator willremain off. When a slippery or low trac-tion condition is encountered, the ESCwill operate, and the ESC indicator willblink to indicate the ESC is operating. Ifthe ESC system malfunctions the indica-tor illuminates and stays on. Take yourvehicle to an authorized KIA dealer andhave the system checked.

ESC OFF indicator (if equipped)

The ESC OFF indicator will illuminatewhen the ignition switch is turned ON,but should go off after approximately 3seconds. To switch to ESC function off,press the ESC OFF button. The ESCOFF indicator will illuminate indicatingthe ESC is deactivated.

CAUTION• Prolonged driving with the

Emission Control SystemMalfunction Indicator Light ( ) illuminated may causedamage to the emission controlsystems which could effect dri-vability and/or fuel economy.

• If the Emission Control SystemMalfunction Indicator Light ( )Illuminates, potential catalyticconverter damage is possiblewhich could result in loss ofengine power. Have the EngineControl System inspected as soonas possible by an authorized KiaDealer.

ESC

ESCOFF

Features of your vehicle

1303

Cruise indicator (if equipped)CRUISE indicator

The indicator light illuminates when thecruise control system is enabled.

Cruise SET indicator

The indicator light illuminates when thecruise function switch (COAST/SET orRES/ACCEL) is ON.

Lights on warning chimeThe lights on warning chime will sound ifthe headlight switch is left in the 1st or2nd position and the driver’s door isopened.

Key reminder warning chimeIf the driver’s door is opened while theignition key is left in the ignition switch(ACC or LOCK position), the keyreminder warning chime will sound. Thisis to prevent you from locking your keysin the vehicle.

CRUISE

SET

3 131

Features of your vehicle

INTERIOR LIGHTS

1VQA2141

1VQA2140

Main control switch

Map light

OFF Any ON OFF

Close ON OFF*2)

ON ( ) Any

Map lights operating logic

Main controlswitch status

Door open/close status

DOOR

Open orClose ➜ Open ON

Lamp turns ON, then turns OFF afterabout 20 minutes*1)

Open ➜ Close ON

ON

Lamp dims gradually overa 5-second period*3)

Map light switchON (depressed) DOOR (not depressed)

*1) If other door is opened while the light stays off after about 20 minutes, the light stays onagain for about 20 minutes.

*2) When a door is unlocked by the transmitter, the light stays on for about 30 seconds as longas any door is not opened. When the ignition switch is turned to the ACC or LOCK position,the light stays on for about 15 seconds.

*3) If the ignition switch is turned to the ON position, the light turns off immediately.

Map lightThe lights are turned ON or OFF based on the status of the doors, main control switchand corresponding light switch.

WARNINGDo not use the interior lights whendriving in the dark. Accidents couldhappen because the view may beobscured by interior lights.

Features of your vehicle

1323

1VQA2141

1VQA2333

Main control switch

OFF Any

Close ON OFF*2) OFF

ON ( ) Any

Dome lights operating logic

Main controlswitch status

Door open/close status

DOOR

Open orClose ➜ Open ON

ON

OFF

OFF

Lamp turns ON, then turns OFFafter about 20

minutes*1)

Lamp dimsgradually over

a 5-secondperiod*3)

Open ➜ Close

OFF

ON

Dome light switchON DOOR OFF

*1) If other door is opened while the light stays off after about 20 minutes, the light stays onagain for about 20 minutes.

*2) When a door is unlocked by the transmitter, the light stays on for about 30 seconds as longas any door is not opened. When the ignition switch is turned to the ACC or LOCK position,the light stays on for about 15 seconds.

*3) If the ignition switch is turned to the ON position, the light turns off immediately.

Dome lightThe lights are turned ON or OFF based on the status of the doors, main control switchand corresponding light switch.

1VQA2142/OUN026245Dome light - center (if equipped)

Dome light - center/rear (if equipped)• Type A • Type B

3 133

Features of your vehicle

1VQA2141

1VQA2311

Main control switch

Tailgate light

Open ON OFFClose

ON ( ) Any

Tailgate light operating logic

Main control switch status

Tailgate open/close status

DOOR

OFF

Open orClose ➜ Open

Lamp turns ON, then turns OFF after

about 20 minutesOFF

Close orOpen ➜ Close OFF

ON

OFF

Tailgate light switch

DOOR OFF

Tailgate light The lights are turned ON or OFF based on the status of the tailgate, main controlswitch and corresponding light switch.

Features of your vehicle

1343

Door courtesy lamp (if equipped)The door courtesy lamp comes ON whenthe door is opened to assist entering orexiting the vehicle. It also serves as awarning to passing vehicles that the vehi-cle door is open.

Glove box lampThe glove box lamp comes ON when theglove box is opened.The parking lights or headlights must beON for the glove box lamp to function.

LIGHTING

Battery saver function • The purpose of this feature is to pre-

vent the battery from being dis-charged. The system automaticallyturns off the parking lights when thedriver removes the ignition key andopens the driver- side door.

• With this feature, the parking lights willbe turned off automatically if the driverparks on the side of road at night.If necessary, to keep the lights onwhen the ignition key is removed, per-form the following :1) Open the driver-side door.2) Turn the parking lights OFF and ON

again using the light switch on thesteering column.

OVQ036041N

OVQ036042N

Front

RearOVQ036043N

CAUTIONIf the driver gets out of the vehiclethrough other doors (except dri-ver's door), the battery saver func-tion does not operate. Therefore, itcauses the battery to be dis-charged. In this case, make sure toturn off the lamp before getting outof the vehicle.

3 135

Features of your vehicle

Rescue mode functionIf your vehicle has any problem on thevehicle network system, the headlights(low beam) and parking lights turn onautomatically with the ignition switch inthe ON position even though the head-light switch is not turned on. At this time,the emergency lighting is not turned offwhen the headlight switch is turned off.

Lighting controlThe light switch has a Headlight and aParking light position.To operate the lights, turn the knob at theend of the control lever to one of the fol-lowing positions:(1) OFF position(2) Parking light position(3) Headlight position

Parking light position ( )When the light switch is in the parkinglight position (1st position), the tail, posi-tion, license and instrument panel lightsare ON.

CAUTIONIf the rescue mode occurs, haveyour vehicle checked by an autho-rized Kia dealer as soon as possi-ble.

OVQ041129 OVQ041130

Features of your vehicle

1363

Headlight position ( )When the light switch is in the headlightposition (2nd position) the head, tail,position, license and instrument panellights are ON.

✽✽ NOTICEThe ignition switch must be in the ONposition to turn on the headlights.

High - beam operation To turn on the high beam headlights,push the lever away from you. Pull it backfor low beams.The high-beam indicator will light whenthe headlight high beams are switchedon.To prevent the battery from being dis-charged, do not leave the lights on for aprolonged time while the engine is notrunning.

Flashing headlights To flash the headlights, pull the levertowards you. It will return to the normal(low-beam) position when released. Theheadlight switch does not need to be onto use this flashing feature.

OVQ041131 OVQ041134 OVQ041132

3 137

Features of your vehicle

Turn signals (A)The ignition switch must be on for theturn signals to function. To turn on theturn signals, move the lever up or down.Green arrow indicators on the instrumentpanel indicate which turn signal is oper-ating. They will self-cancel after a turn iscompleted. If the indicator continues toflash after a turn, manually return thelever to the OFF position.

Lane change signals (B)To signal a lane change, move the turnsignal lever slightly and hold it in position.The lever will return to the OFF positionwhen released.If an indicator stays on and does notflash or if it flashes abnormally, one of theturn signal bulbs may be burned out andwill require replacement.

✽✽ NOTICEIf an indicator flash is abnormally quickor slow, bulb may be burned out or havea poor electrical connection in the cir-cuit.

Front fog light (if equipped) Fog lights are used to provide improvedvisibility and avoid accidents when visibil-ity is poor due to fog, rain or snow etc.The fog lights will turn on when fog lightswitch (1) is turned to ON after the head-light is turned on.To turn off the fog lights, turn the switchto OFF.

OVQ041133

CAUTIONWhen in operation, the fog lightsconsume large amounts of vehicleelectrical power. Only use the foglights when visibility is poor orunnecessary battery and generatordrain could occur.

OVQ041135

Features of your vehicle

1383

Daytime running light (if equipped)Daytime Running Lights (DRL) can makeit easier for others to see the front of yourvehicle during the day. DRL can be help-ful in many different driving conditions,and it is especially helpful after dawn andbefore sunset.The DRL system will make your high-beam headlights turn OFF when:1. The head light switch is ON.2. The parking brake engaged.3. Engine stops.

A : Wiper speed control· MIST – Single wipe· OFF – Off· INT/AUTO – Intermittent wipe or

AUTO control wipe · LO – Low wiper speed· HI – High wiper speed

B : Intermittent or Auto control wipetime adjustment

C : Wash with brief wipes

D : Rear wiper/washer control· – Spraying washer fluid· OFF – Off · INT – Intermittent wipe (if equipped)· ON – Continuous wipe· – Wash with brief wipes

OKM040900N/OKM040901N

Windshield wiper/washer

Rear window wiper/washer (if equipped)

WIPERS AND WASHERS

3 139

Features of your vehicle

Windshield wipers Operates as follows when the ignitionswitch is turned ON.MIST: For a single wiping cycle, push the

lever upward and release it withthe lever in the OFF position. Thewipers will operate continuously ifthe lever is pushed upward andheld.

OFF : Wiper is not in operationINT : Wiper operates intermittently at

the same wiping intervals. Usethis mode in a light rain or mist. Tovary the speed setting, turn thespeed control knob (1).

LO : Normal wiper speedHI : Fast wiper speed

✽✽ NOTICEIf there is heavy accumulation of snowor ice on the windshield, defrost thewindshield for about 10 minutes, oruntil the snow and/or ice is removedbefore using the windshield wipers toensure proper operation.

Auto control (if equipped)The rain sensor located on the upper endof windshield glass senses the amount ofrainfall and controls the wiping cycle forthe proper intervals. The more it rains,the faster the wiper operates. When therain stops, the wiper stops. To vary thespeed setting, turn the speed controlknob (1).If the wiper switch is set in AUTO modewhen the ignition switch is ON, or thespeed control knob is turned toward theupward position when the wiper switch isin AUTO mode, wiper will operate once toperform a self-check of the system. Setthe wiper to OFF position when the wiperis not in use.

OVQ038052N-1OKM040902N

Features of your vehicle

1403

Variable intermittent wipersSet the lever to the INT/AUTO positionand choose the desired wiper interval byturning the ring(1).

One - touch wiper For a single wiping cycle, push the leverupward and release it with the lever in theOFF position.The wipers will operate continuously ifthe lever is pushed upward and held.

CAUTIONWhen the ignition switch is ON andthe windshield wiper switch isplaced in the AUTO mode, use cau-tion in the following situations toavoid any injury to the hands orother parts of the body:• Do not touch the upper end of the

windshield glass facing the rainsensor.

• Do not wipe the upper end of thewindshield glass with a damp orwet cloth.

• Do not put pressure on the wind-shield glass.

CAUTIONWhen washing the vehicle, set thewiper switch in the OFF position tostop the auto wiper operation.Wiper may operate and be damagedif the switch is set in AUTO modewhile washing vehicle.Do not remove the sensor coverlocated on the upper end of the pas-senger side windshield glass.Damage to system parts couldoccur and may not be covered byyou vehicle warranty.When the starting the vehicle in win-ter, set the wiper switch in the OFFposition. Otherwise, wipers mayoperate and ice may damage thewindshield wiper blades. Alwaysremove all snow and ice and defrostthe windshield properly prior tooperating the windshield wipers.

CAUTION• To prevent possible damage to

the wipers or windshield, do notoperate the wipers when thewindshield is dry.

• To prevent damage to the wiperblades, do not use gasoline,kerosene, paint thinner, or othersolvents on or near them.

• To prevent damage to the wiperarms and other components, donot attempt to move the wipersmanually.

3 141

Features of your vehicle

Windshield washers In the OFF position, pull the lever gentlytoward you to spray washer fluid on thewindshield and to run the wipers 1-3cycles.Use this function when the windshield isdirty.

The spray and wiper operationwill continue until you release thelever.If the washer does not work, check thewasher fluid level. If the fluid level is notsufficient, you will need to add appropri-ate non-abrasive windshield washer fluidto the washer reservoir.The reservoir filler neck is located in thefront of the engine compartment on thepassenger side.

Rear window wiper and washerswitch (if equipped)The rear window wiper and washerswitch is located at the end of the wiperand washer switch lever. Turn the switchto desired position to operate the rearwiper and washer.

- Spraying washer fluid and wipingOFF - Wiper is not in operationINT - Intermittent wiper operation ON - Normal wiper opertion

- Wash with brief wipes

CAUTIONTo prevent possible damage to thewasher pump, do not operate thewasher when the fluid reservoir isempty.

WARNINGDo not use the washer in freezingtemperatures without first warmingthe windshield with the defrosters;the washer solution could freeze oncontact with the windshield andobscure your vision.

OKM040903N OKM040904N

Features of your vehicle

1423

To sound the horn, press the horn sym-bol on your steering wheel.Check the horn regularly to be sure itoperates properly.

The defroster heats the window toremove frost, fog and thin ice from theinterior and exterior of the rear window,while engine is running.

To activate the rear window defroster,press the rear window defroster buttonlocated in the center console switchpanel. The indicator on the rear windowdefroster button illuminates when thedefroster is ON.If there is heavy accumulation of snow onthe rear window, brush it off before oper-ating the rear defroster.The rear window defroster automaticallyturns off after 20 minutes or when theignition switch is turned off. To turn off thedefroster, press the rear windowdefroster button again.

HORN

CAUTION• To sound the horn, press the area

indicated by the horn symbol onyour steering wheel (see illustra-tion). The horn will operate onlywhen this area is pressed.

• Do not strike the horn severely tooperate it, or hit it with your fist.Do not press on the horn with asharp-pointed object.

OVQ036055N

DEFROSTER

OVQ049343

OVQ049344

Type A

Type B

CAUTION• To prevent damage to the con-

ductors bonded to the inside sur-face of the rear window, never usesharp instruments or windowcleaners containing abrasives toclean the window.

• If you want to defrost and defogon the front windshield, refer to“Windshield Defrosting andDefogging” in this section.

3 143

Features of your vehicle

Outside mirror defroster (if equipped)If your vehicle is equipped with the out-side mirror defroster, it will be operatingat the same time when you operate therear window defroster.

Front windshield deicer(if equipped)The engine must be running to enablethis feature. To activate the front wind-shield deicer, press the front windshielddeicer button. The indicator on the buttonilluminates when the deicer is ON. Thefront windshield deicer automaticallyturns off after 20 minutes or when theignition switch is turned off. To turn off thedeicer, press the front windshield deicerbutton again.

The hazard warning flasher causes thefront and rear turn signal lights to flashon and off, which serves as a warning toother drivers to exercise caution whenapproaching or passing your vehicle.To activate the flasher, depress the haz-ard warning flasher switch. This switchoperates in any ignition switch position.To turn the flashers off, depress theswitch again.

HAZARD WARNING FLASHER

OVQ049031

OVQ049032

Type A

Type B

❈ The location of the front windshield deicerbutton may be different depending on yourmodel.

OVQ041030L

Features of your vehicle

1443

MANUAL CLIMATE CONTROL SYSTEM (IF EQUIPPED)

OVQ049301/OVQ049304/OVQ049305

1. Front temperature control knob

2. Rear temperature control knob*

3. Front fan speed control knob

4. Air conditioning button*

5. Rear window defroster button

6. Mode selection knob

7. Air intake control button

8. Rear climate control selection button*or Outside (fresh) air position button

9. Rear fan speed control knob*

*: if equipped

Type A

Type B

Type C

3 145

Features of your vehicle

Front fan speed control knob The ignition switch must be in the ONposition for fan operation.The fan speed control knob allows you tocontrol the fan speed of the air flowingfrom the ventilation system. To changethe fan speed, turn the knob to the rightfor higher speed or left for lower speed.To turn off the fan, turn the knob to theOFF (0) position.

Temperature control knobThe temperature control knob allows youto control the temperature of the air flow-ing from the ventilation system. Tochange the air temperature in the pas-senger compartment, turn the knob tothe WARM (red) position for warm andhot air or COOL (blue) position for cool-er air.

Mode selection knob The mode selection knob controls thedirection of the air flow through the venti-lation system.

OVQ049306 OVQ049307 OVQ049308

Features of your vehicle

1463

Outlet port locations

MAX/ A/C position (if equipped)When you select the MAXA/C mode while the fanspeed is on, the followingsystem settings will be madeautomatically;• the air conditioning system

will be turned on.• the recirculated air position

will be selected.• the face mode will be

selected.If you select MAX A/C mode,you will not be able to cancelthe A/C system operation, orchange the recirculated airmode position.Set the fan speed controlknob to the desired speedand rotate the temperaturecontrol knob to the COOL(blue) position for maximumcooling. (outlet port : B, E)

1VQA2147

MAXA/C

3 147

Features of your vehicle

Face position Air flow is directed toward theupper body and face.Additionally, each outlet canbe controlled to direct the airdischarged from the outlet.(outlet port: B, E)

Face - floor position Air flow is directed towardsthe face and the floor.(outlet port: B, C, E, F)

Floor position Most of the air flow is direct-ed to the floor, with a smallamount of the air beingdirected to the windshieldand side window defroster.(outlet port: A, C, D, E, F)

Floor - defrost position Most of the air flow is direct-ed to the floor and the wind-shield with a small amountdirected to the side windowdefrosters.(outlet port: A, C, D, E, F)

Defrost position Most of the air flow is directedto the windshield with a smallamount of air directed to theside window defrosters.(outlet port: A, D, E) Instrument panel vents

If air flow control is not satisfactory, checkthe instrument panel vents. The outletport (B, E) can be opened or closed sep-arately using the horizontal thumbwheel.To close the vent, rotate it left to the max-imum position. To open the vent, rotate itright to the desired position.Also, you can adjust the direction of airdelivery from these vents using the ventcontrol lever as shown.

1VQA2148

Features of your vehicle

1483

Air intake control button This is used to select outside (fresh) airposition or recirculated air position.To change the air intake control position,push the control button.

Recirculated air position With the recirculated airposition selected, air frompassenger compartmentwill be drawn through theheating system and heatedor cooled according to thefunction selected.

Outside (fresh) air position With the outside (fresh) airposition selected, air entersthe vehicle from outside andis heated or cooled accord-ing to the function selected.

OVQ049309

3 149

Features of your vehicle

✽✽ NOTICEIt should be noted that prolonged oper-ation of the heating in recirculated airposition will cause fogging of the wind-shield and side windows and the airwithin the passenger compartment willbecome stale.In addition, prolonged use of the airconditioning with the “recirculated airposition” selected, will result in exces-sively dry air in the passenger compart-ment.

Air conditioning button (if equipped) Push the A/C button to turn the air condi-tioning system on (indicator light will illu-minate). Push the button again to turn theair conditioning system off.

WARNING• Continued climate control system

operation in the recirculated airposition may allow humidity toincrease inside vehicle whichmay fog the glass and obscurevisibility.

• Do not sleep in a vehicle with airconditioning or heating systemon. It may cause serious harm ordeath due to a drop in the oxygenlevel and/or body temperature.

• Continued climate control systemoperation in the recirculated airposition can cause drowsiness orsleepiness, and loss of vehiclecontrol. Set the air intake controlto the outside (fresh) air positionas much as possible while driv-ing.

OVQ049310

Features of your vehicle

1503

Rear climate control (if equipped)To turn on the rear climate control sys-tem;From the front seat1. Set the rear climate control selection

(REAR CONTROL) button in the frontclimate control panel to the OFF posi-tion. (if equipped)

2. Set the rear fan speed control knob inthe front climate control panel to thedesired position.

3. Set the rear temperature control knobin the front climate control panel to thedesired position. (if equipped)

4. The rear mode is controlled accordingto the front mode control. (if equippedwith both of the rear heater and airconditioner)If not equipped with either of the rearheater or air conditioner, rear air blowsonly from one side of lower or uppervents.

5. To turn on the rear air conditioningsystem (if equipped), turn on the airconditioning button in the front climatecontrol panel.

OVQ049311/1VQA2168/OVQ049312

■ Front

■ Rear (if equipped)

Type A Type B

1. Rear fan speed control knob (from front seat)

2. Rear temperature control knob* (from front seat)

3. Rear climate control selection button*(from front seat)

4. Rear fan speed control knob* (from rear seat)

5. Rear mode selection button* (from rear seat)

6. Rear temperature control button*(from rear seat)

*: if equipped

3 151

Features of your vehicle

From the rear seat (if equipped)1. Set the rear climate control selection

(REAR CONTROL) button in the frontclimate control panel to the ON posi-tion.

2. Set the rear fan speed control knob onthe rear climate control panel to thedesired position.

3. Set the rear temperature control knobon the rear climate control panel to thedesired position. (if equipped)

4. Select the desired rear mode buttonon the rear climate control panel. (ifequipped)If not equipped with either of the rearheater or air conditioner, rear air blowsonly from one side of lower or uppervents.

5. To turn on the rear air conditioningsystem (if equipped), turn on the airconditioning button in the front climatecontrol panel.

Rear fan speed controlFrom front seatSet the rear climate control selection(REAR CONTROL) button (if equipped)to the OFF position and turn the rear fanspeed control (REAR) knob in the frontclimate control panel to the desired posi-tion.To change the rear fan speed, turn theknob to the right for higher speed or leftfor lower speed.Setting the knob to the OFF(0) positionturns off the rear fan.

From rear seat (if equipped)Set the rear climate control selection(REAR CONTROL) button in the front cli-mate control panel to the ON positionand turn the rear fan speed control knobon the rear control panel to the desiredposition.To change the rear fan speed, turn theknob to the right for higher speed or leftfor lower speed.Setting the knob to the OFF(0) positionturns off the rear fan.

OVQ049313 OVQ049314

Features of your vehicle

1523

Rear temperature control (if equipped)From front seatSet the rear climate control selection(REAR CONTROL) button (if equipped)to the OFF position and turn the reartemperature control (REAR TEMP) knobin the front climate control panel to thedesired position.To change the rear air temperature, turnthe knob to the WARM (red) position forwarm and hot air or COOL (blue) posi-tion for cooler air.

From rear seat (if equipped)Set the rear climate control selection(REAR CONTROL) button in the front cli-mate control panel to the ON positionand turn the rear temperature controlknob on the rear control panel to thedesired position.To change the rear air temperature, turnthe knob to the right for warmer air or leftfor cooler air.

Rear mode selection (if equipped)When the rear climate control selection(REAR CONTROL) button in the front cli-mate control panel is in the OFF positionor the button is not equipped, the rearmode is controlled automatically depend-ing on the mode of the front climate con-trol as follows:

OVQ049315 OVQ049316

OVQ028338

1VQA2174

with rear air conditioner

with rear heater

3 153

Features of your vehicle

• Front climate control is MAX A/C, :Rear air blows from the upper vents onthe rear ceiling.

• Front climate control is :Rear air blows from the upper vents onthe rear ceiling and the lower vents onthe right rear trim together.

• Front climate control is , , :Rear air blows from the lower vents onthe right rear trim.

❇ If the rear air conditioner is notequipped, rear air blows only from thelower vents.

❇ If the rear heater is not equipped, rearair blows only from the upper vents.

When the rear climate control selection(REAR CONTROL) button in the front cli-mate control panel is in the ON position,the rear mode is selected by pushing therear mode selection button on the rearcontrol panel as follows:• : Rear air blows from the upper

vents on the rear ceiling.• : Rear air blows from the upper

vents on the rear ceiling and thelower vents on the right rear trimtogether.

• : Rear air blows from the lowervents on the right rear trim.

Rear vents (if equipped)The vent can be adjusted by rotating theblade.

✽✽ NOTICEIf all the vents are closed, it may causesome noise. Always open 2 vents ormore.

OVQ049317 OVQ028339

Features of your vehicle

1543

System operationVentilation1. Set the mode to the position.2. Set the air intake control to the outside

(fresh) air position.3. Set the temperature control to the

desired position.4. Set the fan speed control to the

desired speed.

Heating1. Set the mode to the position.2. Set the air intake control to the outside

(fresh) air position.3. Set the temperature control to the

desired position.4. Set the fan speed control to the

desired speed.5. If dehumidified heating is desired, turn

the air conditioning system (ifequipped) on.

• If the windshield fogs up, set the modeto the , position.

Air conditioning (if equipped) All Kia Air Conditioning Systems arefilled with environmentally friendly R-134a refrigerant which is not damag-ing to the ozone layer.1. Start the engine. Push the air condi-

tioning button.2. Set the mode to the position.3. Set the air intake control to the outside

air or recirdulation air position.4. Set the temperature control to the

desired position.5. Set the fan speed control to the

desired speed.6. Adjust the fan speed control and tem-

perature control to maintain maximumcomfort.

• When maximum cooling is desired, setthe temperature control to the COOL(blue) position, set the air intake con-trol to the recirculated air position, thenset the fan speed control to the highestspeed.

CAUTION• When using the air conditioning

system, monitor the temperaturegauge closely while driving uphills or in heavy traffic when out-side temperatures are high. Airconditioning system operationmay cause engine overheating.Continue to use the blower fanbut turn the air conditioning sys-tem off if the temperature gaugeindicates engine overheating.

• When opening the windows inhumid weather air conditioningmay create water droplets insidethe vehicle. Since excessivewater droplets may cause dam-age to electrical equipment, airconditioning should only be runwith the windows closed.

3 155

Features of your vehicle

Air conditioning system opera-tion tips • If the vehicle has been parked in direct

sunlight during hot weather, open thewindows for a short time to let the hotair inside the vehicle escape.

• To help reduce moisture inside of win-dows on rainy humid days, decreasethe humidity inside the vehicle by oper-ating the air conditioning system.

• During air conditioning system opera-tion, you may occasionally notice aslight change in engine speed as theair conditioning compressor cycles on.This is a normal system operationcharacteristic.

• Use the air conditioning system everymonth if only for a few minutes toensure maximum system perform-ance.

• When using the air conditioning sys-tem, you may notice clear water drip-ping (or even puddling) on the groundunder the passenger side of the vehi-cle. This is a normal system operationcharacteristic.

• Operating the air conditioning systemin the recirculated air position doesprovide maximum cooling, however,continual operation in this mode maycause the air inside the vehicle tobecome stale.

Checking the amount of air con-ditioner refrigerant and compres-sor lubricantWhen the amount of refrigerant is low,the performance of the air conditioning isreduced. Overfilling also has a bad influ-ence on the air conditioning system.Therefore, if abnormal operation isfound, have the system inspected by anauthorized Kia dealer.

CAUTIONWhen the performance of the airconditioning system is reduced it isimportant that the correct type andamount of oil and refrigerant isused. Otherwise, damage to thecompressor and abnormal systemoperation may occur.

CAUTIONThe air conditioning system shouldbe serviced by an authorized Kiadealer. Improper service may causeserious injury.

Features of your vehicle

1563

AUTOMATIC CLIMATE CONTROL SYSTEM (IF EQUIPPED)

1. AUTO (automatic control) button

2. Driver’s temperature control button

3. A/C display

4. Passenger’s temperature control button

5. Dual temperature control selection button

6. Front fan speed control knob

7. OFF button

8. Mode selection button

9. Air conditioning button

10. Front windshield defrost button

11. Rear window defrost button

12. Recirculated air position button

13. Rear climate control selection button

14. Rear temperature control button*

15. Rear fan speed control knob

*: if equipped

Type A

OVQ049320/OVQ049321

Type B

3 157

Features of your vehicle

Automatic operationThe automatic climate control system iscontrolled by simply setting the desiredtemperature.The Full Automatic Temperature Control(FATC) system automatically controls theheating and cooling system as follows;

1. Push the AUTO button. It is indicatedby AUTO on the display. The modes,fan speeds, air intake and air-condi-tioning will be controlled automaticallyby temperature setting.

2. Push the TEMP button to set thedesired temperature.If the temperature is set to the lowestsetting LO (17°C/62°F), the air condi-tioning system will operate continu-ously.

3. To turn the automatic operation off,press any button except temperaturecontrol button. If you press the modeselection button, air-conditioning but-ton, defrost button, air intake controlbutton or fan speed knob, the selectedfunction will be controlled manuallywhile other functions operate automat-ically.

Regardless of the temperature setting,when using automatic operation, the airconditioning system can automaticallyturn on to decrease the humidity insidethe vehicle, even if the temperature is setto warm.

OVQ049322 OVQ049156

CAUTIONNever place anything over the sen-sor located on the instrumentpanel to ensure better control of theheating and cooling system.

Features of your vehicle

1583

Manual operation The heating and cooling system can becontrolled manually as well by pushingbuttons other than the AUTO button. Inthis case, the system works sequentiallyaccording to the order of buttons select-ed.When pressing any button except AUTObutton while automatic operation, thefunctions of the buttons not selected willbe controlled automatically.Press the AUTO button in order to con-vert to full automatic control of the sys-tem. Temperature control button

The temperature will increase to themaximum 32°C/90°F (HI) by pushing theup button. Each push of the button willcause the temperature to increase by0.5°C/1°F.The temperature will decrease to the mini-mum 17°C/62°F (LO) by pushing the downbutton. Each push of the button will causethe temperature to decrease by 0.5°C/1°F.When set to the lowest temperature set-ting, the air conditioning will operate con-tinuously.

Dual temperature control selec-tion buttonAdjusting the driver and passenger sidetemperature individually 1. Press the DUAL button to operate the

driver and passenger side temperatureindividually. Pressing the right temper-ature control button will automaticallyswitch to the DUAL mode as well.

2. Press the left temperature control toadjust the driver side temperature.Press the right temperature control toadjust the passenger side tempera-ture.

OVQ049323 OVQ049324

3 159

Features of your vehicle

Adjusting the driver and passenger sidetemperature equally1. Press the DUAL button again to deac-

tivate DUAL mode. The passengerside temperature will be set to thesame as the driver side temperature.

2. Press the left temperature control but-ton. The driver and passenger sidetemperature will be adjusted equally.

Temperature conversionIf the battery has been discharged or dis-connected, the temperature mode dis-play will reset to Centigrade.This is normal condition and you canswitch the temperature mode betweenCentigrade to Fahrenheit as follows;While depressing the AUTO button,depress the OFF button for 3 seconds ormore. The display will change fromCentigrade to Fahrenheit, or fromFahrenheit to Centigrade.

Front fan speed control knobThe fan speed can be set to the desiredspeed by turning the fan speed controlknob.The higher the fan speed is, the more airis delivered.Pressing the OFF button turns off thefan.

Air intake control button This is used to select outside (fresh) airposition or recirculated air position.To change the air intake control position,push the control button.

OVQ049325 OVQ049326

Features of your vehicle

1603

Recirculated air positionWith the recirculated air posi-tion selected, air from pas-senger compartment will bedrawn through the heatingsystem and heated or cooledaccording to the functionselected.

Outside (fresh) air positionWith the outside (fresh) airposition selected, air entersthe vehicle from outside andis heated or cooled accordingto the function selected.

✽✽ NOTICEIt should be noted that prolonged oper-ation of the heating in recirculated airposition will cause fogging of the wind-shield and side windows and the airwithin the passenger compartment willbecome stale.In addition, prolonged use of the airconditioning with the “recirculated airposition” selected, will result in exces-sively dry air in the passenger compart-ment.

WARNING• Continued climate control system

operation in the recirculated airposition may allow humidity toincrease inside vehicle whichmay fog the glass and obscurevisibility.

• Do not sleep in a vehicle with airconditioning or heating systemon. It may cause serious harm ordeath due to a drop in the oxygenlevel and/or body temperature.

• Continued climate control systemoperation in the reciruclated airposition can cause drowsiness orsleepiness, and loss of vehiclecontrol. Set the air intake controlto the outside (fresh) air positionas much as possible while driving.

3 161

Features of your vehicle

Mode selection buttonThe mode selection button controls thedirection of the air flow through the venti-lation system.The air flow outlet port is converted asfollows:

Outlet port locations1VQA2147

OVQ049327

Features of your vehicle

1623

Face position Air flow is directed toward theupper body and face.Additionally, each outlet canbe controlled to direct the airdischarged from the outlet.(outlet port: B, E)

Face - floor position Air flow is directed towardsthe face and the floor.(outlet port: B, C, E, F)

Floor position Most of the air flow is direct-ed to the floor, with a smallamount of the air beingdirected to the windshieldand side window defroster.(outlet port: A, C, D, E, F)

Floor - defrost position Most of the air flow is direct-ed to the floor and the wind-shield with a small amountdirected to the side windowdefrosters.(outlet port: A, C, D, E, F)

Defrost button Most of the air flow is directed to thewindshield with a small amount of airdirected to the side window defrosters.(outlet port: A, D, E)

OVQ049328

3 163

Features of your vehicle

Instrument panel ventsIf air flow control is not satisfactory, checkthe instrument panel vents. The outletport (B, E) can be opened or closed sep-arately using the horizontal thumbwheel.To close the vent, rotate it left to the max-imum position. To open the vent, rotate itright to the desired position.Also, you can adjust the direction of airdelivery from these vents using the ventcontrol lever as shown.

Air conditioning button Push the A/C button to turn the air condi-tioning system on (indicator light will illu-minate).Push the button again to turn the air con-ditioning system off.

OFF buttonPush the OFF button to turn off the air cli-mate control system. However you canstill operate the mode and air intake but-tons as long as the ignition switch is ON.

1VQA2148 OVQ049329 OVQ049330

Features of your vehicle

1643

Rear climate control (if equipped)To turn on the rear climate control sys-tem;From the front seat1. Set the rear climate control selection

(REAR) button in the front climate con-trol panel to the OFF position.

2. Set the rear fan speed control knob inthe front climate control panel to thedesired position.

3. Set the rear temperature control buttonin the front climate control panel to thedesired position. (if equipped)

4. The rear mode is controlled accordingto the front mode control. (if equippedwith both of the rear heater and airconditioner)If not equipped with either of the rearheater or air conditioner, rear air blowsonly from one side of lower or uppervents.

5. To turn on the rear air conditioningsystem (if equipped), turn on the airconditioning button in the front climatecontrol panel.

OVQ049331/1VQA2168/OVQ049312

■ Front

■ Rear (if equipped)

Type A Type B

1. Rear fan speed control knob (from front seat)

2. Rear temperature control button* (from front seat)

3. Rear climate control selection button(from front seat)

4. Rear fan speed control knob(from rear seat)

5. Rear mode selection button(from rear seat)

6. Rear temperature control button(from rear seat)

*: if equipped

3 165

Features of your vehicle

From the rear seat (if equipped)1. Set the rear climate control selection

(REAR) button in the front climate con-trol panel to the ON position.

2. Set the rear fan speed control knob onthe rear climate control panel to thedesired position.

3. Set the rear temperature control knobon the rear climate control panel to thedesired position. (if equipped)

4. Select the desired rear mode buttonon the rear climate control panel. (ifequipped)If not equipped with either of the rearheater or air conditioner, rear air blowsonly from one side of lower or uppervents.

5. To turn on the rear air conditioningsystem (if equipped), turn on the airconditioning button in the front climatecontrol panel.

Rear fan speed controlFrom front seatSet the rear climate control selection(REAR) button to the OFF position andturn the rear fan speed control (REAR)knob in the front climate control panel tothe desired position.To change the rear fan speed, turn theknob to the right for higher speed or leftfor lower speed.Setting the knob to the OFF positionturns off the rear fan.

From rear seat (if equipped)Set the rear climate control selection(REAR) button in the front climate controlpanel to the ON position and turn therear fan speed control knob on the rearcontrol panel to the desired position.To change the rear fan speed, turn theknob to the right for higher speed or leftfor lower speed.Setting the knob to the OFF positionturns off the rear fan.

OVQ049332 OVQ049334

Features of your vehicle

1663

Rear temperature control (if equipped)From front seatSet the rear climate control selection(REAR) button to the OFF position andset the rear temperature control (REARTEMP) button in the front climate controlpanel to the desired position.To change the rear air temperature, pushthe upper part ▲ of the button for warmerair or push the lower part ▼ of the buttonfor cooler air.

From rear seat (if equipped)Set the rear climate control selection(REAR) button in the front climate controlpanel to the ON position and turn therear temperature control knob on the rearcontrol panel to the desired position.To change the rear air temperature, turnthe knob to the right for warmer air or leftfor cooler air.

Rear mode selection (if equipped)When the rear climate control controlselection (REAR) button in the front cli-mate control panel is in the OFF position,the rear mode is controlled automaticallydepending on the mode of the front cli-mate control as follows:

OVQ049333 OVQ049335

OVQ028338

1VQA2174

with rear air conditioner

with rear heater

3 167

Features of your vehicle

• Front climate control is :Rear air blows from the upper vents onthe rear ceiling.

• Front climate control is :Rear air blows from the upper vents onthe rear ceiling and the lower vents onthe right rear trim together.

• Front climate control is , , :Rear air blows from the lower vents onthe right rear trim together.

❇ If the rear air conditioner is notequipped, rear air blows only from thelower vents.

❇ If the rear heater is not equipped, rearair blows only from the upper vents.

When the rear climate control selection(REAR) button in the front climate controlpanel is in the ON position, the rearmode is selected by pushing the rearmode selection button on the rear controlpanel as follows:• : Rear air blows from the upper

vents on the rear ceiling.• : Rear air blows from the upper

vents on the rear ceiling and thelower vents on the right rear trimtogether.

• : Rear air blows from the lowervents on the right rear trim.

Rear vents (if equipped)The vent can be adjusted by rotating theblade.

✽✽ NOTICEIf all the vents are closed, it may causesome noise. Always open 2 vents ormore.

OVQ049336 OVQ028339

Features of your vehicle

1683

System operationVentilation1. Set the mode to the position.2. Set the air intake control to the outside

(fresh) air position.3. Set the temperature control to the

desired position.4. Set the fan speed control to the

desired speed.

Heating1. Set the mode to the position.2. Set the air intake control to the outside

(fresh) air position.3. Set the temperature control to the

desired position.4. Set the fan speed control to the

desired speed.5. If dehumidified heating is desired, turn

the air conditioning system on.• If the windshield fogs up, set the mode

to the , position.

Air conditioning All Kia Air Conditioning Systems arefilled with environmentally friendly R-134a refrigerant which is not damag-ing to the ozone layer.1. Start the engine. Push the air condi-

tioning button.2. Set the mode to the position.3. Set the air intake control to the outside

air or recirculated air position.4. Set the temperature control to the

desired position.5. Set the fan speed control to the

desired speed.6. Adjust the fan speed control and tem-

perature control to maintain maximumcomfort.

• When maximum cooling is desired, setthe temperature control to the minimumLO (17°C/62°F) and set the air intaketo the recirculated air position, then setthe fan speed control to the highestspeed.

CAUTION• When using the air conditioning

system, monitor the temperaturegauge closely while driving uphills or in heavy traffic when out-side temperatures are high. Airconditioning system operationmay cause engine overheating.Continue to use the blower fanbut turn the air conditioning sys-tem off if the temperature gaugeindicates engine overheating.

• When opening the windows inhumid weather air conditioningmay create water droplets insidethe vehicle. Since excessivewater droplets may cause dam-age to electrical equipment, airconditioning should only be runwith the windows closed.

3 169

Features of your vehicle

Air conditioning system opera-tion tips • If the vehicle has been parked in direct

sunlight during hot weather, open thewindows for a short time to let the hotair inside the vehicle escape.

• To help reduce moisture inside of win-dows on rainy humid days, decreasethe humidity inside the vehicle by oper-ating the air conditioning system.

• During air conditioning system opera-tion, you may occasionally notice aslight change in engine speed as theair conditioning compressor cycles on.This is a normal system operationcharacteristic.

• Use the air conditioning system everymonth if only for a few minutes toensure maximum system perform-ance.

• When using the air conditioning sys-tem, you may notice clear water drip-ping (or even puddling) on the groundunder the passenger side of the vehi-cle. This is a normal system operationcharacteristic.

• Operating the air conditioning systemin the recirculated air position doesprovide maximum cooling, however,continual operation in this mode maycause the air inside the vehicle tobecome stale.

Checking the amount of air con-ditioner refrigerant and compres-sor lubricantWhen the amount of refrigerant is low,the performance of the air conditioning isreduced. Overfilling also has a bad influ-ence on the air conditioning system.Therefore, if abnormal operation isfound, have the system inspected by anauthorized Kia dealer.

CAUTIONThe air conditioning system shouldbe serviced by an authorized Kiadealer. Improper service may causeserious injury.

CAUTIONWhen the performance of the airconditioning system is reduced it isimportant that the correct type andamount of oil and refrigerant isused. Otherwise, damage to thecompressor and abnormal systemoperation may occur.

Features of your vehicle

1703

Manual climate control systemTo defog inside windshield 1. Select any fan speed except “OFF (0)”.2. Select desired temperature.3. Select the or position.4. The outside (fresh) air and air condi-

tioning will be selected automatically.If the air-conditioning and outside (fresh)air position are not selected automatical-ly, press the corresponding button manu-ally.

To defrost outside windshield 1. Set the fan speed to the highest

(extreme right) position.2. Set the temperature to the extreme hot

position.3. Select the position.4. The outside (fresh) air and air condi-

tioning will be selected automatically.

WINDSHIELD DEFROSTING AND DEFOGGING

WARNINGDo not use the or positionduring cooling operation inextremely humid weather. The dif-ference between the temperature ofthe outside air and that of the wind-shield could cause the outer sur-face of the windshield to fog up,causing loss of visibility. In thiscase, set the mode selection knobto the position and fan speedcontrol knob to the lower speed.OVQ049338OVQ049337

3 171

Features of your vehicle

Automatic climate control systemTo defog inside windshield 1. Select desired temperature.2. Press the defrost button ( ).3. The air-conditioning will be turned on

according to the detected ambient tem-perature, outside (fresh) air positionand higher fan speed will be selectedautomatically.

If the air-conditioning, outside (fresh) airposition and higher fan speed are notselected automatically, adjust the corre-sponding button or knob manually.

To defrost outside windshield 1. Set fan speed to the highest (extreme

right) position.2. Set temperature to the extreme hot

(HI) position.3. Press the defrost button ( ).4. The air-conditioning will be turned on

according to the detected ambienttemperature and outside (fresh) airposition will be selected automatically.

• For maximum defrosting, set the tem-perature control to the extremeright/hot position and the fan speedcontrol to the highest speed.

• If warm air to the floor is desired whiledefrosting or defogging, set the modeto the floor-defrost position.

• Before driving, clear all snow and icefrom the windshield, rear window, out-side rear view mirrors, and all side win-dows.

• Clear all snow and ice from the hoodand air inlet in the cowl grill to improveheater and defroster efficiency and toreduce the probability of fogging upinside of the windshield.

WARNINGDo not use the or positionduring cooling operation inextremely humid weather. The dif-ference between the temperature ofthe outside air and that of the wind-shield could cause the outer sur-face of the windshield to fog up,causing loss of visibility. In thiscase, set the mode selection knobto the position and fan speedcontrol knob to the lower speed.OVQ049340OVQ049339

Features of your vehicle

1723

Defogging logicManual climate control systemTo reduce the probability of fogging upthe inside of the windshield, the air intakecontrol is set to the outside (fresh) airposition automatically if any of followingoccur.• The mode is selected to the or

while the system is activated.• The ignition switch is turned on while the

mode is selected to the or .In this case, the air conditioning will auto-matically operate if the mode is selectedto the or (while the fan is operat-ed).If you don’t want the air-conditioning oroutside (fresh) air position, press the cor-responding button to cancel the opera-tion.

How to cancel or return defogging logicof manual climate control system1. Turn the ignition switch to the ON posi-

tion.2. Turn the fan speed control knob to the

OFF (0) position.3. Turn the mode selection knob to the

defrost position ( ).4. Push the air intake control button

( ) at least 5 times within 3 sec-onds.

The indicator light in the air intake controlbutton will blink 3 times with 0.5 secondof interval. It indicates that the defogginglogic is canceled or returned to the pro-grammed status.

If the battery has been discharged or dis-connected, it is reset as the defog logicstatus.

OVQ049341

3 173

Features of your vehicle

Automatic climate control systemTo reduce the probability of fogging upinside of the windshield, the air intakecontrol is set to outside (fresh) air posi-tion automatically if any of followingoccur.• The ignition switch is turned on while

the mode is selected to the , .• The OFF button is pushed.• The mode is selected to the or

position.In this case, the air conditioning will auto-matically operate if the mode is selectedto the (while the fan is operated) or

.If you don’t want the air-conditioning oroutside (fresh) air position, press the cor-responding button to cancel the opera-tion.If the mode is selected to the posi-tion, higher fan speed will be selectedautomatically regardless of the fan speedcontrol knob adjustment.

How to cancel or return defogging logicof automatic climate control system1. Turn the ignition switch to the ON posi-

tion.2. Select the defrost position pressing

defrost button ( ).3. While holding the air conditioning but-

ton (A/C) pressed, press the air intakecontrol button ( ) at least 5 timeswithin 3 seconds.

The display panel blinks 3 times with 0.5second of interval. It indicates that thedefogging logic is canceled or returned tothe programmed status.

If the battery has been discharged or dis-connected, it is reset as the defog logicstatus.

To keep items from shifting in the cargoarea, you can use the four holders locat-ed in the cargo area to attach the lug-gage net.Contact your authorized Kia dealer toobtain a luggage net.

OVQ049342

OVQ036085N

LUGGAGE NET HOLDER (IF EQUIPPED)

Features of your vehicle

1743

If the vehicle has a roof rack, you canload cargo on top of your vehicle.Crossbars and fixing components need-ed to install the roof rack on your vehiclemay be obtained from an authorized Kiadealer.

ROOF RACK (IF EQUIPPED)

OVQ069206

CAUTION• The crossbars should be placed

in the proper load carrying posi-tions prior to placing items ontothe roof rack.

• If the vehicle is equipped with asunroof, be sure not to positioncargo onto the roof rack in such away that it could interfere withsunroof operation.

(Continued)

WARNING • The following specification is the

maximum weight that can beloaded onto the roof rack.Distribute the load as evenly aspossible across the crossbarsand roof rack and secure the loadfirmly.

• The vehicle center of gravity willbe higher when items are loadedonto the roof rack. Avoid suddenstarts, braking, sharp turns,abrupt maneuvers or high speedsthat may result in loss of vehiclecontrol or rollover causing anaccident.

(Continued)

(Continued)• Always drive slowly and turn cor-

ners carefully when carryingitems on the roof rack. Severewind updrafts, caused by passingvehicles or natural causes, cancause sudden upward pressureon items loaded on the roof rack.This is especially true when car-rying large, flat items such aswood panels or mattresses. Thiscould cause the items to fall offthe roof rack and cause damageto your vehicle or those aroundyou.

• To prevent damage or loss ofcargo while driving, check fre-quently before or while driving tomake sure the items on the roofrack are securely fastened.

CAUTION• If the vehicle has a sunroof, do

not position the roof rack loadsso that they could interfere withthe sunroof.

• Loading cargo or luggage abovespecification on the roof rack maydamage your vehicle.

(Continued)• When carrying cargo on the roof

rack, take the necessary precau-tions to make sure the cargo doesnot damage the roof of the vehicle.

• When carrying large objects onthe roof rack, make sure they donot exceed the overall roof lengthor width.

ROOF 165 lbs. (75 kg)RACK EVENLY DISTRIBUTED

3 175

Features of your vehicle

Your new mirror comes with an integrat-ed HomeLink Universal Transceiver,which allows you to program the mirror toactivate your garage door(s), estate gate,home lighting, etc. The mirror actuallylearns the codes from your various exist-ing transmitters.

ProgrammingYour vehicle may require the ignitionswitch to be turned to the ACC positionfor programming and/or operation ofHomeLink. It is also recommended that anew battery be replaced in the hand-heldtransmitter of the device being pro-grammed to HomeLink for quicker train-ing and accurate transmission of theradio-frequency.Follow these steps to train yourHomeLink mirror:

HOMELINK® WIRELESS CONTROL SYSTEM (IF EQUIPPED)

WARNING• When programming the

HomeLink® Wireless ControlSystem, you may be operating agarage door or gate operator.Make sure that people and objectsare out of the way of the movingdoor or gate to prevent potentialharm or damage.

(Continued)

(Continued)• Do not use HomeLink with any

garage door opener that lacks thesafety stop and reverse feature asrequired by federal safety stan-dards. (This includes any garagedoor opener model manufacturedbefore April 1, 1982.) A garagedoor opener which cannot detectan object, signaling the door tostop and reverse, does not meetcurrent federal safety standards.Using a garage door opener with-out these features increases riskof serious injury or death. Formore information, call 1-800-355-3515 or on the internet atwww.homelink.com.

• Retain the original transmitter forfuture programming procedures(i.e., new vehicle purchase). It isalso suggested that upon the saleof the vehicle, the programmedHomeLink buttons be erased forsecurity purposes (follow step 1in the “Programming” portion ofthis text).

OVQ036305N

Glare detection sensorIndicator light

Homelink buttons

Features of your vehicle

1763

1. When programming the buttons for thefirst time, press and hold the left andcenter buttons ( , ) simultane-ously until the indicator light begins toflash after approximately 20 seconds.(This procedure erases the factory-setdefault codes. Do Not perform this stepto program additional hand-held trans-mitters.)

✽✽ NOTICEFor non rolling code garage door open-ers, follow steps 2 - 3. For rolling code garage door openers,follow steps 2 - 6. For Canadian Programming, please fol-low the Canadian Programming section.For help with determining whether yourgarage is non-rolling code or rollingcode, please refer to the garage dooropeners owner’s manual or contactHomeLink customer service at 1-800-355-3515.

2. Press and hold the button on theHomeLink system you wish to trainand the button on the transmitter whilethe transmitter is approximately 1 to 3inches away from the mirror. Do notrelease the buttons until step 3 hasbeen completed.

3. The HomeLink indicator light will flash,first slowly and then rapidly. When theindicator light flashes rapidly, both but-tons may be released. (The rapid flash-ing light indicates successful program-ming of the new frequency signal.)

✽✽ NOTICESome gate operators and garage dooropeners may require you to replace step#3 with the “cycling” procedure noted inthe “Canadian Programming” sectionof this document.

OVQ036306N

Flashing

OVQ036307N

Flashing

1-3inc

hes

Transmitter

3 177

Features of your vehicle

Rolling code programmingTo train a garage door opener (or otherrolling code equipped devices) with therolling code feature, follow these instruc-tions after completing the “Programming”portion of this text. (A second personmay make the following training proce-dures quicker & easier.) 4. Locate the “learn” or “smart” button on

the device’s motor head unit. Exactlocation and color of the button mayvary by product brand. If there is diffi-culty locating the “learn” or “smart” but-ton, reference the device’s owner’smanual or contact HomeLink at 1-800-355-3515 or on the internet atwww.homelink.com.

5. Press and release the “learn” or“smart” button on the device’s motorhead unit. You have 30 seconds tocomplete step number 6.

6. Return to the vehicle and firmly pressand release the programmedHomeLink button up to three times.The rolling code equipped deviceshould now recognize the HomeLinksignal and activate when theHomeLink button is pressed. Theremaining two buttons may now beprogrammed if this has not previouslybeen done. Refer to the“Programming” portion of this text.

Operating HomeLink To operate, simply press the pro-grammed HomeLink button. Activationwill now occur for the trained product(garage door, security system, entry doorlock, estate gate, or home or office light-ing). For convenience, the hand-heldtransmitter of the device may also beused at any time. The HomeLinkWireless Controls System (once pro-grammed) or the original hand-heldtransmitter may be used to activate thedevice (e.g. garage door, entry door lock,etc.). In the event that there are still pro-gramming difficulties, contact HomeLinkat 1-800-355-3515 or on the internet atwww.homelink.com.

Erasing programmed HomeLinkbuttonsTo erase the three programmed buttons(individual buttons cannot be erased):• Press and hold the left and center

buttons simultaneously, until the indi-cator light begins to flash (approxi-mately 20 seconds). Release both but-tons. Do not hold for longer than 30seconds.

HomeLink is now in the train (or learning)mode and can be programmed at anytime.

OVQ036306N

Flashing

Features of your vehicle

1783

Reprogramming a singleHomeLink buttonTo program a device to HomeLink usinga HomeLink button previously trained,follow these steps:1. Press and hold the desired HomeLink

button. Do NOT release until step 4has been completed.

2. When the indicator light begins to flashslowly (after 20 seconds), position thehand-held transmitter 1 to 3 inchesaway from the HomeLink surface.

3. Press and hold the hand-held trans-mitter button (or press and “cycle” - asdescribed in “Canadian Programming”above).

4. The HomeLink indicator light will flash,first slowly and then rapidly. When theindicator light begins to flash rapidly,release both buttons.

The previous device has now beenerased and the new device can be acti-vated by pushing the HomeLink buttonthat has just been programmed. This pro-cedure will not affect any other pro-grammed HomeLink buttons.

Gate operator programming &canadian programmingDuring programming, your hand-heldtransmitter may automatically stop trans-mitting. Continue to press and hold theHomeLink button (note steps 2 through 4in the “Programming” portion of this text)while you press and re-press (“cycle”)your handheld transmitter every two sec-onds until the frequency signal has beenlearned. The indicator light will flashslowly and then rapidly after several sec-onds upon successful training.

AccessoriesIf you would like additional information onthe HomeLink Wireless Control System,HomeLink compatible products, or topurchase other accessories such as theHomeLink® Lighting Package, pleasecontact HomeLink at 1-800-355-3515 oron the internet at www.homelink.com.

This device complies with Part 15 ofthe FCC rules. Operation is subject tothe following two conditions:1. This device may not cause harmful

interference, and 2. This device must accept any interfer-

ence received, including interferencethat may cause undesired operation.

CAUTIONIf programming a garage dooropener or gate, it is advised tounplug the device during the“cycling” process to prevent possi-ble motor burn-up. WARNING

The HomeLink transmitter has beentested and complies with FCC andDOC/MDC rules. Changes or modifi-cations not expressly approved bythe party responsible for compli-ance could void the user’s authorityto operate the equipment.IC: 4112104541A Gentex MODEL/FCC ID: NZLSTDHL3

3 179

Features of your vehicle

Your new mirror comes with an integrat-ed HomeLink Universal Transceiver,which allows you to program the mirror toactivate your garage door(s), estate gate,home lighting, etc. The mirror actuallylearns the codes from your various exist-ing transmitters.

ProgrammingYour vehicle may require the ignitionswitch to be turned to the ACC positionfor programming and/or operation ofHomeLink. It is also recommended that anew battery be replaced in the hand-heldtransmitter of the device being pro-grammed to HomeLink for quicker train-ing and accurate transmission of theradio-frequency.Follow these steps to train yourHomeLink mirror:

HOMELINK® WIRELESS CONTROL SYSTEM WITH REARVIEW DISPLAY (IF EQUIPPED)

WARNING• When programming the

HomeLink® Wireless ControlSystem, you may be operating agarage door or gate operator.Make sure that people and objectsare out of the way of the movingdoor or gate to prevent potentialharm or damage.

• Do not use HomeLink with anygarage door opener that lacks thesafety stop and reverse feature asrequired by federal safety stan-dards. (This includes any garagedoor opener model manufacturedbefore April 1, 1982.) A garagedoor opener which cannot detectan object, signaling the door tostop and reverse, does not meetcurrent federal safety standards.Using a garage door opener with-out these features increases riskof serious injury or death. Formore information, call 1-800-355-3515 or on the internet atwww.homelink.com.

(Continued)

(Continued)• Retain the original transmitter for

future programming procedures(i.e., new vehicle purchase). It isalso suggested that upon the saleof the vehicle, the programmedHomeLink buttons be erased forsecurity purposes (follow step 1in the “Programming” portion ofthis text).

OVQ032360N

OVQ032305N

Glare detection sensorIndicator light

Rearview display

Homelink buttons

Compass display

Features of your vehicle

1803

1. When programming the buttons for thefirst time, press and hold the left andcenter buttons ( , ) simultane-ously until the indicator light begins toflash after approximately 10 seconds.Release both buttons. Do not hold forlonger than 20 seconds. (This proce-dure erases the factory-set defaultcodes. Do Not perform this step to pro-gram additional hand-held transmit-ters.)

✽✽ NOTICEFor non rolling code garage door open-ers, follow steps 2 - 3. For rolling code garage door openers,follow steps 2 - 6. For Canadian Programming, please fol-low the Canadian Programming section.For help with determining whether yourgarage is non-rolling code or rollingcode, please refer to the garage dooropeners owner’s manual or contactHomeLink customer service at 1-800-355-3515.

2. Press and hold the button on theHomeLink system you wish to trainand the button on the transmitter whilethe transmitter is approximately 1 to 3inches away from the mirror. Do notrelease the buttons until step 3 hasbeen completed.

3. The HomeLink indicator light will flash,first slowly and then rapidly. When theindicator light flashes rapidly, both but-tons may be released. (The rapid flash-ing light indicates successful program-ming of the new frequency signal.)

✽✽ NOTICESome gate operators and garage dooropeners may require you to replace step#3 with the “cycling” procedure noted inthe “Canadian Programming” sectionof this document.

OVQ032306N

Flashing

OVQ032307N

Flashing

1-3inc

hes

Transmitter

3 181

Features of your vehicle

Rolling code programmingTo train a garage door opener (or otherrolling code equipped devices) with therolling code feature, follow these instruc-tions after completing the “Programming”portion of this text. (A second personmay make the following training proce-dures quicker & easier.) 4. Locate the “learn” or “smart” button on

the device’s motor head unit. Exactlocation and color of the button mayvary by product brand. If there is diffi-culty locating the “learn” or “smart” but-ton, reference the device’s owner’smanual or contact HomeLink at 1-800-355-3515 or on the internet atwww.homelink.com.

5. Press and release the “learn” or“smart” button on the device’s motorhead unit. You have 30 seconds tocomplete step number 6.

6. Return to the vehicle and firmly pressand release the programmedHomeLink button up to three times.The rolling code equipped deviceshould now recognize the HomeLinksignal and activate when theHomeLink button is pressed. Theremaining two buttons may now beprogrammed if this has not previouslybeen done. Refer to the“Programming” portion of this text.

Operating HomeLink To operate, simply press the pro-grammed HomeLink button. Activationwill now occur for the trained product(garage door, security system, entry doorlock, estate gate, or home or office light-ing). For convenience, the hand-heldtransmitter of the device may also beused at any time. The HomeLinkWireless Controls System (once pro-grammed) or the original hand-heldtransmitter may be used to activate thedevice (e.g. garage door, entry door lock,etc.). In the event that there are still pro-gramming difficulties, contact HomeLinkat 1-800-355-3515 or on the internet atwww.homelink.com.

Erasing programmed HomeLinkbuttonsTo erase the three programmed buttons(individual buttons cannot be erased):• Press and hold the left and center

buttons simultaneously, until the indi-cator light begins to flash (approxi-mately 10 seconds). Release both but-tons. Do not hold for longer than 30seconds.

HomeLink is now in the train (or learning)mode and can be programmed at anytime.

OVQ032306N

Flashing

Features of your vehicle

1823

Reprogramming a singleHomeLink buttonTo program a device to HomeLink usinga HomeLink button previously trained,follow these steps:1. Press and hold the desired HomeLink

button. Do NOT release until step 4has been completed.

2. When the indicator light begins to flashslowly (after 10 seconds), position thehand-held transmitter 1 to 3 inchesaway from the HomeLink surface.

3. Press and hold the hand-held trans-mitter button (or press and “cycle” - asdescribed in “Canadian Programming”above).

4. The HomeLink indicator light will flash,first slowly and then rapidly. When theindicator light begins to flash rapidly,release both buttons.

The previous device has now beenerased and the new device can be acti-vated by pushing the HomeLink buttonthat has just been programmed. This pro-cedure will not affect any other pro-grammed HomeLink buttons.

Gate operator programming &canadian programmingDuring programming, your hand-heldtransmitter may automatically stop trans-mitting. Continue to press and hold theHomeLink button (note steps 2 through 4in the “Programming” portion of this text)while you press and re-press (“cycle”)your handheld transmitter every two sec-onds until the frequency signal has beenlearned. The indicator light will flashslowly and then rapidly after several sec-onds upon successful training.

AccessoriesIf you would like additional information onthe HomeLink Wireless Control System,HomeLink compatible products, or topurchase other accessories such as theHomeLink® Lighting Package, pleasecontact HomeLink at 1-800-355-3515 oron the internet at www.homelink.com.

This device complies with Part 15 ofthe FCC rules. Operation is subject tothe following two conditions:1. This device may not cause harmful

interference, and 2. This device must accept any interfer-

ence received, including interferencethat may cause undesired operation.

CAUTIONIf programming a garage dooropener or gate, it is advised tounplug the device during the“cycling” process to prevent possi-ble motor burn-up. WARNING

The HomeLink transmitter has beentested and complies with FCC andDOC/MDC rules. Changes or modifi-cations not expressly approved bythe party responsible for compli-ance could void the user’s authorityto operate the equipment.IC: 4112104541A Gentex MODEL/FCC ID: NZLSTDHL3

3 183

Features of your vehicle

These compartments can be used tostore small items required by the driveror passengers.

STORAGE COMPARTMENT

WARNING - Flammablematerials

Do not store cigarette lighters,propane cylinders, or other flamma-ble/explosive materials in the vehi-cle. These items may catch fireand/or explode if the vehicle isexposed to hot temperatures forextended periods.

CAUTION• To avoid possible theft, do not

leave valuables in the storagecompartment.

• Always keep the storage com-partment covers closed whiledriving. Do not attempt to placeso many items in the storagecompartment that the storagecompartment cover can not closesecurely.

1VQA2197/OVQ049403/OVQ039003

Features of your vehicle

1843

Glove boxThe glove box can be locked andunlocked with a master key.To open the glove box, make sure it isunlocked, then pull the handle (1) andthe glove box will automatically open (2).Close the glove box after use.

Sunglass holder (if equipped)To open the sunglass holder, press thecover and the holder will slowly open.Place your sunglasses in the compart-ment door with the lenses facing out.Push to close.

CAUTIONSince key is not fully inserted intothe glove box key set, do not applyexcessive force. Doing so may dam-age the parts.

WARNING To reduce the risk of injury in anaccident or sudden stop, alwayskeep the glove box door closedwhile driving.

CAUTIONMake sure the sunglass holder isclosed while driving.

OVQ028191 OVQ028198

CAUTIONDo not keep food in the glove boxfor a long time.

3 185

Features of your vehicle

Side table (if equipped)The side table is located on the inner por-tion of the passenger’s seat.To use the table, pull the table all the wayup until it locks into place. Verify the tableis locked by trying to push it down. If thetable moves down, it is not locked prop-erly.To fold down the table, pull up the releaselever and press down the edge of thetable.

Cigarette lighter (if equipped)To operate the cigarette lighter, press it inand release it. When it is heated, it auto-matically pops out ready for use.If the engine is not running, the ignitionswitch must be in the ACC or ON positionfor the lighter to operate.

OVQ039339

INTERIOR FEATURES

OVQ040401

CAUTION• Do not hold the lighter in after it is

already heated because it willoverheat.

• Only a genuine Kia lighter shouldbe used in the cigarette lightersocket. The use of plug-in acces-sories (shavers, hand-held vacu-ums, and coffee pots, for exam-ple) may damage the socket orcause electrical failure.

• If the lighter does not pop outwithin 30 seconds, remove it toprevent overheating.

Features of your vehicle

1863

Ashtray (if equipped)To use the ashtray, press the cover andrelease it.To remove the ashtray to empty or cleanit, lift it upward and pull it out.

Cup holder

Front (if equipped)To use the cup holders, pull the cup hold-er cover out. Push the cover to close afteruse.

OVQ049402

WARNING - Ashtray use• Do not use the vehicle’s ashtrays

as waste receptacles.• Putting lit cigarettes or matches

in an ashtray with other com-bustible materials may cause afire.

WARNING - Hot liquids• Do not place uncovered cups of

hot liquid in the cup holder whilethe vehicle is in motion. If the hotliquid spills, you could be burned.Such a burn to the driver couldcause a loss of control of thevehicle.

• To reduce the risk of personalinjury in the event of sudden stopor collision, do not place uncov-ered or unsecured bottles, glass-es, cans, etc., in the cup holderwhile the vehicle is in motion.

WARNINGKeep cans or bottles out of directsun light and do not put them in avehicle that is heated up. It mayexplode.

1VQA2199

CAUTIONDo not place heavy cups or cans incup holders. Cup holders could bedamaged.

3 187

Features of your vehicle

Center (if equipped)Cups or small beverage cans may beplaced in the cup holders.The storage can be removed and rein-stalled.To remove the storage, pull up the rearportion slightly after moving the lockingtap to the unlock position and move itrearward.To reinstall the storage, insert the fronttap on the bottom of the storage into thefront hole on the floor, put the rear por-tion on the floor and move the locking tapto the lock position. Make sure the com-partment is locked in place.

RearCups or small beverage cans may beplaced in the cup holders.

Shopping bag holder ✽✽ NOTICEDo not hang heavy bags, since those maydamage the holder.

OVQ036234N OVQ037090N OVQ036308N

Features of your vehicle

1883

Clothes hanger (if equipped) SunvisorUse the sunvisor to shield direct lightthrough the front or side windows.To use a sunvisor, pull it downward.To use a sunvisor for a side window, pullit downward, unsnap it from the bracket(1) and swing it to the side (2).Adjust the sunvisor forward or backward(3).To use the vanity mirror, pull down thevisor and pull up the mirror cover (4).

OVQ028201

CAUTIONDo not hang heavy clothes, sincethose may damage the hook.

OVQ036233N

CAUTION - Vanity mirror (if equipped)

Close the vanity mirror coversecurely and return the sunvisor toits original position after use. If thevanity mirror is not closed securely,the lamp will stay on and couldresult in battery discharge and pos-sible sunvisor damage.

WARNINGFor your safety, do not obstruct yourvision when using the sunvisor.

3 189

Features of your vehicle

(1) : It can be used when the ignitionswitch is in ACC or ON position.

(2), (3) : It can be used regardless of theignition switch position.

Power outletThe power outlets are designed to pro-vide power for mobile telephones orother devices designed to operate withvehicle electrical systems. The devicesshould draw less than 10 amps with theengine running.

1VQA2188A

Front (Type A)

OVQ040188

Front (Type B)

1VQA2190

Rear

CAUTION• Use power outlet only when the

engine is running and remove theaccessory plug after use. Usingthe accessory plug for prolongedperiods of time with the engineoff could cause the battery to dis-charge.

• Only use 12V electric accessorieswhich are less than 10A in elec-tric capacity.

• Adjust the air-conditioner orheater to the lowest operatinglevel when using the power outlet.

• Close the cover when not in use.• Some electronic devices can

cause electronic interferencewhen plugged into a vehicle’spower outlet. These devices maycause excessive audio static andmalfunctions in other electronicsystems or devices used in yourvehicle.

Features of your vehicle

1903

Digital clockWhenever the battery terminals, relatedfuses are disconnected, you must resetthe time.When the ignition switch is in the ACC orON position, the clock buttons operate asfollows:

• HOUR:Pressing the “H” button with your fin-ger, a pencil or similar object willadvance the time displayed by onehour.

• MINUTE:Pressing the “M” button with your fin-ger, a pencil or similar object willadvance the time displayed by oneminute.

To change the 12 hour format to the 24hour format, press the “H” and “M” but-tons for more than 3 seconds.For example, if the “H” and “M” buttons ispressed for more than 3 seconds whilethe time is 10:15 p.m., the display will bechanged to 22:15.

Floor mat anchor(s) (if equipped)When using a floor mat on the front floorcarpet, make sure it attaches to the floormat anchor(s) in your vehicle. This keepsthe floor mat from sliding forward.

OVQ038092N OXM049228

■ Type A ■ Type B

3 191

Features of your vehicle

Roof antennaIf your vehicle has an audio system, anamplifying antenna is installed in yourvehicle.This antenna can be removed from thevehicle when you wash your vehicle.

ANTENNA

OHM048154

WARNINGThe following must be observedwhen installing ANY floor mat tothe vehicle.• Ensure that the floor mats are

securely attached to the vehicle'sfloor mat anchor(s) before drivingthe vehicle.

• Do not use ANY floor mat thatcannot be firmly attached to thevehicle's floor mat anchors.

• Do not stack floor mats on top ofone another (e.g. all-weather rub-ber mat on top of a carpeted floormat). Only a single floor matshould be installed in each posi-tion.

IMPORTANT - Your vehicle was man-ufactured with driver's side floormat anchors that are designed tosecurely hold the floor mat inplace. To avoid any interferencewith pedal operation, KIA recom-mends that only the KIA floor matdesigned for use in your vehiclebe installed.

CAUTION• Before entering a place with a low

height clearance or a car wash,remove the antenna by rotating itcounterclockwise. If not, theantenna may be damaged.

• When reinstalling your antenna, itis important that it is fully tight-ened and adjusted to the uprightposition to ensure proper recep-tion. But it could be removedwhen parking the vehicle or whenloading cargo on the roof rack.

• When cargo is loaded on the roofrack, do not place the cargo nearthe antenna pole to ensure properreception.

Aux, USB and iPod port(if equipped)If your vehicle has an aux and/orUSB(universal serial bus) port or iPodport, you can use an aux port to connectaudio devices and an USB port to plug inan USB and also an iPod port to plug inan iPod.

✽✽ NOTICEWhen using a portable audio deviceconnected to the power outlet, noise mayoccur during playback. If this happens,use the power source of the portableaudio device.

* iPod® is a trademark of Apple Inc.

The steering wheel audio remote controlbutton is installed to promote safe driv-ing.

✽✽ NOTICEDo not operate audio remote controlbuttons simultaneously.

MODEPress the button to change audio source.FM(1~2)➟AM➟SAT(1~3)➟CD➟USB➟AUX(iPod)➟FM(1~2)...

VOL (▲/▼) • Press the VOL (▲) button to increase

volume.• Press the VOL (▼) button to decease

volume.

CALL( )Places and transfers calls.

END( )Ends calls or cancels functions.

TALK( )Activates voice recognition.

3 192

Features of your vehicle

AUDIO REMOTE CONTROL (IF EQUIPPED)

KMC_VQ11_ADO_HR(EU)OVQ029448

3 193

Features of your vehicle

✽✽ NOTICEIf you install an after market HID headlamp, your vehicle’s audio and electron-ic device may malfunction.

How vehicle audio worksAM and FM radio signals are broadcastfrom transmitter towers located aroundyour city. They are intercepted by theradio antenna on your vehicle.This signalis then received by the radio and sent toyour vehicle speakers.When a strong radio signal has reachedyour vehicle, the precise engineering ofyour audio system ensures the best pos-sible quality reproduction. However, insome cases the signal coming to yourvehicle may not be strong and clear. Thiscan be due to factors such as the dis-tance from the radio station, closeness ofother strong radio stations or the pres-ence of buildings, bridges or other largeobstructions in the area.

AM broadcasts can be received atgreater distances than FM broadcasts.This is because AM radio waves aretransmitted at low frequencies. Theselong, low frequency radio waves can fol-low the curvature of the earth rather thantravelling straight out into the atmos-phere. In addition, they curve aroundobstructions so that they can provide bet-ter signal coverage.

AUDIO SYSTEM

JBM001

FM radio reception

JBM002

AM radio reception

Features of your vehicle

1943

FM broadcasts are transmitted at highfrequencies and do not bend to follow theearth's surface. Because of this, FMbroadcasts generally begin to fade atshort distances from the station.Also, FM signals are easily affected bybuildings, mountains, or other obstruc-tions.These can result in certain listeningconditions which might lead you tobelieve a problem exists with your radio.The following conditions are normal anddo not indicate radio trouble:

• Fading - As your vehicle moves awayfrom the radio station, the signal willweaken and sound will begin to fade.When this occurs, we suggest that youselect another stronger station.

• Flutter/Static - Weak FM signals orlarge obstructions between the trans-mitter and your radio can disturb thesignal causing static or fluttering nois-es to occur. Reducing the treble levelmay lessen this effect until the distur-bance clears.

• Station Swapping - As a FM signalweakens, another more powerful sig-nal near the same frequency maybegin to play. This is because yourradio is designed to lock onto the clear-est signal. If this occurs, select anotherstation with a stronger signal.

• Multi-Path Cancellation - Radio signalsbeing received from several directionscan cause distortion or fluttering. Thiscan be caused by a direct and reflect-ed signal from the same station, or bysignals from two stations with closefrequencies. If this occurs, selectanother station until the condition haspassed.

JBM004JBM003

FM radio station

JBM005

3 195

Features of your vehicle

Satellite radio receptionYou may experience difficulties in receiv-ing SIRIUS satellite radio signals in thefollowing situations.

• If you are driving next to a tall vehi-cle(such as a truck or a bus) that blockthe signal.

• If you are driving beneath the top levelof a multi-level freeway.

• If you drive under a bridge.• If you are driving next to a tall vehicle

(such as a truck or a bus) that blocksthe signal.

• If you are driving in a valley where thesurrounding hills or peaks block thesignal from the satellite.

• If you are driving on a mountain roadwhere the signal is blocked by moun-tains.

• If you are driving in an area with talltrees that block the signal (10m ormore), for example, on an road througha dense forest.

• The signal can become weak in someareas that are not covered by the SIR-IUS repeater network.

NOTE:There may be other unforeseen cir-cumstances leading to receptionproblems with the SIRIUS satelliteradio signal.

SATELITE2

SATELITE1

Features of your vehicle

1963

Using a cellular phone or a two-wayradioWhen a cellular phone is used inside thevehicle, noise may be produced from theaudio equipment. This does not meanthat something is wrong with the audioequipment. In such a case, use the cellu-lar phone at a place as far as possiblefrom the audio equipment.

Care of discs• If the temperature inside the vehicle is

too high, open the vehicle windows forventilation before using your vehicleaudio.

• It is illegal to copy and use MP3/WMAfiles without permission. Use CDs thatare created only by lawful means.

• Do not apply volatile agents such asbenzene and thinner, normal cleanersand magnetic sprays made for ana-logue disc onto CDs.

• To prevent the disc surface from get-ting damaged. Hold and carry CDs bythe edges or the edges of the centerhole only.

• Clean the disc surface with a piece ofsoft cloth before playback (wipe it fromthe center to the outside edge).

• Do not damage the disc surface orattach pieces of sticky tape or paperonto it.

• Make sure objects other than CDs arenot inserted into the CD player (Do notinsert more than one CD at a time).

• Keep CDs in their cases after use toprotect them from scratches or dirt.

• Depending on the type of CD-R/CD-RW CDs, certain CDs may not operatenormally according to manufacturingcompanies or making and recordingmethods. In such circumstances, if youstill continue to use those CDs, theymay cause the malfunction of yourvehicle audio system.

✽✽ NOTICE - Playing anIncompatible CopyProtected Audio CD

Some copy protected CDs, which do notcomply with the international audio CDstandards (Red Book), may not play onyour vehicle audio. Please note that ifyou try to play copy protected CDs andthe CD player does not perform correct-ly the CDs maybe defective, not the CDplayer.

WARNINGDo not use a cellular phone whiledriving. Stop at a safe location touse a cellular phone.

3 197

Features of your vehicle

1. FM/AM Button

2. SEEK Button

3. POWER Button & VOLUME Knob

4. SCAN Button

5. MUTE Button

6. SETUP Button

7. TUNE & AUDIO Control Knob

8. PRESET Buttons

RADIO, SET UP, VOLUME and AUDIO CONTROLCD Player : PA710S

VQ_PA710S_RADIO / VQ_760S_RADIO

CD Changer : PA760S

Features of your vehicle

1983

Using RADIO, SETUP, VOLUMEand AUDIO CONTROL

1. FM/AM ButtonThe FM/AM button toggles between FMand AM. Listed below are the paths asthe system switches from FM to AM andback to FM.• FM/AM : FM1➟FM2➟AM➟FM1...

2. SEEK Button• When the [SEEK ] is pressed, it will

automatically tune to the next lowerstation.

• When the [SEEK ] is pressed, it willautomatically tune to the next higherstation.

3. POWER Button & VOLUME Knob• Turns the audio system on/off when

the IGNITION SWITCH is on ACC orON.

• If the knob is turned clockwise/counteclockwise, the volume will increase/decrease.

4. SCAN Button• When the button is pressed, it auto-

matically scans the radio stationsupwards.

• The SCAN feature steps through eachstation, starting from the initial station,for 5 seconds.

• Press the [SCAN] button again to stopthe scan feature and to listen to thecurrently selected channel.

5. MUTE ButtonWhen the button is pressed, stops soundand “Audio Mute” is displayed on LCD.

6. SETUP ButtonPress this button to enter SETUP mode,If no action is taken for 8 seconds, it willreturn to previous mode.In “SETUP” mode, rotate the TUNE knobto move the cursor between items, andpush the TUNE knob to select.

• SCROLLSelect whether long file names arescrolled continuously (“ON”) or just once(“OFF”).

• SDVCSelect this item to turn the SDVC(SpeedDependent Volume Control) feature ONor OFF. If it is turned ON, volume level isadjusted automatically according to thevehicle speed.

• SIRIUSSelect default display of SIRIUS mode.“Category/Channel name” or “Artist/SongTitle” can be selected.

• PHONESelect this item to enter BLUETOOTHsetup mode. Refer to “BLUETOOTHPHONE OPERATION” section fordetailed information.

3 199

Features of your vehicle

7. TUNE & AUDIO Control KnobRotate the knob clockwise or counterclock wise to increase or decrease fromcurrent frequency.(AM 10 kHz, FM 200 kHz) Pressing the button changes the BASS,MIDDLE, TREBLE, FADER and BAL-ANCE TUNE mode. The mode selectedis shown on the display. After selectingeach mode, rotate the Audio control knobclockwise or counterclockwise.Press this button while holding [SETUP]button to activate / inactivate the item to.Select SETUP item using left and rightfunction of the Tune button.

• BASS ControlTo increase the BASS, rotate the knobclockwise, while to decrease the BASS,rotate the knob counterclockwise.

• MIDDLE ControlTo increase the MIDDLE, rotate the knobclockwise, while to decrease the MID-DLE, rotate the knob counterclockwise.

• TREBLE ControlTo increase the TREBLE, rotate the knobclockwise, while to decrease the TRE-BLE, rotate the knob counterclockwise.

• FADER ControlTurn the control knob clockwise toemphasize rear speaker sound (frontspeaker sound will be attenuated). Whenthe control knob is turned counterclock-wise, front speaker sound will be empha-sized (rear speaker sound will be attenu-ated).

• BALANCE ControlRotate the knob clockwise to emphasizeright speaker sound (left speaker soundwill be attenuated). When the controlknob is turned counter clockwise, leftspeaker sound will be emphasized (rightspeaker sound will be attenuated).

8. PRESET Buttons• Press [1]~[6] buttons less than 0.8 sec-

onds to play the station saved in eachbutton.

• Press [1]~[6] buttons more than 0.8seconds or longer to save the currentstation to the respective button with abeep.

Features of your vehicle

2003

1. CD Slot

2. CD Indicator

3. CD Eject Button

4. CD LOAD Button

5. TRACK Button

6. INFO Button

7. SEARCH Knob & ENTER Button

8. REPEAT Button

9. RANDOM Button

10. SCAN Button

11. DISC Button

12. CD Button

13. FOLDER Button

VQ_PA710S_CD / VQ_760S_CDC

CDCD Player : PA710S

CD Changer : PA760S

3 201

Features of your vehicle

Using CD Player

1. CD SlotInsert a CD label side up and gently pushin while ignition switch is on ACC or ON.The audio automatically switches to CDmode and begins to play the CD. If theaudio was turned off, audio power willautomatically turned on as the CD isinserted.• This audio only recognizes 12cm-size,

CD-DA (Audio CD) or ISO data-CD(MP3 CD).

• If UDF data-CD or non-CD (e.g. DVD)is inserted, "Reading Error" messagewill be displayed and the disc will beejected.

2. CD Indicator(CD Player :PA710S)When car ignition switch is ACC or ONand if the CD is loaded, this indicator is lit.If the CD is ejected the Icon is off.

3. CD Eject ButtonPress button to to eject the CD. Thisbutton works regardless of ignitionswitch status.• ALL EJECT(CD Changer :PA760S)

Press this button for more than 0.8seconds to eject all discs inside thedeck in respective order.

4. CD LOAD ButtonThis compact disc player will accommo-date up to six compact discs.To insertdiscs into the player, perform the follow-ing:• Press and release the [LOAD] Button.• Green light on the slot will be illuminat-

ed and the lowest number of emptyslot will blink on the display. After “Wait”is displayed on the LCD, the slot willopen with “Insert CD” displayed on theLCD.

• Insert a disc partway into the slot, labelside up. The player will pull the disc in.

When the disc is inserted, the disc willbegin to play automatically.

✽✽ NOTICE• The disc can be only inserted while the

green light is blinking on the slot.• This CD player is suitable only for

12cm discs, do not use irregularshaped CDs.

To insert multiple discs:• Press and hold the [LOAD] button for

one second or more.You will then heara beep sound and the green light onthe slot will be illuminated, and thenumbers of empty disc will blink on thedisplay.

• After “Wait” is displayed on the LCDwith the lowest number of empty slotblinking, the slot will open with “InsertCD” displayed on the LCD.

• Insert a disc partway into the slot, labelside up. The player will pull the disc in.Once the disc is loaded, the numbersof the empty disc will blink on the dis-play continuously.If the next “Insert CD” is displayedwhen the slot is illuminated, you canthen load another disc.

• Load the remaining disc by followingprocedures 1 and 2. When you finishedloading 6 discs, the CD player willbegin to play the last CD loaded.

CAUTIONDo not insert a CD if CD indicatoris lit.

Features of your vehicle

2023

• To load more than one disc but lessthan six, complete Steps 1 and 2.

When you have finished loading discs,press LOAD button to cancel the loadingfunction or wait for 10 seconds. The CDplayer will begin to play the last CDloaded. As each CD starts to play, theDISC number will appear on the display.

✽✽ NOTICEThe disc player takes up to six discs. Donot try to load more than six.

5. TRACK Button• Press [TRACK ] button for less than

0.8 seconds to play from the beginningof current song.

• Press [TRACK ] button for less than0.8 seconds and press again within 1second to play the previous song.

• Press [TRACK ] button for 0.8 sec-onds or longer to initiate reverse direc-tion high speed sound search of cur-rent song.

• Press [TRACK ] button for less than0.8 seconds to play the next song.

• Press [TRACK ] button for 0.8 sec-onds or longer to initiate forward direc-tion high speed sound search of cur-rent song.

6. INFO ButtonDisplays the information of the currentsong.• CDDA : DISC TITLE ➟ DISC ARTIST ➟

TRACK TITLE ➟ TRACK ARTIST ➟

TOTAL TRACK ➟ DISC TITLE...• MP3/WMA : FILE NAME➟TITLE➟ARTIST

➟ALBUM➟FOLDER➟TOTAL FILE...(Not displayed if the information isunavailable on the CD or file.)

7. SEARCH Knob & ENTER Button• Turn this knob clockwise to browse

songs after current song, or counter-clockwise to browse songs before cur-rent song. To play the displayed song,press the knob.

• Pressing this knob without turningenters to AUDIO CONTROL mode.

8. REPEAT ButtonPress this button for less than 0.8 sec-onds to activate ‘RPT’ mode and morethan 0.8 seconds to activate ‘FLD RPT’mode.• RPT : Only a track (file) is repeatedly

played back.• FLD RPT (MP3/WMA Only) : Only files

are repeatedly played back.

9. RANDOM ButtonPress this button for less than 0.8 sec-onds to activate ‘RDM’ mode and morethan 0.8 seconds to activate ‘ALL RDM’mode.• RDM : Only files/tracks in a folder/disc

are played back in a random sequence.• ALL RDM (MP3/WMA Only) : All files in

a disc are played back in the randomsequence.

10. SCAN ButtonPlay each song in the CD for 10 seconds.To cancel SCAN Play, press this buttonagain.

11. DISC Buttons• [DISC ] Change Button Changes

disc to the previous disc.• [DISC ] Change Button Changes

disc to the next disc.

12. CD ButtonIf there is a CD in the CD DECK it switch-es to CD mode.If there is no CD, then the message “NOCD” will become displayed on the LCDfor 3 seconds and returns to the previousmode.

3 203

Features of your vehicle

13. FOLDER Button• Press [FOLDER ] button to move to

child folder of the current folder anddisplay the first song in the folder.Press TUNE/ ENTER knob to move tothe folder displayed. It will play the firstsong in the folder.

• Press [FOLDER ] button to move toparent folder of the current folder anddisplay the first song in the folder.Press TUNE/ENTER knob to move tothe folder displayed.

NOTE:Order of playing files(folders):

1. Song playing order : to sequentially.

2. Folder playing order:

✽ If no song file is contained in thefolder, that folder is not displayed.

Features of your vehicle

2043

CAUTION IN USING USB DEVICE

• To use an external USB device,make sure the device is not con-nected when starting up the vehi-cle. Connect the device afterstarting up.

• If you start the engine when theUSB device is connected, it maydamage the USB device. (USBflashdrives are very sensitive toelectric shock.)

• If the engine is started up orturned off while the external USBdevice is connected, the externalUSB device may not work.

• It may not play inauthentic MP3 orWMA files.1) It can only play MP3 files with

the compression rate between8Kbps~320Kbps.

2) It can only play WMA musicfiles with the compression ratebetween 8Kbps~320Kbps.

• Take precautions for static electrici-ty when connecting or disconnect-ing the external USB device.

(Continued)

(Continued)• An encrypted MP3 PLAYER is not

recognizable.• Depending on the condition of

the external USB device, the con-nected external USB device canbe unrecognizable.

• When the formatted byte/sectorsetting of External USB device isnot either 512BYTE or 2048BYTE,then the device will not be recog-nized.

• Use only a USB device formattedto FAT 12/16/32.

• USB devices without USB I/Fauthentication may not be recog-nizable.

• Make sure the USB connectionterminal does not come in contactwith the human body or otherobjects.

• If you repeatedly connect or dis-connect the USB device in a shortperiod of time, it may break thedevice.

• You may hear a strange noisewhen connecting or disconnect-ing a USB device.

(Continued)

(Continued)• If you disconnect the external USB

device during playback in USBmode, the external USB device canbe damaged or may malfunction.Therefore, disconnect the externalUSB device when the audio isturned off or in another mode. (e.g,Radio, SIRIUS or CD)

• Depending on the type and capacityof the external USB device or thetype of the files stored in the device,there is a difference in the timetaken for recognition of the device.

• Do not use the USB device for pur-poses other than playing music files.

• Playing videos through the USB isnot supported.

• Use of USB accessories such asrechargers or heaters using USBI/F may lower performance orcause trouble.

• If you use devices such as a USBhub purchased separately, thevehicle’s audio system may notrecognize the USB device. In thatcase, connect the USB devicedirectly to the multimedia termi-nal of the vehicle.

(Continued)

3 205

Features of your vehicle

(Continued)• If the USB device is divided by

logical drives, only the music fileson the highest-priority drive arerecognized by car audio.

• Devices such as MP3 Player/Cellular phone/Digital camera canbe unrecognizable by standardUSB I/F can be unrecognizable.

• Charging through the USB maynot be supported in some mobiledevices.

❋ A car exclusive cable (Providedor sold separately) is required touse the iPod.

• Some non-standard USB devices(METAL COVER TYPE USB) can beunrecognizable.

• Some USB flash memory readers(such as CF, SD, microSD, etc.) orexternal-HDD type devices can beunrecognizable.

• Music files protected by DRM(DIGITAL RIGHTS MANAGEMENT)are not recognizable.

• The data in the USB memory maybe lost while using this audio.Always back up important data ona personal storage device.

(Continued)

(Continued)• Please avoid using USB memory

products which can be used askey chains or cellular phoneaccessories as they could causedamage to the USB jack. Pleasemake certain only to use plug typeconnector products as shownbelow.

Features of your vehicle

2063

1. AUX/USB Button

2. TRACK Button

3. INFO Button

4. FOLDER Button

5. SEARCH Knob & ENTER Button

6. RANDOM Button

7. REPEAT Button

8. SCAN Button

VQ_PA710_AUX,USB / VQ_PA760_AUX,USB

AUX/USBCD Player : PA710S

CD Changer : PA760S

3 207

Features of your vehicle

Using USB deviceUsing a USB that is connected to themultiple terminal inside the console onthe right hand side of the driver’s seat.When USB is connected, the ‘USB’ iconwill be displayed on the top right cornerof the display screen.

1. AUX/USB ButtonIf the auxiliary device is connected, itswitches to AUX or USB mode to play thesound from the auxiliary player.If there is no auxiliary device, then themessage “No Media” will become dis-played on the LCD for 3 seconds andreturns to previous mode.

2. TRACK Button• Press the [TRACK ] button for less

than 0.8 seconds to play from thebeginning of the current song.Press the button for less than 0.8 sec-onds and press it again within 1 sec-ond to move to and play the previoussong.Press the button for 0.8 seconds orlonger to play the song in reversedirection in fast speed.

• Press the [TRACK ] button for lessthan 0.8 seconds to move to the next

song. Press the button for 0.8 secondsor longer to play the song in forwarddirection in fast speed.

3. INFO ButtonDisplays the information of the file current-ly played in the order of FILE NAME➟

TITLE➟ARTIST➟ALBUM➟FOLDER➟TOTAL FILE➟PLAY SCREEN➟FILE NAME… (Displays no information if the file hasno song information.)

4. FOLDER Button• Press [FOLDER ] button to move to

child folder of the current folder anddisplay the first song in the folder.Press TUNE/ ENTER knob to move tothe folder displayed. It will play the firstsong in the folder.

• Press [FOLDER ] button to move toparent folder display the first song inthe folder.Press TUNE/ENTER knob to move tothe folder displayed.

5. SEARCH Knob & ENTER Button• Turn this knob clockwise to browse

songs after current song, or counterclockwise to browse songs before cur-

rent song. To play the displayed song,press the knob.

• Pressing this knob without turningenters to AUDIO CONTROL mode.

6. RANDOM Button• Press this button for less than 0.8 sec-

onds to play songs randomly in currentfolder.

• Press this button for 0.8 seconds orlonger to play songs randomly in entireUSB device.

• To cancel RANDOM play, press thisbutton again.

7. REPEAT Button• Press this button for less than 0.8 sec-

onds to repeat current song.• Press this button for 0.8 seconds or

longer to repeat all songs in currentfolder.

• To cancel REPEAT, press this buttonagain.

8. SCAN ButtonPlays each song in the USB device for10 seconds.To cancel SCAN Play, press this buttonagain.

Features of your vehicle

2083

✽✽ NOTICE FOR USING THEiPod® DEVICE

• Some iPod models might not sup-port the communication protocoland the files will not be played. Supported iPod models: - iPod Mini- iPod 4th(Photo) ~ 6th(Classic)generation- iPod Nano 1st~4th generation- iPod Touch 1st~2nd generation

• The order of search or playback ofsongs in the iPod can be differentfrom the order searched in theaudio system.

• If the iPod disabled due to its ownmalfunction, reset the iPod. (Reset:Refer to iPod manual)

• An iPod may not operate normallyon low battery.

• Some iPod devices, such as theiPhone, can be connected through theBluetooth® interface. The devicemust have audio Bluetooth® capabili-ty (such as for stereo headphoneBluetooth®). The device can play, butit will not be controlled by the audiosystem.

CAUTION IN USING THE iPod® DEVICE

• The KIA iPod Power Cable isneeded in order to operate iPodwith the audio buttons on theaudio system.The USB cable pro-vided by Apple may cause mal-function and should not be usedfor KIA vehicles.

❋ The KIA iPod Power Cable maybe purchased through your KIADealership.

• When connecting iPod with theiPod Power Cable, insert the con-nector to the multimedia socketcompletely. If not inserted com-pletely, communications betweeniPod and audio may be interrupted.

• When adjusting the sound effects ofthe iPod and the audio system, thesound effects of both devices willoverlap and might reduce or distortthe quality of the sound.

• Deactivate (turn off) the equalizerfunction of an iPod when adjust-ing the audio system’s volume,and turn off the equalizer of theaudio system when using theequalizer of an iPod.

(Continued)

(Continued)• When the iPod cable is connected,

the system can be switched to AUXmode even without iPod deviceand may cause noise. Disconnectthe iPod cable when you are notusing the iPod device.

• When not using iPod with caraudio, detach the iPod cable fromiPod. Otherwise, iPod may remainin accessory mode, and may notwork properly.

• When connecting the iPod, use theUSB/AUX terminals.

• When disconnecting the iPod,disconnect both the USB/AUX ter-minal.

• The iPod exclusive cable must beconnected to both the USB/AUXterminals for iPod charging andoperations to be supported.

Detachable USB/AUX All-in-one USB/AUX

3 209

Features of your vehicle

1. iPod Button

2. TRACK Button

3. INFO Button

4. MENU Button

5. SEARCH Knob & ENTER Button

6. RANDOM Button

7. REPEAT Button

iPod®

VQ_PA710S_iPod / VQ_PA760S_iPod

iPod is a trademark of Apple Inc.

CD Player : PA710S

CD Changer : PA760S

Features of your vehicle

2103

Using iPodUsing an iPod when the exclusive cableis connected to the multiple terminalinside the console on the right hand sideof the driver’s seat. When the iPod is con-nected, the ‘iPod’ icon will be displayedon the top right corner of the displayscreen.

1. iPod ButtonIf iPod is connected, it switches to theiPod mode from the previous mode toplay the song files stored in the iPod.If there is no iPod connected, then it dis-plays the message “No Media” for 3 sec-onds and returns to the previous mode.

2. TRACK Button• Press the [TRACK ] button for less

than 0.8 seconds to play from thebeginning of the song currently played.Press the button for less than 0.8 sec-onds and press it again within 1 sec-ond to move to and play the previoustrack.Press the button for 0.8 seconds orlonger to play the song in reversedirection in fast speed.

• Press the [TRACK ] button for lessthan 0.8 seconds to move to the nexttrack.

Press the button for 0.8 seconds orlonger to play the song in forwarddirection in fast speed.

3. INFO ButtonDisplays the information of the file cur-rently played in the order of TITLE ➟ ARTIST ➟ ALBUM ➟ PLAYSCREEN DISPLAY ➟ TITLE...(Displays no information if the file has nosong information.)

4. MENU ButtonMoves to the upper category from cur-rently played category of the iPod.To move to (play) the category (song)displayed, press TUNE Knob & ENTERButton.You will be able to search through thelower category of the selected category.The standard order of iPod’s category isSongs➟Albums➟Artists➟Genres➟iPod.

5. SEARCH Knob & ENTER ButtonWhen you rotate the knob clockwise, itwill display the songs (category) aheadof the song currently played (category inthe same level).

Also, when you rotate the knob counter-clockwise, it will display the songs (cate-gory) before the song currently played(category in the same level).To listen to the song displayed in thesong category, press the button to skip toand play the selected song.Pressing the button changes the BASS,MIDDLE, TREBLE, FADER and BAL-ANCE TUNE mode. The mode selectedis shown on the display. After selectingeach mode, rotate the Audio control knobclockwise or counterclockwise.

6. RANDOM Button• Press this button for less than 0.8 sec-

onds to shuffle order of all songs incurrent category. (Song Random)

• Press this button for 0.8 seconds orlonger to shuffle order of albums in cur-rent category. (Album Random)

• To cancel RANDOM Play, press thisbutton again.

7. REPEAT ButtonRepeats the song currently played.

3 211

Features of your vehicle

Satellite Radio channels:SIRIUS Satellite Radio has over 130 chan-nels, including 69 channels of 100% com-mercial-free music, plus sports, news, talkand entertainment available nationwide inyour vehicle. For more information and acomplete list of SIRIUS Satellite Radiochannels, visit sirius.com in the UnitedStates, sirius-canada.ca in Canada, or callSIRIUS at 1-888-539-7474.

Satellite Radio reception factors:To receive the satellite signal, your vehi-cle has been equipped with a satelliteradio antenna located on the roof of yourvehicle. The vehicle roof provides thebest location for an unobstructed, openview of the sky, a requirement of a satel-lite radio system. Like AM/FM, there areseveral factors that can affect satelliteradio reception performance:• Antenna obstructions: For optimal

reception performance, keep theantenna clear of snow and ice build-upand keep luggage and other materialas far away from the antenna as possi-ble.

• Terrain: Hills, mountains, tall buildings,bridges, tunnels, freeway overpasses,parking garages, dense tree foliageand thunderstorms can interfere withyour reception.

SIRIUS Satellite Radio service:SIRIUS Satellite Radio is a subscription-based satellite radio service that broad-casts music, sports, news and entertain-ment programming to radio receivers,which are available for installation inmotor vehicles or factory installed, aswell as for the home, portable and wire-less devices, and through an Internetconnection on personal computer.Vehicles that are equipped with a factoryinstalled SIRIUS Satellite Radio systeminclude:• Hardware and an introductory trial sub-

scription term, which begins on thedate of sale or lease of the vehicle.

• For a small upgrade fee, access toSIRIUS music channels, and otherselect channels over the Internet usingany computer connected to theInternet (U.S. customers only).For information on extended subscrip-tion terms, contact SIRIUS at 1-888-539-7474.

NOTE:Satellite Radio requires SIRIUS® com-patible receiver and a subscription serv-ice fee after trial period.Vehicles without a factory-installedradio receiver require hardware pur-chase and installation. Please see yourdealer for further details. All fees andprogramming subject to change.Subscriptions governed by the SIRIUSTerms & Conditions available atwww.sirius.com / serviceterms.Available only in the 48 contiguousUnited States and the District ofColumbia. Service available in Canada;see www.siriuscanada.caKIA shall not be responsible for anysuch programming changes.

Satellite Radio Electronic SerialNumber (ESN): This 12-digit SatelliteSerial Number is needed to re-activate,modify or track your satellite radioaccount. You will need this number whencommunicating with SIRIUS.

SIRIUS Satellite Radio information (if equipped)

Features of your vehicle

2123

1. SAT RADIO Button

(SIRIUS Satellite Radio)

2. SEEK Button

3. PRESET Buttons

4. SCAN Button

5. TUNE Knob & ENTER button

6. CAT(Category) Button

7. INFO Button

VQ_PA710S_SATELLITE RADIO / VQ_PA760S_SATELLITE RADIO

SIRIUS SATELLITE RADIOCD Player : PA710S

CD Changer : PA760S

3 213

Features of your vehicle

Using SIRIUS Satellite RadioYour Kia vehicle is equipped with a 3month complimentary period of SIRIUSSatellite Radio so you have access to over130 channels of music, information, andentertainment programming.

ActivationIn order to extend or reactivate your sub-scription to SIRIUS Satellite Radio, youwill need to contact SIRIUS CustomerCare at 1-888-539-7474. Have your 12digit SID (Sirius Identification Number)/ESN(Electronic Serial Number) ready. Toretrieve the SID/ESN, turn on the radio,press the [SAT] button and tune to chan-nel zero. Please note that the vehicle willneed to be turned on, in Sirius mode, andhave an unobstructed view of the sky inorder for the radio to receive the activa-tion signal.

1. SAT Button(SIRIUS Satellite Radio)

Press the [SAT] button to switch to SIR-IUS Satellite Radio. It cycles through thedifferent bands as noted below.SAT1 ➟ SAT2 ➟ SAT3 ➟ SAT1...

2. SEEK Button• Press [ SEEK ] button for less

than 0.8 seconds to select previous ornext channel.

• Press [ SEEK ] button for 0.8seconds or longer to continuouslymove to previous or next channel.

• If "CATEGORY" Icon is displayed atthe top of the screen, channel up/downis done through the channels withincurrent category.

3. PRESET Buttons• Press [1]~[6] buttons less than 0.8 sec-

onds to play the channel saved in eachbutton.

• Press [1]~[6] buttons for 0.8 secondsor longer to save current channel to therespective button with a beep.

4. SCAN Button • When the [SCAN] button is pressed, it

automatically scans the radio stationsupwards.

• The SCAN feature steps through everychannel, starting from the initial chan-nel, for ten seconds.

• Press the [SCAN] button again to stopthe scan feature and to listen to thecurrently selected channel.

• If "CATEGORY" Icon is displayed atthe top of the screen, channel chang-ing is done through the channels with-in current category.

5. TUNE knob & ENTER button• Rotate clockwise to increase the chan-

nel number or to scroll down the cate-gory list.

• Rotate counterclockwise to decreasethe channel number or to scroll up thecategory list.

• Press this to make selection of chan-nels or items.

Features of your vehicle

2143

6. CAT(Category) Button • Press [CAT ] or [CAT ] button to

enter the Category List Mode, it dis-plays category items and highlights thecategory that currently tuned channelbelongs to.

• On Category List Mode, press thesebuttons to navigate category list.

• Press [ENTER] Button to select thelowest channel in highlighted category.

• If channel is selected by selecting cate-gory "CATEGORY" Icon is displayed atthe top of the screen.

7. INFO ButtonDisplays the information of the currentchannel as below when the button ispressed each time.• When default display is

CAT(Category)/CH(Channel) ➟ Artist/Title ➟

Composer (if available) ➟ Category/Channel...• When default display is

ART(Artist)/TITLE(Title) ➟ Category/Channel➟ Composer(if available) ➟ Artist/Title...

✽✽ Troubleshooting1. Antenna Error

If this message is displayed, the anten-na or antenna cable is broken orunplugged. Please consult with yourKia dealership.

2. Acquiring Signal If this message is displayed, it meansthat the antenna is covered and thatthe SIRIUS Satellite Radio signal isnot available. Ensure the antenna isuncovered and has a clear view of thesky.

3 215

Features of your vehicle

RSE(Rear Seat Entertainment System (if equipped)

1. RSE Button

VQ_PA710S_RSE / VQ_PA760_RSE

CD Player : PA710S

CD Changer : PA760S

Features of your vehicle

2163

1. RSE ButtonPlay the RSE, and "RSE" Icon is dis-played. After pressing the RSE button,you can enjoy the RSE audio through thespeakers in RSE mode and "Connected"is appeared at the same time.At the state of NO RSE Icon, the RSEbutton is pressed and "RSE Not Ready"is appeared at the window.The speaker volume level is adjustableby VOLUME(+,-) knob on HEAD unit,RSE unit and remote controller.• Refer to the "RSE" in this section for

details RSE operation.• RSE : Rear Seat Entertainment System

(A/V).

3 217

Features of your vehicle

NOTE:If you need more information aboutKia’s Bluetooth® wireless technology.Contact kia website “www.kia.com”(OWNERS>General Info>BLUETOOTHwireless technology).

CAUTION IN USINGBLUETOOTH® CELLULARPHONE

• Do not use a cellular phone orperform Bluetooth® settings (e.g.pairing a phone) while driving.

• Some Bluetooth®-enabled phonesmay not be recognized by thesystem or fully compatible withthe system.

• Before using Bluetooth® relatedfeatures of the audio system,refer your phone’s User’s Manualfor phone-side Bluetooth® opera-tions.

• The phone must be paired to theaudio system to use Bluetooth®

related features.• You will not be able to use the

hands-free feature when yourphone (in the car) is outside ofthe cellular service area (e.g. in atunnel, in a underground, in amountainous area, etc.).

• If the cellular phone signal is pooror the vehicles interior noise istoo loud, it may be difficult to hearthe other person’s voice during acall.

(Continued)

(continued)• Do not place the phone near or

inside metallic objects, otherwise communications with Bluetooth®

system or cellular service sta-tions can be disturbed.

• While a phone is connectedthrough Bluetooth® your phonemay discharge quicker than usualfor additional Bluetooth®-relatedoperations.

• Some cellular phones or otherdevices may cause interferencenoise or malfunction to audiosystem. In this case, store thedevice in a different location mayresolve the situation.

• Please save your phone name inEnglish, or your phone name maynot be displayed correctly.

• If Priority is set upon vehicle igni-tion (IGN/ACC ON), the Bluetoothphone will be automatically con-nected.Even if you are outside, theBluetooth phone will be automat-ically connected once you are inthe vicinity of the vehicle.If you do not want automaticBluetooth power off.

(Continued)

(continued)• Bluetooth connection may

become intermittently discon-nected in some mobile phones.Follow the following steps to tryagain.1) Turn the Bluetooth Function

within the mobile phoneON/OFF and try to connectagain.

2) Turn the mobile phone powerON/OFF and try to connectagain.

3) Completely remove the mobilephone battery, reboot, and thentry to connect again.

4) Reboot the Audio and try toconnect again.

5) Delete all paired devices fromthe mobile phone and Audioand re-pair for use.

• The hands-free call volume andquality may differ depending onthe mobile phone.

Features of your vehicle

2183

BLUETOOTH PHONE OPERATION

1. button : Press the button tochange audio source.- FM(1~2)➟AM➟SAT(1~3)➟CD➟USB

➟AUX(iPod)➟FM(1~2)...2. button : Raises or lowers

speaker volume.3. button : Places and transfers calls.4. button :Ends calls or cancels functions.5. button : Activates voice recognition.

■ What is Bluetooth®?Bluetooth® is a wireless technology thatallows multiple devices to be connectedin a short range, low-powered deviceslike hands-free, stereo headset, steeringremote control, etc. For more informa-tion, visit the Bluetooth® website atwww.Bluetooth.com

■ General Features• This audio system supports Bluetooth®

hands-free and stereo-headset fea-tures.- HANDS-FREE feature: Making or

receiving calls wirelessly throughvoice recognition.

- STEREO-HEADSET feature: Playingmusic from cellular phones (that sup-ports A2DP feature) wirelessly.

• Voice recognition engine of theBluetooth® system supports 3 types oflanguages:

EnglishCanadian FrenchUS Spanish

✽✽ NOTICE• The phone must be paired to the sys-

tem before using Bluetooth® features.• Only one selected (linked) cellular phone

can be used with the system at a time.• Some phones are not fully compatible

with this system.• The Bluetooth® word mark and logos

are registered trademarks owned byBluetooth® SIG, Inc. and any use ofsuch marks by Kia is under license.A Bluetooth enabled cell phone isrequired to use Bluetooth® wirelesstechnology.

■ Receiving a Phone CallWhen receiving a phone call, a ringtoneis audible from speakers and the audiosystem changes into telephone mode.When receiving a phone call, “Incomingcall” message and incoming phone num-ber (if available) are displayed on theaudio.

• To Answer a Call:- Press button on the steering wheel.• To Reject a Call:- Press button on the steering wheel.• To Adjust Ring Volume:- Use VOLUME buttons on the steering

wheel.• To Transfer a Call to the Phone (Secret

Call):- Press and hold button on the

steering wheel until the audio systemtransfers a call to the phone.

VOLUME

MODE

1

234

5

3 219

Features of your vehicle

■ Talking on the PhoneWhen talking on the phone, “Active Call”message and the other party’s phonenumber (if available) are displayed on theaudio.

• To Finish a Call- Press button on the steering wheel.

✽✽ NOTICEIn the following situations, you or theother party may have difficulty hearingeach other:1. Speaking at the same time, your voice

may not reach each other parties. (Thisis not a malfunction.) Speak alternate-ly with the other party on the phone.

2. Keep the Bluetooth® volume to a lowlevel. High-level volume may result indistortion and echo.

3. When driving on a rough road.4. When driving at high speeds.5. When the window is open.6. When the air conditioning vents are

facing the microphone.7. When the sound of the air condition-

ing fan is loud.

■ Bluetooth® Audio Music StreamingThe audio system supports Bluetooth®

A2DP (Audio Advanced DistributionProfile) and AVRCP (Audio VideoRemote Control Profile) technologies.Both profiles provide steaming of musicvia compatible “PAIRED” Bluetooth®

Cellular phone.To stream music from the Bluetooth® cel-lular phone, play your music files on yourcellular phone according to your cellularphone user’s manual and press the

button on the audio system until“MP3 play” is displayed on the LCD.The audio system head unit displays‘MP3 MODE’.

NOTE:• In addition to streaming MP3 files,

all music and sound files your cellu-lar phone supports can be playedby the audio system.

• Bluetooth® compatible cellularphones must include A2DP andAVRCP capabilities.

• Some A2DP and AVRCP compatibleBluetooth® cellular phones may notplay music through the audio sys-tem initially. These cellular phonesmay need to have the Bluetooth®

streaming enabled, for example;i.e : Menu➟Filemanager➟Music➟

Option➟Play via Bluetooth • Please refer to User’s Guide for your

cellular phone for more information.To cancel Bluetooth® cellular phonemusic streaming, stop music play-back on the cellular phone orchange the audio mode to AM/FM,SIRIUS, CD, iPod, ect.

AUX

Features of your vehicle

2203

■ Phone SetupAll Bluetooth® related operations can beperformed in PHONE menu.1) Push the button to enter

SETUP mode.

2) Rotate the knob to move thecursor between items push the

button to select “PHONE”.3) Rotate the knob to move the

cursor between items and push thebutton to select a desired item.

• Pairing a phoneBefore using Bluetooth® features, thephone must be paired (registered) withthe audio system. Up to 5 phones can bepaired with the system.

NOTE:• The pairing procedure of the phone

varies according to each phonemodel. Before attempting to pairphone, please see your phone’sUser’s Guide for instructions.

• Once pairing with the phone is com-pleted, there is no need to pair withthat phone again unless the phoneis deleted manually from the audiosystem (refer “Deleting a Phone”section) or the vehicle’s informationis removed from the phone.

➀ Press button to enter SETUPmode.

➁ Select “PHONE”, then “PAIR” inPHONE menu.

➂ The audio displays “Device : [Name]passkey: 0000”

➃ Search and select the device name inyour mobile phone to starting the pair-ing process.

NOTE:• If the phone is paired with two or

more vehicles of the same model,some phones may not handleBluetooth® devices of that namecorrectly. In this case, you may needto change the name displayed onyour phone.

For example, if the vehicles' name isKMC CAR, you may need to changethe name displayed on you phonefrom KMC_CAR to JOHNS_CAR orKMC CAR_1 to avoid ambiguity.Refer to your phone User’s Guide, orcontact your cellular carrier or phonemanufacturer for instructions.

• Connecting a phoneWhen the Bluetooth® system is enabled,the phone previously used is automati-cally selected and re-connected. If youwant to select different phone previouslypaired, the phone can be selectedthrough “Select Phone” menu.Only a selected phone can be used withthe hands-free system at a time.

➀ Press button to enter SETUPmode.

➁ Select “PHONE”, then “SELECT” inPHONE menu.

SETUP

SETUP

ENTER

TUNEENTER

TUNE

SETUP

3 221

Features of your vehicle

➂ Select desired phone name from the listshown.

➃ The Bluetooth® icon appears on theupper side of audio display when aphone is connected.

• Changing PriorityIf several phones are paired with theaudio system, the system attempts toconnect following order when theBluetooth® system is enabled:1) “Priority” checked phone.2) Previously connected phone3) Gives up auto connection.

➀ Press button to enter SETUPmode.

➁ Select “PHONE”, then “PRIORITY” inPHONE menu.

➂ Select desired phone name from thelist shown.

• Deleting a PhoneThe paired phone can be deleted.- When the phone is deleted, all the infor-

mation associated with that phone isalso deleted (including phonebook).

- If you want to use the deleted phone withthe audio system again, pairing proce-dure must be completed once more.

➀ Press button to enter SETUPmode.

➁ Select “PHONE”, then “DELETE” inPHONE menu.

➂ Select desired phone name from the listshown.

• ADVANCED MenuAfter pressing the button, selectthe “Phone” menu. while in PHONEmenu, select the “Advanced” menu tomake Bluetooth® Phone settings.(TheADVANCED menu may differ according toaudio specifications.)

Incoming Volume (Bluetooth® call vol-ume adjustments)While in ADVANCED menu, press “In. Vol”Use the knob key to set the desired vol-ume and select the button.

Contacts Sync (Automatic Phonebookdownload setting)While in ADVANCED menu, select“Contacts” To automatically save thecontacts and call history in your mobilephone each time you connect a mobiledevice, select ON. If you do not wish forautomatic download, select OFF.It’s not available to make a phone call bybluetooth audio system while the phone-book is being downloaded.

ENTER

SETUP

SETUP

SETUP

Features of your vehicle

2223

Language of Bluetooth® voice recognitionWhile in ADVANCED menu, select“Language”. To change the language,select the desired language and pressthe button.

Bluetooth® system offWhile in ADVANCED menu, select“BT Off” to turn off the Bluetooth® System.

■ Voice Recognition Activation• The voice recognition engine contained

in the Bluetooth® System can be acti-vated in the following conditions:- Button Activation

The voice recognition system will beactive when the button is pressedand after the sound of a Beep.

- Active ListeningThe voice recognition system will beactive for a period of time when theVoice Recognition system has askedfor a customer response.

• The system can recognize single digitsfrom zero to nine while number greaterthan ten will not be recognized.

• The system shall cancel voice recogni-tion mode in following cases : Whenpressing the button and saying“cancel” following the beep. When notmaking a call and pressing thebutton. When voice recognition hasfailed 3 consecutive times.

• At any time if you say “help”, the systemwill announce what commands areavailable.

■ Menu treeThe menu tree identifies available voicerecognition Bluetooth® functions.

ENTERCall [Name] Ex) Call John(at Home)

Ex) Dial 911Dial [Number]

Redial

Call Back

Add entryPhonebook

Change name

Delete name

By phone

By voice

Call By name

By number

3 223

Features of your vehicle

■ Making a Phone Call• Direct Calling ➀ Press button.➁ Say the following command.

- Call <John> : Connects the call to John.- Call <John> on <Mobile> : Connects

the call to John’s mobile phone number.- Call <John> at <Home> : Connects

the call to john’s home number.- Call <John> in <Office> : Connects

the call to John’s office number.

Note:Calls can be immediately connectedto contacts who name or voice tag aresaved in the phonebook(or contacts).

• Calling by NameA phone call can be made by speakingnames registered in the audio system.

➀ Press button.➁ Say “Call”.➂ Say “By name” when prompted.➃ Say desired name (in Phonebook or

voice tag).➄ Say desired location (phone number

type). Only stored locations can beselected.

➅ Say “Yes” to confirm and make a call.

✽✽ TipA shortcut to each of the following func-tions is available:1. Say “Call Name”

✽✽ Tip■ Voice OperationTo get the best performance out of theVoice Recognition System, observe thefollowings:- Keep the interior of the vehicle as

quiet as possible. Close the windowto eliminate surrounding noise(traffic noise, vibration sounds,etc), which may disturb recogniz-ing the voice command correctly.

- Speak a command after a beepsound within 5 seconds. Otherwisethe command will not be receivedproperly.

- Speak in a natural voice withoutpausing between words.

- While receiving voice commands,press the button on the steer-ing wheel remote controller to ter-minate guidance. Voice commandwill convert back to waiting modeto allow the user to say a new voicecommand.

Features of your vehicle

2243

• Dialing by NumberA phone call can be made by dialing thespoken numbers. The system can recog-nize single digits from zero to nine.

➀ Press button.➁ Say “Call”.➂ Say “By number” when prompted.➃ Say desired phone numbers.➄ Say “Dial” to complete the number and

make a call.

✽✽ TipA shortcut to each of the following func-tions is available:➀ Say “Dial Number”➁ Say “Dial <digit>”

■ Phone Book (In-Vehicle)• Adding entry by voicePhone numbers and voice tags can beregistered. Entries registered in thephone can also be transferred.

➀ Press button.➁ Say "Phonebook".

- The system replies with all availablecommands.

- To skip the information message,press again and then a beep isheard.

➂ Say “Add Entry”.➃ Say “By Voice” to proceed.➄ Say the name of the entry when

prompted.➅ Say “Yes” to confirm.➆ Say the phone number of that entry

when prompted.➇ Say “Store” if phone number input is

finished.➈ Say a phone number type. “Home”,

“Work”, “Mobile”, “Other” or “Default” isavailable.

➉ Say “Yes” to complete adding entry.Say “Yes” to store additional locationfor this contact, or say “Cancel” to fin-ish the process.

✽✽ NOTICE- The system can recognize single digits

from zero to nine. Numbers that areten or greater cannot be recognized.

- You can enter each digit individuallyor group digits together in preferredstring lengths.

- To speed up input, it is a good idea togroup all digits into a continuous string.

- Recommend to enter the numbersconstituted an grouping within alldigit numbers to dial 995 / 734 / 0000

- The display corresponding to eachoperation appears on the screen as fol-lows:Input operation example:1. Say: “Nine, nine, five”

➟ Display: “995”2. And say: “Seven, three, four”

➟ Display: “995734”

11

3 225

Features of your vehicle

• Adding Entry by Phone➀ Press button.➁ Say "Phonebook".➂ Say "Add Entry" after prompt.➃ Say "By Phone" to proceed.➄ Say “Yes” to confirm.➅ Your phone will start to transfer

phone/contact list to the audio system.This process may take over 10 min-utes depending on the phone modeland number of entries

➆ Wait till the audio displays “TransferComplete” message.

• Changing NameThe registered names can be modified.

➀ Press button.➁ Say “Phonebook”.➂ Say “Change Name” after prompt.➃ Say the name of the entry (voice tag).➄ Say “Yes” to confirm.➅ Say new desired name.

• Deleting NameThe registered names can be deleted.

➀ Press button.➁ Say “Phonebook”.➂ Say “Delete Name” after prompt.➃ Say the name of the entry (voice tag).➄ Say “Yes” to confirm.

■ Bluetooth® Audio Speaker AdaptationSpeaker adaptation will improve perform-ance of voice recognition system to aparticular user voice.This will degrade the performance forother users.

• Record➀ Press button for 10sec.➁ Say “Record profile”.➂ Say “Yes”.➃ Say the word displayed on Radio.

• Delete➀ Press button for 10sec.➁ Say “Delete profile”.➂ Say “Yes”.

Features of your vehicle

2263

■ Key matrix

No.

Class

Paired H/PEmpty

Disconnected

1

SHORT

LONG

SHORT

SHORT

LONG[10sec]

LONG[10sec]

Normal mode BT SETUP menuIncoming Call Outgoing Call Active Call 2nd Call

Not Paired Not Connecting - - Accept Call

Connected

-2nd call

1st Call:waiting2nd Call:active

2nd Call2nd Call:waiting1st Call:active

KEY

- - - - - - Transfer call:secret call

End CallVR

MODE CancelVR

MODE CancelVR

MODE CancelVR

MODE CancelReject Call End Call End Call

-

Active

Changelanguage

-

Active

SpeakerAdaptation

(Only English)

Changelanguage

Active

Changelanguage

Active

-Speaker

Adaptation(Only English)

Changelanguage

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

- -

2

3

3 227

Features of your vehicle

WelcomeThe Rear Seat Entertainment (RSE)System is a compact, built-in, easy-to-useentertainment system designed to providefamily fun while you are on the road. Enjoygreat quality sound from the vehiclespeakers, or have a private, quiet viewingwith the wireless headphones.The display unit is mounted to the ceilingin the rear passenger area of the vehicle,allowing rear-seat passengers to playDVD movies, video CDs or music CDs.Users may also plug in a game platform orVHS player. Headphones, game car-tridges and other accessories can be keptneatly out of the way in the 3rd-row arm-rest compartment.

System OverviewThe RSE System includes a mountedcolor monitor with a built-in audio/videocontrol panel and a DVD player. It alsoincludes a remote control and two (2)sets of battery-operated wireless head-phones (batteries are included).

Connections / SetupThe RSE system is designed to makeyour time on the road more enjoyable.Please follow these instructions carefullyto get the most out of your RSE.

✽✽ NOTICERSE operation is prevented during thefirst 2 seconds after the ignition switch isturned to ignition on or accessory mode.

The RSE system is already set up andready for use. The system is always“awake” when the vehicle's ignition isturned on or when the vehicle is in“accessory power mode.”

REAR SEAT ENTERTAINMENT SYSTEM (IF EQUIPPED)

CAUTION• Refrain from using food or drinks

near the RSE, the wireless head-phones or the remote control.

• Direct sunlight may interfere withthe headphone's operation andperformance.

• Normal RSE operation cannot beguaranteed with unofficial dupli-cated discs.

• In order to prevent inadvertentbattery discharge, the RSE willremain in standby mode whenignition switch is turn to ignitionON or accessory mode.

• Use of rear seat entertainmentsystem without the engine run-ning will reduce battery power.

CAUTIONDisclaimer: The RSE system is pro-grammed to the regional displayformats for your region (NTSC orPAL). Please note that your RSE willnot read DVDs from a differentregion.

Features of your vehicle

2283

Viewing/Adjusting the MonitorTo view the monitor, locate the latch onthe bottom center of the mounted unitand pull it forward. This will release themonitor from its locked, stow-away posi-tion. Use your hands to adjust the moni-tor into optimal viewing position. Do nottouch the LCD panel itself to avoid dam-age or smudging.

To close the monitor, pull the bottomedge forward and push it up until it clicksinto the stow-away position.

HeadphonesThe RSE comes with two (2) sets of wire-less headphones and four (4) AAA 1.5Vbatteries. Install the batteries by openingthe compartment on the right side of theheadphones. Each set of headphonesrequires two (2) AAA 1.5V batteries.

RES_OPEN_8111

RES_CLOSED_8111

HEADPHONE8112

HEADPHONE8111

Folded

Spread

Close

Open

3 229

Features of your vehicle

To turn the headphones on, push the but-ton (➊) once. Push the button again toturn the headphones off. The red LEDindicator on the headphone identifies theOn/Off status. The power status indicatoris located on the left headphone.The sound level of the headphones iscontrolled by the volume up[down] knob(➋) located on the side of the head-phones.The headphones can be stored by fold-ing the headphones.

✽✽ NOTICE• Conserve the energy of your batteries

by turning the headphones off whenthey are not in use. The on/off buttonis located on the left side of the head-phones.

• The headphone has an automaticshutoff feature if an IR signal fromthe RSE units is not received after 20seconds. This feature is used to pre-vent inadvertent battery dischargingof the headphones.

• The life cycle of headphone's batteryis usually 48 hours.

• In case of poor reception perform-ance, please check the battery condi-tion.

• The headphones are best used within2-6 feet (0.6-1.8 m) of the RSE unit.Getting too close or too far away willcause poor audio reception.

• Audio from the vehicle's CD/radiocannot be heard through the head-phones.

Audio Via Vehicle SpeakersTo hear the audio from the RSE throughthe vehicle's speakers, the RSE must beselected by the Head Unit in the front ofthe vehicle. To select the RSE, pressAUX button.To end the RSE audio troughthe vehicle’s speakers, press AUX buttonagain. When RSE is de-selected by theHead Unit, the headphones can still beused to hear audio.

HEADPHONE8112 ICDX_VQ-465_1

Features of your vehicle

2303

Connecting Other Devices to the RSEElectronic devices such as video gamesystems, VHS players, Camcorder or etc,can be played through the RSE. Theseexternal devices can be connected to theunit via RCA plugs available throughoutthe vehicle. DC power for additional elec-tronic equipment is provided by one of the12-volt power outlets located in the dash.Additional information can be found in thevehicle manual.Press the SOURCE (SRC) Button toswitch to the externally connected device.(AUX mode)

The RSE unit has an automatic videodetection feature that will automatic switchto external device when the device isplugged into the auxiliary jacks in the vehi-cle.Once the RSE has switched to the exter-nal device, you can make your selectionsby using the buttons on the externaldevice. The RSE controls will not work forexternal devices. For example, to select avideo game after the RSE has recognizedthe source, you must use the game con-trols, not the RSE controls, to choose aselection.The RSE unit will automatically switch tothe RSE mode when the external device isunplugged from the auxiliary jacks.The display mode can be changed byDISP( ) button.

✽✽ NOTICEOnly external devices that have anactive video source - such as video gamesystems or VHS players - can be read bythe RSE. The RSE will not play anexternal device that only has an audiosource, such as a cassette player or otherCD player.

✽✽ NOTICEWhen using an external device connect-ed to the power outlet, noise may occurduring playback. If this happens, usethe power source of the external device.

Cleaning of DisplayIf the LCD display becomes dusty ordirty, clean it by wiping gently with a soft,dry, clean cloth.

CAUTIONConnect only appropriate inputsources to the RSE jacks.Connecting an incorrect input maycause damage to the player and/orthe external electronic device.

AUX-INPUT-8111A

RCA plug

3 231

Features of your vehicle

Using the DVD playerDisc compatibilityYour RSE player accepts and plays allDVDs in 4:3 (normal) and 16:9 (widescreen) video formats. With DVDs thatoffer multiple formats, the default formatis 16:9 and will stay that way unless theuser changes the format. (See “Display”to learn how to adjust the format.)

✽✽ NOTICE• The DVD player has the capability to

play DVD-Video, DVD-R, DVD-RW,CD-DA, CD-R, CD-RW and Video-CD.

• The DVD player has the capability toplay CD-DA, DVD, VCD, PCM,Dolby Digital and DTS formats.

• Please refer to the appendix for theerror messages.

Loading a DiscInsert the disc part way into the load slot.The player will automatically grip the discand pull it in the rest of the way. The playerwill display “reading” on the screen andshow the “Kia Motors” logo before begin-ning the DVD.

The player is only capable of reading thebottom side of a disc. When inserting asingle-sided disc, the label side should beup. When inserting a two-sided disc, thedesired play side should be down.

✽✽ NOTICE• Because there is no universal standard

for DVD programming, your disc maybehave differently than below. SomeDVDs may present warning messagesabout unauthorized duplication, somewill go directly to a menu and othersmay start playing the movie immedi-ately.

• When the vehicle's ignition is active,the loading of any playable disc willcause the player to initialize and auto-matically play the disc. If a disc wasplaying prior to the ignition beingturned off, it will not automaticallyreplay once the ignition is turned onagain. Instead, it will go into standbymode. Press the SRC orPLAY/PAUSE( ) button to “wakeup” the unit and resume disc play.

Disc ProtectionThe player has an Auto-Reload DiscProtection feature to protect discs fromaccidental damage. If an ejected disc isnot removed within 25 seconds after beingejected, it will be pulled back into the play-er.The disc will not begin playing. Disc canbe played by the SRC orPLAY/PAUSE( ) buttons.

DVD ControlsYou can control your DVD by using thebuttons on the unit's control panel or byusing the remote control. Instructions forthe controls listed below are the samewhether you are using the control panelor the remote control. However, there arefunctions that are only available from theremote control. These buttons and theirfunctionality are discussed in the“REMOTE CONTROL” section begin-ning.

Features of your vehicle

2323

VIDEO MODE OPERATION (IF EQUIPPED)

1. STOP/EJECT

2. SPEAKER VOLUME CONTROL

3. PLAY/PAUSE

4. DISPLAY

5. FORWARD

6. REVERSE

7. NEXT CHAPTER

8. PREVIOUS CHAPTER

9. ENTER

10. MENU

11. SOURCE

RES_OPEN_8111

3 233

Features of your vehicle

✽✽ NOTICEThe RSE will enter standby mode whenthe vehicle ignition is turned off andback on. Press the SRC orPLAY/PAUSE( ) button to “wakeup” the unit and resume disc play.

1. Stop/Eject While the disc is playing, press theSTOP/EJECT ( ) button to stop discplay. When the disc has stopped, pressthe button again to eject the disc.

✽✽ NOTICEThe player has an Auto-Reload DiscProtection feature to protect discs fromaccidental damage. If an ejected disc isnot removed within 25 seconds afterbeing ejected, it will be pulled back intothe player. This is to protect the discfrom accidental damage.

2. Speaker Volume ControlYou can adjust the volume one of twoways. First, if you are adjusting the vol-ume for audio through the vehicle speak-ers, you can use the VOLUME button onthe control panel or the remote control.This button is reserved for sending a sig-nal to the vehicle speakers only, and willnot adjust the headphone volume. Press“+” to increase the volume and “-” todecrease the volume.Second, the volume on the wirelessheadphones can be adjusted by turningthe VOL knob located on the left side ofthe headphones.

3. Play/Pause You do not need to press the play buttonafter first loading a DVD or VCD; it willstart automatically by playing the firsttrack or bringing up the disc menu.If the disc does not automatically load,press PLAY/PAUSE( ) to play the DVD.While playing a DVD, press PLAY/PAUSE( ) to pause the DVD. Pressthe button again to resume play.

4. Display When the player is in DVD mode, press theDISP button to view the DVD title, chapternumber and elapsed time and other infor-mation about the DVD currently playing.It will also display brightness. There are“Day Time” brightness with brightest leveland “Night Time” brightness which has 70%level of “Day Time” brightness. Adjust thelevel of brightness by pressing theREV(dimmer) or FWD(brighter) buttons.The next time the player is turned on, it willreturn to the brightness level it was adjustedto when last used.The RSE unit has two presets of displaybrightness. When the headlamp is turnedon, the display brightness level will bedimmed as the preset. However, when theheadlamp is turned off, the display bright-ness will return to the daytime brightness.Press DISP to adjust the image format.Theimage format, also known as the aspectratio, is a ratio of the height to width of theimage on the screen. For example, a 4:3ratio would mean an image that is 4 units by3 units.

Features of your vehicle

2343

You have two options: 4:3 (normal) and 16:9(widescreen). Press the display button toselect the preferred aspect ratio.When the RSE unit receives video signalsfrom the AUX, the aspect ratio can bechanged to 16:9 or 4:3 by the DISP button.The aspect ratio information will auto-matically disappear if no button ispressed for three seconds.

5. ForwardThere are three DVD and VCD fast for-ward speeds. Press and hold the FWDbutton for up to 2 seconds and the playerwill fast forward at 4 times the normalspeed (8 times for VCDs). Hold the but-ton for more than 2 seconds but less than4 seconds and the player will fast forwardat about 8 times the normal speed (20times for VCDs). Hold the button for morethan 4 seconds and the fast forward willincrease to about 32 times the normalspeed for both DVDs and VCDs. Pressthe FWD button again to stop fast for-warding and return to normal speed play.

6. ReverseThere are three DVD and VCD fastreverse speeds. Press and hold the REVbutton for up to 2 seconds and the playerwill reverse through the DVD at 4 timesthe normal speed (8 times for VCDs).Hold the button for more than 2 secondsbut less than 4 seconds and the playerwill reverse at about 8 times the normalspeed (20 times for VCDs). Hold the but-ton for more than 4 seconds and thereverse will increase to 32 times the nor-mal speed for both DVDs and VCDs.Press the REV button again to stopreversing and return to normal speedplay.

7. Next ChapterWhile a DVD is playing, press the NEXTbutton to skip to the next chapter. Thecurrent chapter number is shown on thescreen. Press and hold the NEXT buttonto move quickly through the chapters.

✽✽ NOTICEDepending on the DVD, if NEXT ispressed during the last chapter on aDVD, a red circle with a “Invalidicon[ ]” may be displayed, indicatingan invalid button press.

8. Previous ChapterPress the PREV button to skip to thebeginning of the previous chapter. Pressand hold the PREV button to move quick-ly through the chapters.Depending on your DVD, if the PREVbutton is pressed during the first 8 sec-onds of the first chapter, the player willskip to the beginning of the last chapterof the DVD.

9. EnterA momentary press shall initiate a selector enter function of a selected menuitem.

10. Menu DVDs may contain special programmingor features that are accessed by using themenu. To use the menu with a DVD that isplaying, press the MENU button once todisplay the DVD disc menu. Press the but-ton a second time to exit the menu andreturn to the DVD program.The menu is not available during disc ini-tialization, the beginning credits or anycopyright FBI warnings.

3 235

Features of your vehicle

When viewing a menu, pressing theMENU button again will automaticallyreturn to the movie at the point it wasbeing viewed.You can also select “play” orany other option by using the NEXT,PREV, FWD and REV buttons.Press the NEXT button to move the cursorup and the PREV button to move the cur-sor down the menu.Press the FWD button to move the cursorto the right, and the REV button to movethe cursor to the left.

✽✽ NOTICEYou must repeatedly push any button tomove through several items. Pressingand holding any button will not advancethe cursor beyond the position justmoved.

Press ENTER to select the desired menuchoice.

11. SourcePress the SOURCE button to switch fromthe RSE’s internal DVD player to anexternal device such as a VCR or videogame. The sound and images from theexternal source will be presentedthrough the RSE.

Pressing the SRC button will switchbetween the following RSE states:

Playback state - will play DVDs, VCDs, andCDs

Auxiliary (AUX) state - will play videogames and other external devices

When an external source is selected, theRSE’s internal DVD player turns off.Press the SRC button to switch backfrom the external source to the internalDVD player.If a disc is present in the DVD player, thedisc will begin to play. If another sourcehas been detected, such as a VCR orvideo game, the RSE will enter the AUXmode automatically and shall remain sountil a disc is inserted or until the PLAY/SRC button is pressed on the RSE's frontpanel or on the remote control. If thevehicle ignition is on but the player isn'tbeing used, the display will power off.The DVD mechanism will be in sleepmode, but the main RSE's controller willstay up to accept commands from thefront panel controls or the remote control.

✽✽ NOTICEThe external device must be correctlyconnected to the RSE in order to playproperly.

Using the CD PlayerThe RSE will play audio CDs in both thestandard (12 cm) and mini-disc (8 cm)format.

✽✽ NOTICEWhile the player will accept DVDROMs and CD ROMs discs, the RSEcannot play discs in these formats andwill eject them.

With power applied to your unit, insertthe disc part way into the load slot. Theplayer will automatically grip the CD disc,pull it the rest of the way in and beginplaying.

CD ControlsThe following functions are availablewhen playing audio CDs.

Features of your vehicle

2363

AUDIO MODE OPERATION (IF EQUIPPED)

1. STOP/EJECT

2. VOLUME CONTROL

3. PLAY/PAUSE

4. DISPLAY

5. FORWARD

6. REVERSE

7. NEXT TRACK

8. PREVIOUS TRACK

RES_CLOSED_8111

3 237

Features of your vehicle

1. Stop/Eject While the disc is playing, press theSTOP/EJECT( ) button to stop discplay.While the disc is stopped, press theSTOP/EJECT( ) button again to ejectthe disc.

2. Volume Control You can adjust the volume one of twoways. First, if you are adjusting the vol-ume for audio through the vehicle speak-ers, you can use the VOLUME ()button on the control panel or theremote control. Press “+” to increase thevolume and “-” to decrease the volume.The volume level will be displayed on thehead-unit, when the RSE unit volumelevel is adjusted from its control panel orremote control. This button does notaffect headphone volume.Second, you can adjust the volume onthe wireless headphones by locating theVOL control wheel on the left side of theheadphones. Roll the control wheel toadjust the volume.

3. Play/Pause When an audio CD is inserted, the RSEwill display the KIA logo, then automati-cally begin playing the first track. Thetrack number and time elapsed for thecurrent track is displayed.If a CD is loaded and playing, press thePLAY/PAUSE( ) button to pause theCD. Press the button again to resumeplay.If a CD is already loaded, stopping andplaying the CD by pressingPLAY/PAUSE( ) button on the remotecontrol; cycling the ignition and pressingplay; or changing the source will cause theCD to begin playing at the point where itwas stopped during the previous play. Theplayer will automatically play this previousplay position unless theSTOP/EJECT( ) button is pressed.At the end of the CD, the player will auto-matically return to the first track and con-tinue playing.

4. Display When the player is in DVD mode, press theDISP button to view the DVD title, chapternumber and elapsed time and other infor-mation about the DVD currently playing.The next time the player is turned on, it willreturn to the brightness level it was adjustedto when last used.The RSE unit has two presets of displaybrightness. When the headlamp is turnedon, the display brightness level will bedimmed as the preset. However, when theheadlamp is turned off, the display bright-ness will return to the daytime brightness.Press DISP to adjust the image format.Theimage format, also known as the aspectratio, is a ratio of the height to width of theimage on the screen. For example, a 4:3ratio would mean an image that is 4 units by3 units. You have two options: 4:3 (normal)and 16:9 (widescreen). Press the displaybutton to select the preferred aspect ratio.When the RSE unit receives video signalsfrom the AUX, the aspect ratio can bechanged to 16:9 or 4:3 by the DISP button.The aspect ratio information will auto-matically disappear if no button ispressed for three seconds.

Features of your vehicle

2383

5. ForwardThere are two CD fast forward speeds.Press and hold the FWD button for up to2 seconds and the player will fast forwardat 3 times the normal speed. Hold thebutton for more than 2 seconds and theplayer will fast forward at about 10 timesthe normal speed. When the holding but-ton is released, the RSE unit will auto-matically return to a play mode.

6. ReverseThere are two fast reverse speeds. TheRSE unit will fast reverse at 3 times thenormal speed, if the REV button ispressed. Hold the button for more than 2seconds and the RSE unit will fastreverse at about 10 times the normalspeed. When the button is released, theRSE unit will automatically return to aplay mode.

7. Next TrackPress the NEXT button to skip to thebeginning of the next track. The nexttrack number is displayed on the screen.Press and hold the NEXT button for 2seconds or more to move quickly throughthe tracks.

8. Previous TrackPress the PREV button to skip to thebeginning of the current track.Press the PREV button during the first 8seconds of the current track to skip to thebeginning of the previous track.Press the PREV button during the first 8seconds of the first track to skip to thebeginning of the last track on the CD.Press and hold the PREV button for 2seconds or more to move quickly throughthe tracks.

3 239

Features of your vehicle

REMOTE CONTROL

1. STOP

2. SPEAKER VOL (+, -)

3. PLAY/PAUSE

4. DISPLAY

5. FORWARD

6. REVERSE

7. NEXT

8. PREVIOUS

9. ENTER

10. MENU

11. SOURCE

12. ANGLE

13. SUBSCRIPT

14. LANGUAGE

15. SLOW PLAY

16. ON/OFF

REMOTE_CONTROL_8111

Features of your vehicle

2403

Using the Remote ControlIn addition to having all the buttons andfunctionality listed in the DVD and CDControls section, the remote control hasseveral other buttons that offer additionalfunctions. It is an infrared remote control,and must be pointed at the face of theRSE at a 45° angle for best results. Itrequires a CR2025 battery (included).The remote control has the followingadditional buttons:

✽✽ NOTICEThe RSE system is always “awake”when the vehicle's ignition is turned onor when the vehicle is in “accessorypower mode.”

1. StopPressing this button once will stop DVDor CD play. To eject a disc, you must usethe eject button on the control panel.

2. Speaker Volume “+” and “-”These buttons control the volume of theaudio of a DVD or CD through the vehiclespeakers, not the volume from head-phones. Press “+” to turn the volume upand “-” to turn the volume down.

3. Play/PauseWhen an audio CD(VCD/DVD) is insert-ed, the RSE will display the KIA logo,then automatically begin playing the firsttrack.The track number and time elapsedfor the current track is displayed.If a CD(VCD/DVD) is loaded and playing,press the PLAY/PAUSE( ) button topause the CD(VCD/DVD). Press the but-ton again to resume play.If a CD(VCD/DVD) is already loaded, stop-ping and playing the CD(VCD/ DVD) bypressing PLAY/PAUSE( ) button onthe remote control; cycling the ignition andpressing play; or changing the source willcause the CD(VCD/DVD) to begin playingat the point where it was stopped duringthe previous play. The player will automati-cally play this previous play position unlessthe STOP/EJECT( ) button is pressed.At the end of the CD(VCD/DVD), theplayer will automatically return to the firsttrack and continue playing.

4. DisplayWhen the player is in DVD mode, press theDISP button to view the DVD title, chapternumber and elapsed time and other infor-mation about the DVD currently playing.

It will also display brightness. There are“Day Time” brightness with brightest leveland “Night Time” brightness which has 70%level of “Day Time” brightness. Adjust thelevel of brightness by pressing theREV(dimmer) or FWD(brighter) buttons.The next time the player is turned on, it willreturn to the brightness level it was adjustedto when last used.The RSE unit has two presets of displaybrightness. When the headlamp is turnedon, the display brightness level will bedimmed as the preset. However, when theheadlamp is turned off, the display bright-ness will return to the daytime brightness.Press DISP to adjust the image format.Theimage format, also known as the aspectratio, is a ratio of the height to width of theimage on the screen. For example, a 4:3ratio would mean an image that is 4 units by3 units. You have two options: 4:3 (normal)and 16:9 (widescreen). Press the displaybutton to select the preferred aspect ratio.When the RSE unit receives video signalsfrom the AUX, the aspect ratio can bechanged to 16:9 or 4:3 by the DISP button.The aspect ratio information will auto-matically disappear if no button ispressed for three seconds.

3 241

Features of your vehicle

5. ForwardThere are three DVD and VCD fast for-ward speeds. Press and hold the FWDbutton for up to 2 seconds and the playerwill fast forward at 4 times the normalspeed (8 times for VCDs). Hold the but-ton for more than 2 seconds but less than4 seconds and the player will fast forwardat about 8 times the normal speed (20times for VCDs). Hold the button for morethan 4 seconds and the fast forward willincrease to about 32 times the normalspeed for both DVDs and VCDs. Pressthe FWD button again to stop fast for-warding and return to normal speed play.

6. ReverseThere are three DVD and VCD fastreverse speeds. Press and hold the REVbutton for up to 2 seconds and the playerwill reverse through the DVD at 4 timesthe normal speed (8 times for VCDs).Hold the button for more than 2 secondsbut less than 4 seconds and the playerwill reverse at about 8 times the normalspeed (20 times for VCDs). Hold the but-ton for more than 4 seconds and thereverse will increase to 32 times the nor-mal speed for both DVDs and VCDs.Press the REV button again to stopreversing and return to normal speedplay.

7. Next While a DVD is playing, press the NEXTbutton to skip to the next chapter. Thecurrent chapter number is shown on thescreen. Press and hold the NEXT buttonto move quickly through the chapters.

✽✽ NOTICEDepending on the DVD, if NEXT ispressed during the last chapter on aDVD, a red circle with a “Invalidicon[ ]” may be displayed, indicatingan invalid button press.

8. PreviousPress the PREV button to skip to thebeginning of the previous chapter. Pressand hold the PREV button to move quick-ly through the chapters.Depending on your DVD, if the PREVbutton is pressed during the first 8 sec-onds of the first chapter, the player willskip to the beginning of the last chapterof the DVD.

9. EnterA momentary press shall initiate a selector enter function of a selected menuitem.

10. Menu DVDs may contain special programmingor features that are accessed by using themenu. To use the menu with a DVD that isplaying, press the MENU button once todisplay the DVD disc menu. Press the but-ton a second time to exit the menu andreturn to the DVD program.The menu is not available during disc ini-tialization, the beginning credits or anycopyright FBI warnings.When viewing a menu, pressing theMENU button again will automaticallyreturn to the movie at the point it wasbeing viewed.You can also select “play” orany other option by using the NEXT,PREV, FWD and REV buttons.Press the NEXT button to move the cursorup and the PREV button to move the cur-sor down the menu.Press the FWD button to move the cursorto the right, and the REV button to movethe cursor to the left.

Features of your vehicle

2423

✽✽ NOTICEYou must repeatedly push any button tomove through several items. Pressingand holding any button will not advancethe cursor beyond the position justmoved.

Press ENTER to select the desired menuchoice.

11. SourcePress the SOURCE button to switch fromthe RSE’s internal DVD player to anexternal device such as a VCR or videogame. The sound and images from theexternal source will be presentedthrough the RSE.

Pressing the SRC button will switchbetween the following RSE states:

Playback state - will play DVDs, VCDs, andCDs

Auxiliary (AUX) state - will play videogames and other external devices

When an external source is selected, theRSE’s internal DVD player turns off.Press the SRC button to switch backfrom the external source to the internalDVD player.If a disc is present in the DVD player, thedisc will begin to play. If another sourcehas been detected, such as a VCR orvideo game, the RSE will enter the AUXmode automatically and shall remain sountil a disc is inserted or until the PLAY/SRC button is pressed on the RSE’s frontpanel or on the remote control. If thevehicle ignition is on but the player isn'tbeing used, the display will power off.The DVD mechanism will be in sleepmode, but the main RSE's controller willstay up to accept commands from thefront panel controls or the remote control.

✽✽ NOTICEThe external device must be correctlyconnected to the RSE in order to playproperly.

12. AngleSome DVDs offer different scene angles.If available on the DVD, the ANGLE but-ton will show you the other availablescene angles. If angle scenes are notavailable, then “Invalid icon[ ]” will bedisplayed. Pressing the ANGLE buttonduring CD play will do nothing.

13. SubscriptThe SUBSC button allows you to displayor remove language subtitles. If no lan-guage subtitles are available, the displaywill show an invalid icon[ ]. Pressing theSUBSC button during CD play will donothing.

14. LanguagePressing the LANG button will allow youto select your preferred language, if avail-able. Select the language and then pressenter. If no other languages are available,the display will show an invalid icon[ ].Pressing the LANG button during CDplay will do nothing.

3 243

Features of your vehicle

15. Slow PlayThere are 3 slow forward and 3 slowreverse speeds available when viewingDVDs. To review a DVD in slow motion,first press the PLAY/PAUSE ( ) buttonto pause the DVD, then press either REVor FWD (( ) or ( ) on the remote con-trol) to select slow playback in eitherreverse or forward.Pressing either the REV or FWD (( ) or( ) on the remote control) button oncechanges the player to 1/8 of normalspeed. Press the button again to return topause mode.Press and hold either button for morethan 2 seconds but less than 4 secondsand the player will switch to 1/4 of thenormal speed. Hold either button formore than 4 seconds and the player willswitch to 1/2 of the normal speed.

From the remote control for DVD, you canimmediately switch to 1/8 forward orbackward speed with the ( , ) but-tons. Press either button again to returnto normal play.While using the Slow Play feature, thecurrent play speed is displayed on thescreen.Press PLAY again to resume normalplay.

16. On/OffThis button will only turn off the DVD orCD and display, not the system itself. Thesystem will remain on standby.

Features of your vehicle

2443

AppendixMessages

Technical Specifications

NON PLAYABLE MEDIA An incompatible format disc is inserted, or the disc is not playable.

[INVALID ICON] Invalid button press: The PREV button was pressed during the first chapter of a DVD, or theNEXT button was pressed during the last chapter of a DVD.

NO DISC Displayed with the PLAY button is pressed but not disc is in the player.

READING The player is searching the disc to determine its format and check for any special program-ming.

STOP A disc is inserted in the RSE but not playing.

DISC ERROR The inserted disc is either scratched or otherwise damaged, and cannot be played.

REGION ERROR The region code of the disc is different from the RSE DVD region setting. The RSE unit canonly play disc from the intent region. (ie, Korean Region, US region, European region, etc…)

Input power requirements 12 volts nominal (10.5 to 15.5 volts) @ 5 amps nominal (10amps peak max)

A/V inputs - Audio Input : 1 volts nominal (0.8 to 1.2 V)- Video Input : 1 volts nominal (0.7 to 1.4 V)

3 245

Features of your vehicle

Troubleshooting

Problem Possible causes / solutions

Press the STOP/EJECT button to release the disc. The player will attempt to eject the discup to three times before performing the Auto-Reload function. Once the Auto-Reload func-tion is complete, press the STOP/EJECT button again to release the disc from the player.If a disc is still stuck or blocked in the RSE unit, turn the ignition off and then on again to resetthe RSE unit.

Verify that the headphone is equipped with batteries, and that the batteries are charged.Insert or replace 2 AAA batteries to resume headphone function.

If the display does not show “NO DISC”, then there is no power. Check the vehicle fuse. If theRSE still does not work, contact your authorized Kia dealer.

Make sure you are pointing the remote control at the face of the RSE at a 45° angle. Changethe battery. [Device requires one (1) CR2025 battery.] Use the control buttons on the RSEdisplay panel. If the remote control still does not work, contact your authorized Kia dealer.

Invalid button press. The function you are trying to perform is not available.

The disc becomes stuck orblocked.

There is no audio in the head-phones.

The RSE does not work.

The remote control does notwork.

Continue receiving an invalidicon[ ] when a button ispressed

4

Before driving / 4-2Key positions / 4-3Starting the engine / 4-4Automatic transaxle / 4-5Cruise control system / 4-11Brake system / 4-14Electronic stability control / 4-19Rear parking assist system / 4-21Rearview camera / 4-24

Economical operation / 4-25Special driving conditions / 4-26Winter driving / 4-28Trailer towing / 4-28Overloading / 4-34Label information / 4-35

Driving your vehicle

Driving your vehicle

24

Before entering vehicle:• Be sure that all windows, outside mir-

ror(s), and outside lights are clean.• Check the condition of the tires.• Check under the vehicle for any sign of

leaks.• Be sure there are no obstacles behind

you if you intend to back up.

Necessary inspections Fluid levels, such as engine oil, enginecoolant, brake fluid, and washer fluidshould be checked on a regular basis,with the exact interval depending on thefluid. Further details are provided inSection 6, Maintenance.

Before starting • Close and lock all doors.• Position the seat so that all controls are

easily reached.• Adjust the inside and outside rearview

mirrors.• Be sure that all lights work.• Check all gauges.• Check the operation of warning lights

when the ignition switch is turned tothe ON position.

• Release the parking brake and makesure the brake warning light goes out.

For safe operation, be sure you are famil-iar with your vehicle and its equipment.

BEFORE DRIVING

(Continued)You are much more likely to have aserious accident if you drink or takedrugs and drive.If you are drinking or taking drugs,don’t drive. Do not ride with a driv-er who has been drinking or takingdrugs. Choose a designated driveror call a cab.

WARNING - Driving underthe influence of alcohol ordrugs

Drinking and driving is dangerous.Drunk driving is the number onecontributor to the highway deathtoll each year. Even a small amountof alcohol will affect your reflexes,perceptions and judgement. Drivingwhile under the influence of drugsis as dangerous or more dangerousthan driving drunk.

(Continued)

WARNINGDriving while distracted can resultin a loss of vehicle control, that maylead to an accident, severe person-al injury, and death. The driver’sprimary responsibility is in the safeand legal operation of a vehicle, anduse of any handheld devices, otherequipment, or vehicle systemswhich take the driver’s eyes, atten-tion and focus away from the safeoperation of a vehicle or which arenot permissible by law shouldnever be used during operation ofthe vehicle.

WARNING• When you make a sudden stop or

turn the steering wheel rapidly,loose objects may drop on thefloor and it could interfere withthe operation of the foot pedals,possibly causing an accident.Keep all things in the vehiclesafely stored.

• If you do not focus on driving, itmay cause an accident. Be care-ful when operating what may dis-turb driving such as audio orheater. It is the responsibility ofthe driver to always drive safely.

4 3

Driving your vehicle

Illuminated ignition switch (if equipped)Whenever front door is opened, the igni-tion switch will be illuminated for yourconvenience, provided the ignition switchis not in the ON position. The light will gooff immediately when the ignition switchis turned on or go off after about 10 sec-onds when the door is closed.

Ignition switch and anti-theftsteering column lock Ignition switch positionLOCKThe steering wheel locks to protectagainst theft. The ignition key can beremoved only in the LOCK position.When turning the ignition switch to theLOCK position, push the key inward atthe ACC position and turn the key towardthe LOCK position.

ACC (Accessory)The steering wheel is unlocked and elec-trical accessories are operative.

ONThe warning lights can be checkedbefore the engine is started. This is thenormal running position after the engineis started.Do not leave the ignition switch ON if theengine is not running to prevent batterydischarge.

STARTTurn the ignition key to the START posi-tion to start the engine. The engine willcrank until you release the key; then itreturns to the ON position. The brakewarning lamp can be checked in thisposition.

✽✽ NOTICEIf difficulty is experienced turning theignition switch to the ACC position, turnthe key while turning the steering wheelright and left to release the tension.

KEY POSITIONS

1VQA3017 1VQA3018

WARNINGWhen you intend to park or stop thevehicle with the engine on, be care-ful not to depress the acceleratorpedal for a long period of time. Itmay overheat the engine or exhaustsystem and cause fire.

Driving your vehicle

44

STARTING THE ENGINE

1. Make sure the parking brake isapplied.

2. Place the transaxle shift lever in P(Park). Depress the brake pedal fully.You can also start the engine whenthe shift lever is in the N (Neutral)position.

3. Turn the ignition switch to START andhold it there until the engine starts (amaximum of 10 seconds), thenrelease the key.

4. In extremely cold weather (below -18°C / 0°F) or after the vehicle hasnot been operated for several days, letthe engine warm up without depress-ing the accelerator.

Whether the engine is cold or warm, itshould be started without depressingthe accelerator.

WARNING - Ignition key• Never turn the ignition switch to

LOCK or ACC while the vehicle ismoving.This would result in loss ofdirectional control and brakingfunction, which could cause anaccident.

• The anti-theft steering column lockis not a substitute for the parkingbrake. Before leaving the driver’sseat, always make sure the shiftlever is engaged in P (Park) forautomatic transaxle, set the park-ing brake fully and shut the engineoff. Unexpected and sudden vehi-cle movement may occur if theseprecautions are not taken.

• Never reach for the ignition switch,or any other controls through thesteering wheel while the vehicle isin motion. The presence of yourhand or arm in this area couldcause a loss of vehicle control, anaccident and serious bodily injuryor death.

• Do not place any movable objectsaround the driver’s seat as theymay move while driving, interferewith the driver and lead to an acci-dent.

CAUTIONIf the engine stalls while you are inmotion, do not attempt to move theshift lever to the P (Park) position. Iftraffic and road conditions permit,you may put the shift lever in the N(Neutral) position while the vehicleis still moving and turn the ignitionswitch to the START position in anattempt to restart the engine.

CAUTIONDo not engage the starter for morethan 10 seconds. If the engine stallsout or fails to start, wait 5 to 10 sec-onds before re-engaging the starter.Improper use of the starter maydamage it.

WARNINGAlways wear appropriate shoeswhen operating your vehicle.Unsuitable shoes (high heels, skiboots,etc.) may interfere with yourability to use the brake and acceler-ator pedal.

4 5

Driving your vehicle

AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE

OVQ049059

The lock release button must be depressed while moving the shift lever.

Depress the brake pedal and push the button when shifting.

The shift lever can be moved without depressing the lock release button.

+ (UP)

- (DOWN)

Sports modeAutomatic mode

Lock release button prevents shift levermovement without first depressing the button.

Driving your vehicle

64

Automatic transaxle operationAll normal forward driving is done withthe shift lever in the D (Drive) position.To move the shift lever from the P (Park)position, the brake pedal must bedepressed and the lock release buttonmust be depressed.

For smooth operation, depress the brakepedal when shifting from N (Neutral) to aforward or reverse gear.

WARNING - Automatictransaxle

Before leaving the driver’s seat,always make sure the shift lever isin the P (PARK) position; then setthe parking brake fully and shut theengine off. Unexpected and suddenvehicle movement can occur ifthese precautions are not followedin the order identified.

1VQA3024

Automaticmode

CAUTION• To avoid damage to your

transaxle, do not accelerate theengine in R (Reverse) or any for-ward gear position with thebrakes on.

• When stopped on an upgrade, donot hold the vehicle stationarywith engine power. Use the serv-ice brake or the parking brake.

• Do not shift from N (Neutral) or P(Park) into D (Drive), or R(Reverse) when the engine isabove idle speed.

4 7

Driving your vehicle

Transaxle rangesP (park)Always come to a complete stop beforeshifting into P (Park). This position locksthe transaxle and prevents the frontwheels from rotating.

R (reverse)Use this position to drive the vehiclebackward.

N (neutral)The wheels and transaxle are not locked.The vehicle will roll freely even on theslightest incline unless the parking brakeor service brakes are applied.

D (drive)This is the normal forward driving posi-tion. The transaxle will automatically shiftthrough a 6-gear sequence, providing thebest fuel economy and power.

For extra power when passing anothervehicle or climbing grades, depress theaccelerator fully, at which time thetransaxle will automatically downshift tothe next lower gear.

✽✽ NOTICEAlways come to a complete stop beforeshifting into D (Drive).

(Continued)• Never leave a child unattended in

a vehicle.

CAUTIONThe transaxle may be damaged ifyou shift into P (Park) while thevehicle is in motion.

CAUTIONAlways come to a complete stopbefore shifting into or out of R(Reverse); you may damage thetransaxle if you shift into R whilethe vehicle is in motion, except asexplained in “Rocking the Vehicle”,in this manual.

WARNING• Shifting into P (Park) while the

vehicle is in motion will cause thedrive wheels to lock which willcause you to lose control of thevehicle.

• Do not use the P (Park) positionin place of the parking brake.Always make sure the shift leveris latched in the P (Park) positionso that it cannot be moved unlessthe lock release button is pushedin, AND set the parking brakefully.

• Before leaving the driver’s seat,always make sure the shift leveris in the P (PARK) position. Setthe parking brake fully, shut theengine off and take the key withyou. Unexpected and suddenvehicle movement can occur ifyou do not follow these precau-tions in the order specified.

(Continued)

Driving your vehicle

84

Sports modeWhether the vehicle is stationary or inmotion, sports mode is selected by push-ing the shift lever from the “D” positioninto the manual gate. To return to “D”range operation, push the shift lever backinto the main gate.

In sports mode, moving the shift leverbackwards and forwards will allow you tomake gearshifts rapidly. In contrast to amanual transaxle, the sports modeallows gearshifts with the acceleratorpedal depressed.

Up (+) : Push the lever forward once toshift up one gear.

Down (-) : Pull the lever backwards onceto shift down one gear.

✽✽ NOTICE• In sports mode, the driver must exe-

cute upshifts in accordance with roadconditions, taking care to keep theengine speed below the red zone.

• In sports mode, only the five forwardgears can be selected. To reverse orpark the vehicle, move the shift leverto the “R” or “P” position as required.

• In sports mode, downshifts are madeautomatically when the vehicle slowsdown. When the vehicle stops, 1st gearis automatically selected.

(Continued)

(Continued)• In sports mode, when the engine rpm

approaches the red zone, shift pointsare varied to upshift automatically.

• To maintain the required levels ofvehicle performance and safety, thesystem may not execute certaingearshifts when the shift lever is oper-ated.

• When driving on a slippery road,push the shift lever forward into the+(up) position. This causes thetransaxle to shift into the 2nd gearwhich is better for smooth driving ona slippery road. Push the shift lever tothe -(down) side to shift back to the 1stgear.

OVQ039025

+ (UP)

- (DOWN)

Sports mode

4 9

Driving your vehicle

Moving up a steep grade from astanding startTo move up a steep grade from a stand-ing start, depress the brake pedal, shiftthe shift lever to D (Drive). Select theappropriate gear depending on loadweight and steepness of the grade, andrelease the parking brake. Depress theaccelerator gradually while releasing theservice brakes.When accelerating from a stop on asteep hill, the vehicle may have a ten-dency to roll backwards. Shifting theshift lever into 2 (Second Gear) whilein Sports mode will help prevent thevehicle from rolling backwards.

Shift lock system For your safety, the automatic transaxlehas a shift lock system which preventsshifting the transaxle out of P (Park)unless the brake pedal is depressed.To shift the transaxle out of P (Park):1. Depress and hold the brake pedal.2. Start the engine or turn the ignition to

the ON position.3. Depress the lock release button and

move the shift lever.If the brake pedal is repeatedlydepressed and released with the shiftlever in the P (Park) position, a chatteringnoise near the shift lever may be heard.This is a normal condition.

Shift-lock overrideIf the shift lever should fail to move fromthe P (Park) position with the brake pedaldepressed, continue depressing thebrake, then do the following:1. Carefully remove the cap covering the

S/Lock override access hole which islocated on the right side of the shiftlever.

OVQ039026

Driving your vehicle

104

2. Insert the screwdriver into the accesshole and press down on the screwdriv-er.

3. Depress the lock release button andmove the shift lever.

4. Have your vehicle inspected by anauthorized Kia dealership immediately.

Ignition key interlock system The ignition key cannot be removedunless the shift lever is in the P (Park)position. If the ignition switch is in anyother position, the key cannot beremoved.

OVQ039027 OVQ039028

4 11

Driving your vehicle

The cruise control system allows you toprogram the vehicle to maintain a con-stant speed without resting your foot onthe accelerator pedal.This system is designed to functionabove approximately 40 km/h (24 mph).

To set cruise control speed:1. Pull the CRUISE ON-OFF button on

the steering wheel to turn the systemon. The CRUISE indicator light in theinstrument cluster will illuminate.

2. Accelerate to the desired speed, whichmust be more than 40 km/h (24 mph).

3. Push the COAST/SET switch, andrelease it at the desired speed.The SETindicator light in the instrument clusterwill illuminate. Release the acceleratorat the same time.The desired speed willautomatically be maintained.

The SET function cannot be activated untilapproximately 2 seconds after theCRUISE ON-OFF button has beenengaged.On a steep grade, the vehicle maymomentarily slow down while going down-hill.

CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM (IF EQUIPPED)

WARNING - Cruise control

Do not use the cruise control fea-ture under the following conditions:• Heavy or unsteady traffic• Slippery or winding roads• Situations that involve varying

speeds

WARNINGIf the cruise control is left on,(CRUISE indicator light in theinstrument cluster illuminated) thecruise control can be switched onaccidentally. Keep the cruise con-trol system off (CRUISE indicatorlight OFF) when cruise control isnot in use.

OVQ046003NOVQ046002N

Driving your vehicle

124

To cancel cruise control, do oneof the following:• Press the brake pedal.• Shift into N (Neutral) with an automatic

transaxle.• Press the CANCEL switch located on

the steering wheel.• Press the COAST/SET and RES/

ACCEL switches at the same time.Each of these actions will cancel cruisecontrol operation (the SET indicator lightin the instrument cluster will go OFF), butit will not turn the system off. If you wishto resume cruise control operation, pushthe RES/ACCEL switch located on yoursteering wheel. You will return to yourpreviously preset speed.

To turn cruise control off, do oneof the following:• Pull the CRUISE ON-OFF button (the

CRUISE indicator light in the instru-ment cluster will go OFF).

• Turn the ignition off.Both of these actions cancel cruise con-trol operation. If you want to resumecruise control operation, repeat the stepsprovided in “To Set Cruise ControlSpeed” on the previous page.

To increase cruise control setspeed:Follow either of these procedures:• Push the RES/ACCEL switch and hold

it. Your vehicle will accelerate. Releasethe switch at the speed you want.

• Push the RES/ACCEL switch andrelease it immediately. The cruisingspeed will increase by 2.0 km/h (1.2mph) each time the RES/ACCEL switchis operated in this manner.

OVQ046004N OVQ046005N

4 13

Driving your vehicle

To temporarily accelerate with thecruise control on:If you want to speed up temporarily whenthe cruise control is on, depress theaccelerator pedal. Increased speed willnot interfere with cruise control operationor change the set speed.To return to the set speed, take your footoff the accelerator.

To decrease the cruising speed:Follow either of these procedures:• Push the COAST/SET switch and hold

it. Your vehicle will gradually slowdown. Release the switch at the speedyou want to maintain.

• Push the COAST/SET switch andrelease it immediately. The cruisingspeed will decrease by 2.0 km/h (1.2mph) each time the COAST/SET switchis operated in this manner.

To resume cruising speed atmore than 40 km/h (24 mph):If any method other than the CRUISEON-OFF switch was used to cancelcruising speed and the system is stillactivated, the most recent set speed willautomatically resume when theRES/ACCEL switch is pushed.It will not resume, however, if the vehiclespeed has dropped below 40 km/h (24mph).

OVQ046003N OVQ046005N

Driving your vehicle

144

Power brakes Your vehicle has power-assisted brakesthat adjust automatically through normalusage.In the event that the power-assistedbrakes lose power because of a stalledengine or some other reason, you canstill stop your vehicle by applying greaterforce to the brake pedal than you nor-mally would. The stopping distance, how-ever, will be longer.When the engine is not running, thereserve brake power is partially depletedeach time the brake pedal is applied. Donot pump the brake pedal when thepower assist has been interrupted.Pump the brake pedal only when neces-sary to maintain steering control on slip-pery surfaces.

In the event of brake failure If service brakes fail to operate while thevehicle is in motion, you can make anemergency stop with the parking brake.The stopping distance, however, will bemuch greater than normal.

BRAKE SYSTEM

(Continued)• When descending a long or steep

hill, shift to a lower gear andavoid continuous application ofthe brakes. Continuous brakeapplication will cause the brakesto overheat and could result in atemporary loss of braking per-formance.

• Wet brakes may result in the vehi-cle not slowing down at the usualrate and pulling to one side whenthe brakes are applied. Applyingthe brakes lightly will indicatewhether they have been affectedin this way. Always test yourbrakes in this fashion after driv-ing through deep water.To dry thebrakes, apply them lightly whilemaintaining a safe forward speeduntil brake performance returnsto normal.

• Always, confirm the position ofthe brake and accelerator pedalbefore driving. If you don't checkthe position of the acceleratorand brake pedal before driving,you may depress the acceleratorinstead of the brake pedal. It maycause a serious accident.

WARNING - Parking brakeApplying the parking brake whilethe vehicle is moving at normalspeeds can cause a sudden loss ofcontrol of the vehicle. If you mustuse the parking brake to stop thevehicle, use great caution in apply-ing the brake.

WARNING - Brakes• Do not drive with your foot rest-

ing on the brake pedal. This willcreate abnormal high brake tem-peratures, excessive brake liningand pad wear, and increasedstopping distances.

(Continued)

4 15

Driving your vehicle

Disc brakes wear indicator Your vehicle has disc brakes.When your brake pads are worn and newpads are required, you will hear a high-pitched warning sound from your frontbrakes or rear brakes (if equipped). Youmay hear this sound come and go or itmay occur whenever you depress thebrake pedal.Please remember that some driving con-ditions or climates may cause a brakesqueal when you first apply (or lightlyapply) the brakes. This is normal anddoes not indicate a problem with yourbrakes.

Parking on curbed streets • When parking your vehicle on an uphill

grade, park as close to the curb aspossible and turn the front wheelsaway from the curb so that the frontwheels will contact the curb if the vehi-cle moves backward.

• When parking your vehicle on a down-hill grade, park as close to the curb aspossible and turn the front wheelstoward the curb so that the frontwheels will contact the curb if the vehi-cle moves forward.

Parking brake Applying the parking brakeTo engage the parking brake, first applythe foot brake and then depress the park-ing brake pedal down as far as possible.In addition it is recommended that whenparking the vehicle on a gradient, theshift lever should be in a low gear onmanual transaxle vehicles or in the P(Park) position on automatic transaxlevehicles.

WARNING - Brake wearThis brake wear warning soundmeans your vehicle needs service.If you ignore this audible warning,you will eventually lose braking per-formance, which could lead to aserious accident.

CAUTIONAlways replace brake pads as com-plete front or rear axle sets.

CAUTIONTo avoid costly brake repairs, donot continue to drive with wornbrake pads.

1VQA3030

Driving your vehicle

164

Releasing the parking brakeType ATo release the parking brake, pull theparking brake release lever while apply-ing the foot brake. The pedal will auto-matically extend to the fully releasedposition. If the parking brake pedal doesnot release or does not release all theway, have the system checked by anauthorized KIA dealer.

Type BTo release the parking brake, depressthe parking brake pedal a second timewhile applying the foot brake. The pedalwill automatically extend to the fullyreleased position. If the parking brakepedal does not release or does notrelease all the way, have the systemchecked by an authorized KIA dealer.

CAUTION• Driving with the parking brake

applied will cause excessivebrake pad and brake rotor wear.

• Do not operate the parking brakewhile the vehicle is movingexcept in an emergency situation.It could damage the vehicle sys-tem and make endanger drivingsafety.

WARNING - Parking brake• To prevent unintentional move-

ment when stopped and leavingthe vehicle, do not use thegearshift lever in place of theparking brake. Set the parkingbrake AND make sure thegearshift lever is securely posi-tioned in P (Park) for automatictransaxle equipped vehicles.

• Never allow a person who is unfa-miliar with the vehicle or childrento touch the parking brake. If theparking brake is released unin-tentionally, serious injury mayoccur.

1VQA3031

OVQ038031

Type A

Type B

4 17

Driving your vehicle

Check the brake warning light by turningthe ignition switch ON (do not start theengine). This light will be illuminatedwhen the parking brake is applied withthe ignition switch in the START or ONposition.Before driving, be sure the parking brakeis fully released and the brake warninglight is off.If the brake warning light remains onafter the parking brake is released, theremay be a malfunction in the brake sys-tem. Immediate attention is necessary.If at all possible, cease driving the vehi-cle immediately. If that is not possible,use extreme caution while operating thevehicle and only continue to drive thevehicle until you can reach a safe loca-tion or repair shop.

Anti-lock brake system (ABS) The ABS continuously senses the speedof the wheels. If the wheels are going tolock, the ABS system repeatedly modu-lates the hydraulic brake pressure to thewheels.When you apply your brakes under con-ditions which may lock the wheels, youmay hear a “tik-tik’’ sound from thebrakes, or feel a corresponding sensationin the brake pedal. This is normal and itmeans your ABS is active.In order to obtain the maximum benefitfrom your ABS in an emergency situa-tion, do not attempt to modulate yourbrake pressure and do not try to pumpyour brakes. Press your brake pedal ashard as possible or as hard as the situa-tion warrants and allow the ABS to con-trol the force being delivered to thebrakes.

W-75

WARNING - ABSYour ABS is not a substitute forgood driving judgement. You canstill have an accident. In fact, yourABS will probably not be able toprevent an accident in the followingdriving conditions:• Dangerous driving, such as

neglecting safety precautions,speeding, or driving too close tothe vehicle in front of you.

• Driving at high speed in situa-tions providing considerably lesstraction, such as wet conditionswhere hydroplaning could occur.

• Driving too fast on poor road sur-faces. The ABS is designed toimprove maximum braking effec-tiveness on typical highways androads in good condition. On poorroad surfaces in poor condition,the ABS may actually reducebraking effectiveness.

Driving your vehicle

184

• Even with the anti-lock brake system,your vehicle still requires sufficientstopping distance. Always maintain asafe distance from the vehicle in frontof you.

• Always slow down when cornering.The anti-lock brake system cannot pre-vent accidents resulting from exces-sive speeds.

• On loose or uneven road surfaces,operation of the anti-lock brake systemmay result in a longer stopping dis-tance than for vehicles equipped with aconventional brake system.

✽✽ NOTICEWhen you jump start your vehiclebecause of a drained battery, the enginemay not run as smoothly and the ABSwarning light may turn on at the sametime. This happens because of the lowbattery voltage. It does not mean yourABS is malfunctioning.• Do not pump your brakes!• Have the battery recharged before

driving the vehicle.

W-78

CAUTION• If the ABS warning light is on and

stays on, you may have a problemwith the ABS. In this case, howev-er, your regular brakes will worknormally.

• The ABS warning light will stay onfor approximately 3 seconds afterthe ignition switch is ON. Duringthat time, the ABS will go throughself-diagnosis and the light will gooff if everything is normal. If thelight stays on, you may have aproblem with your ABS. Contactan authorized Kia dealer as soonas possible.

CAUTION• When you drive on a road having

poor traction, such as an icy road,and operate your brakes continu-ously, the ABS will be active con-tinuously and the ABS warninglight may illuminate. Pull your carover to a safe place and stop theengine.

• Restart the engine. If the ABSwarning light is off, then yourABS system is normal.Otherwise, you may have a prob-lem with the ABS. Contact anauthorized Kia dealer as soon aspossible.

4 19

Driving your vehicle

The Electronic Stability Control (ESC)monitors information from various vehiclesensors and then compares the driver'scommands with the actual behavior of thevehicle. If an unstable condition occurs - asudden evasive movement for example -ESC intervenes within fractions of asecond via the engine computer andbrake system and attempts to stabilizethe vehicle.

ESC operationESC ON condition

• When the ignition is turnedON, ESC and ESC OFF indi-cator lights illuminate forapproximately 3 seconds,then ESC is turned on.

• Press the ESC OFF buttonfor at least half a second afterturning the ignition ON to turnESC off. (ESC OFF indicatorwill illuminate). To turn theESC on, press the ESC OFFbutton (ESC OFF indicatorlight will go off).

• When starting the engine,you may hear a slight tickingsound. This is the ESC per-forming an automatic systemself-check and does not indi-cate a problem.

When operatingWhen the ESC is in operation,ESC indicator light blinks.• When the Electronic Stability

Control is operating properly,you can feel a slight pulsationin the vehicle. This is only theeffect of brake control and indi-cates nothing unusual.

• When moving out of the mudor slippery road, pressing theaccelerator pedal may notcause the engine rpm (revo-lutions per minute) toincrease.

ELECTRONIC STABILITY CONTROL (IF EQUIPPED)

- ESC

❈ The location of the ESC OFF button maybe changed depending on your model.

OVQ041014N

Driving your vehicle

204

ESC operation offESC OFF state

• To cancel ESC operation,press the ESC OFF button(ESC OFF indicator light illu-minates).

• If the ignition switch is turnedto LOCK position when ESCis off, ESC remains off. Uponrestarting the engine, theESC will automatically turnon again. Indicator light

When ignition switch is turned to the ONposition, the indicator light illuminates,then goes off if the ESC system is oper-ating normally.The ESC indicator light blinks wheneverESC is operating or illuminates whenESC fails to operate.The ESC OFF indicator light comes onwhen the ESC is turned off with the but-ton.

ESC OFF usageWhen driving• It’s a good idea to keep the ESC turned

on for daily driving whenever possible.• To turn ESC off while driving, press the

ESC OFF button while driving on a flatroad surface.

Never press ESC OFF button while ESCis operating (ESC indicator light blinks).If ESC is turned off while ESC is operat-ing, the vehicle may slip out of control.

ESC

ESCOFF

■ ESC indicator light

■ ESC OFF indicator light

WARNINGThe Electronic Stability Controlsystem is only a driving aid; useprecautions for safe driving byslowing down on curved, snowy, oricy roads. Drive slowly and don’tattempt to accelerate whenever theESC indicator light is blinking, orwhen the road surface is slippery.

ESCOFF

4 21

Driving your vehicle

✽✽ NOTICE• When operating the vehicle on a

dynamometer, ensure that the ESC isturned off (ESC OFF light illuminat-ed). If the ESC is left on, it may pre-vent the vehicle speed from increas-ing, and result in false diagnosis.

• Turning the ESC off does not affectABS or brake system operation.

The rear parking assist system assiststhe driver during backward movement ofthe vehicle by chiming if any object issensed within a distance of 120 cm (47in.) behind the vehicle. This system is asupplemental system and it is not intend-ed to nor does it replace the need forextreme care and attention of the driver.The sensing range and objectsdetectable by the back sensors are limit-ed. Whenever backing-up, pay as muchattention to what is behind you as youwould in a vehicle without a rear parkingassist system.

WARNINGNever press the ESC OFF buttonwhile ESC is operating.If the ESC is turned off while ESC isoperating, the vehicle may go out ofcontrol.To turn ESC off while driving, pressthe ESC OFF button while drivingon a flat road surface.

REAR PARKING ASSIST SYSTEM (IF EQUIPPED)

WARNINGThe rear parking assist system is asupplementary function only. Theoperation of the rear parking assistsystem can be affected by severalfactors (including environmentalconditions). It is the responsibilityof the driver to always check thearea behind the vehicle beforebacking up.

OVQ049098

Driving your vehicle

224

Operation of the rear parkingassist systemOperating condition• This system will activate when backing

up with the ignition key ON.If the vehicle is moved at speed over 5 km/h (3 mph), the system may notactivated correctly.

• The sensing distance while the rearparking assist system is in operation isapproximately 120 cm (47 in.).

• When more than two objects aresensed at the same time, the closestone will be recognized first.

Types of warning sound• When an object is 120 cm to 81 cm (47

in. to 32 in.) from the rear bumper :Buzzer beeps intermittently

• When an object is 80 cm to 41 cm (31in. to 16 in.) from the rear bumper :Buzzer beeps more frequently

• When an object is within 40 cm (15 in.)of the rear bumper : Buzzer soundscontinuously.

Non-operational conditions ofrear parking assist systemRear parking assist system may notoperate normally when:1. Moisture is frozen to the sensor. (It will

operate normally when moisturemelts.)

2. Sensor is covered with foreign matter,such as snow or water, or the sensorcover is blocked. (It will operate nor-mally when the material is removed orthe sensor is no longer blocked.)

3. Driving on uneven road surfaces(unpaved roads, gravel, bumps, gradi-ent).

4. Objects generating excessive noise(vehicle horns, loud motorcycleengines, or truck air brakes) are withinrange of the sensor.

5. Heavy rain or water spray exists.6. Wireless transmitters or mobile phones

are within range of the sensor.7. Sensor is covered with snow.8. Trailer towing

Detecting range may decrease when:1. Sensor is stained with foreign matter

such as snow or water. (Sensing rangewill return to normal when removed.)

2. Outside air temperature is extremelyhot or cold.

Following objects may not be recog-nized by the sensor:1. Sharp or slim objects such as ropes,

chains or small poles.2. Objects which tend to absorb sensor

frequency such as clothes, spongymaterial or snow.

3. Undetectable objects smaller than 1 m(40 in.) and narrower than 14 cm (6 in.)in diameter.

4 23

Driving your vehicle

✽✽ NOTICEIf you don’t hear an audible warningsound or if the buzzer sounds intermit-tently when shifting the gear to “R” posi-tion, this may indicate a malfunction inthe rear parking assist system. If thisoccurs, have your vehicle checked by anauthorized Kia dealer as soon as possi-ble.

CAUTION1. The rear parking assist system

may not sound sequentiallydepending on the speed andshapes of the objects detected.

2. The rear parking assist systemmay malfunction if the vehiclebumper height or sensor installa-tion has been modified or dam-aged. Any non-factory installedequipment or accessories mayalso interfere with the sensor per-formance.

3. Sensor may not recognizeobjects less than 40 cm (15 in.)from the sensor, or it may sensean incorrect distance. Use cau-tion.

4. When sensor is frozen or stainedwith snow, dirt, or water, sensormay be inoperative until thestains are removed using a softcloth.

5. Do not push, scratch or strike thesensor. Sensor damage couldoccur.

WARNINGPay close attention when the vehi-cle is driven close to objects on theroad, particularly pedestrians,especially children. Be aware thatsome objects may not be detectedby the sensors, due to the object’sdistance, size or material, all ofwhich can limit the effectiveness ofthe sensor. Always perform a visu-al inspection to make sure the vehi-cle is clear of all obstructionsbefore moving the vehicle in anydirection.

CAUTIONThis system can only sense objectswithin the range and location of thesensors; It can not detect objects inother areas where sensors are notinstalled. Also, small or slimobjects, such as poles or objectslocated between sensors may notbe detected by the sensors.Always visually check behind thevehicle when driving back up.Be sure to inform any drivers in thevehicle that may be unfamiliar withthe system regarding the systemscapabilities and limitations.Your new vehicle warranty does notcover any accidents or damage tothe vehicle or its occupants due torear parking assist system malfunc-tion. Always drive safely and cau-tiously.

Driving your vehicle

244

The rearview camera will activate whenthe back-up light is ON with the ignitionswitch ON and the shift lever in the R(Reverse) position.This system is a supplemental systemthat shows behind the vehicle throughthe rearview display mirror while back-ing-up.

The rearview camera may be turned offby pressing the ON/OFF button when therearview camera is activated.To turn the camera on again, press theON/OFF button again when the ignitionswitch is on and the shift lever in R(Reverse). Also, the camera will turn onautomatically whenever the ignitionswitch is turned off and on again.

REARVIEW CAMERA (IF EQUIPPED)

1VQA2117

OVQ020600

Rear view display

WARNING• This system is a supplementary

function only. It is the responsibil-ity of the driver to always checkthe inside/outside rearview mirrorand the area behind the vehiclebefore and while backing upbecause there is a dead zone thatcan't see through the camera.

• Always keep the camera lensclean. If lens is covered with for-eign matter, the camera may notoperate normally.

4 25

Driving your vehicle

Your vehicle's fuel economy dependsmainly on your style of driving, where youdrive and when you drive.Each of these factors affects how manykilometers (miles) you can get from aliter (gallon) of fuel. To operate your vehi-cle as economically as possible, use thefollowing driving suggestions to helpsave money in both fuel and repairs:• Avoid lengthy warm-up idling. Once the

engine is running smoothly, begin driv-ing. Remember, engine warm-up maytake a little longer on cold days.

• Save fuel by accelerating slowly afterstopping.

• Keep the engine in tune and follow therecommended periodic maintenanceschedule. This will increase the life ofall parts and lower your operatingcosts.

• Do not use the air conditioner unnec-essarily.

• Slow down when driving on roughroads.

• For longer tire life and better fuel econ-omy, always keep the tires inflated tothe recommended pressures.

• Maintain a safe distance from othervehicles to avoid sudden stops. Thiswill reduce wear on brake linings andpads. Driving in such a way will alsosave fuel because extra fuel is requiredto accelerate back to driving speed.

• Do not carry unnecessary weight in thevehicle.

• Do not rest your foot on the brakepedal while driving. This can causeneedless wear, possible damage to thebrakes, and poor fuel economy.

• Improper wheel alignment results infaster tire wear and lower fuel econo-my.

• Open windows at high speeds canreduce fuel economy.

• Fuel economy is less in crosswindsand headwinds. To help offset some ofthis loss, slow down when driving inthese conditions.

Keeping a vehicle in good operating con-dition is important both for economy andsafety. Therefore, have an authorized Kiadealer perform scheduled inspectionsand maintenance.

ECONOMICAL OPERATION

WARNING - Engine off dur-ing motion

Never turn the engine off to coastdown hills or anytime the vehicle isin motion. The power steering andpower brakes will not functionproperly without the engine run-ning. Instead, keep the engine onand downshift to an appropriategear for engine braking effect. Inaddition, turning off the ignitionwhile driving could engage thesteering wheel lock resulting inloss of vehicle steering which couldcause serious injury or death.

Driving your vehicle

264

Hazardous driving conditions When hazardous driving conditions areencountered such as water, snow, ice,mud, sand, or similar hazards, followthese suggestions:• Drive cautiously and allow extra dis-

tance for braking.• Avoid sudden movements in braking or

steering.• When braking with non-ABS brakes

pump the brake pedal with a light up-and-down motion until the vehicle isstopped.

• If stalled in snow, mud, or sand, usesecond gear. Accelerate slowly toavoid spinning the drive wheels.

• Use sand, rock salt or other non-slipmaterial under the drive wheels to pro-vide traction when stalled in ice, snow,or mud.

Rocking the vehicle If it is necessary to rock the vehicle tofree it from snow, sand, or mud, first turnthe steering wheel right and left to clearthe area around your front wheels. Then,shift back and forth between R (Reverse)and any forward gear in vehiclesequipped with an automatic transaxle. Donot race the engine, and spin the wheelsas little as possible. If you are still stuckafter a few tries, have the vehicle pulledout by a tow vehicle to avoid engine over-heating and possible damage to thetransaxle.

SPECIAL DRIVING CONDITIONS

WARNING - DownshiftingDownshifting with an automatictransaxle, while driving on slipperysurfaces can cause an accident.The sudden change in tire speedcould cause the tires to skid. Becareful when downshifting on slip-pery surfaces.

WARNING - ABSDo not pump the brake pedal on avehicle equipped with ABS.

CAUTIONProlonged rocking may causeengine over-heating, transaxle dam-age or failure, and tire damage.

CAUTIONThe ESC system (if equipped)should be turned OFF prior to rock-ing the vehicle.

WARNING - Spinning tiresDo not spin the wheels, especiallyat speeds more than 56 km/h (35mph). Spinning the wheels at highspeeds when the vehicle is station-ary could cause a tire to overheat,explode and injure bystanders.

WARNINGIf your vehicle becomes stuck insnow, mud, sand, etc., then you mayattempt to rock the vehicle free bymoving it forward and backward. Donot attempt this procedure if peopleor objects are anywhere near thevehicle. During the rocking opera-tion the vehicle may suddenly moveforward or backward as it becomesunstuck, causing injury or damageto nearby people or objects.

4 27

Driving your vehicle

Driving at night Because night driving presents morehazards than driving in the daylight, hereare some important tips to remember:• Slow down and keep more distance

between you and other vehicles, as itmay be more difficult to see at night,especially in areas where there maynot be any street lights.

• Adjust your mirrors to reduce the glarefrom other driver's headlights.

• Keep your headlights clean and prop-erly aimed on vehicles not equippedwith the automatic headlight aimingfeature. Dirty or improperly aimedheadlights will make it much more diffi-cult to see at night.

• Avoid staring directly at the headlightsof oncoming vehicles. You could betemporarily blinded, and it will takeseveral seconds for your eyes to read-just to the darkness.

Driving in the rain Rain and wet roads can make drivingdangerous, especially if you’re not pre-pared for the slick pavement. Here are afew things to consider when driving in therain:• A heavy rainfall will make it harder to

see and will increase the distanceneeded to stop your vehicle, so slowdown.

• Keep your windshield wiping equip-ment in good shape. Replace yourwindshield wiper blades when theyshow signs of streaking or missingareas on the windshield.

• If your tires are not in good condition,making a quick stop on wet pavementcan cause a skid and possibly lead toan accident. Be sure your tires are ingood shape.

• Turn on your headlights to make it eas-ier for others to see you.

• Driving too fast through large puddlescan affect your brakes. If you must gothrough puddles, try to drive throughthem slowly.

• If you believe you may have gottenyour brakes wet, apply them lightlywhile driving until normal braking oper-ation returns.

Driving in flooded areas Avoid driving through flooded areasunless you are sure the water is no high-er than the bottom of the wheel hub.Drive through any water slowly. Allowadequate stopping distance becausebrake performance may be affected.After driving through water, dry thebrakes by gently applying them severaltimes while the vehicle is moving slowly.

Driving your vehicle

284

• We recommend that you carry emer-gency equipment, including a windowscraper, windshield de-icer, a bag ofsand or salt, flares, a small shovel andjumper cables.

• Make sure you have sufficient ethyl-ene-glycol coolant in the radiator.

• Check the battery condition andcables. Cold temperatures reduce thecapacity of any battery, so it must be inexcellent condition to provide enoughwinter starting power.

• Make sure the engine oil viscosity issuitable for cold weather.

• Check the ignition system for looseconnections and damage.

• Use antifreeze-formulated windshieldwasher fluid. (Do not use enginecoolant antifreeze.)

• Do not use the parking brake if it mightfreeze. When parking, shift to P (Park)with an automatic transaxle and blockthe rear wheels.

Snow tires If you mount snow tires on your Kia,make sure they are radial tires of thesame size and load range as the originaltires. Mount snow tires on all four wheelsto balance your vehicle’s handling in allweather conditions. Keep in mind that thetraction provided by snow tires on dryroads may not be as high as your vehi-cle's original equipment tires. You shoulddrive cautiously even when the roads areclear. Check with the tire dealer for max-imum speed recommendations.

Do not install studded tires without firstchecking local, state and municipal regu-lations for possible restrictions againsttheir use.

WINTER DRIVING

WARNING - Snow tire sizeSnow tires should be equivalent insize and type to the vehicle's stan-dard tires. Otherwise, the safety andhandling of your vehicle may beadversely affected.

TRAILER TOWING

WARNING - Towing a trail-er

If you don't use the correct equip-ment and drive improperly, you canlose control when you pull a trailer.For example, if the trailer is tooheavy, the brakes may not work well- or even at all. You and your pas-sengers could be seriously or fatal-ly injured. Pull a trailer only if youhave followed all the steps in thissection.

WARNING - Weight limitsBefore towing, make sure the totaltrailer weight, gross combinationweight, gross vehicle weight, grossaxle weight and trailer tongue loadare all within the limits.

4 29

Driving your vehicle

Your vehicle can tow a trailer. To identifywhat the vehicle trailering capacity is foryour vehicle, you should read the infor-mation in “Weight of the Trailer” thatappears later in this section.

Remember that trailering is different thanjust driving your vehicle by itself.Trailering means changes in handling,durability, and fuel economy. Successful,safe trailering requires correct equip-ment, and it has to be used properly.

This section contains many time-tested,important trailering tips and safety rules.Many of these are important for yoursafety and that of your passengers.Please read this section carefully beforeyou pull a trailer.

Load-pulling components such as theengine, transaxle, wheel assemblies, andtires are forced to work harder againstthe load of the added weight. The engineis required to operate at relatively higherspeeds and under greater loads. Thisadditional burden generates extra heat.The trailer also adds considerably towind resistance, increasing the pullingrequirements.

Hitches It's important to have the correct hitchequipment. Crosswinds, large trucksgoing by, and rough roads are a few rea-sons why you’ll need the right hitch. Hereare some rules to follow:• Will you have to make any holes in the

body of your vehicle when you install atrailer hitch? If you do, then be sure toseal the holes later when you removethe hitch.If you don’t seal them, deadly carbonmonoxide (CO) from your exhaust canget into your vehicle, as well as dirt andwater.

• The bumpers on your vehicle are notintended for hitches. Do not attachrental hitches or other bumper-typehitches to them. Use only a frame-mounted hitch that does not attach tothe bumper.

Item kg (lbs.)

Maximum trailer Without trailer brakes 453 (1000)

weight With trailer brakes 1587 (3500)

Maximum permissible static vertical

load on the coupling device 158 (350)

CAUTIONPulling a trailer improperly candamage your vehicle and result incostly repairs not covered by yourwarranty. To pull a trailer correctly,follow the advice in this section.

Driving your vehicle

304

Safety chains You should always attach chainsbetween your vehicle and your trailer.Cross the safety chains under the tongueof the trailer so that the tongue will notdrop to the road if it becomes separatedfrom the hitch.Instructions about safety chains may beprovided by the hitch manufacturer or bythe trailer manufacturer. Follow the man-ufacturer’s recommendation for attachingsafety chains. Always leave just enoughslack so you can turn with your trailer.And, never allow safety chains to drag onthe ground.

Trailer brakes If your trailer weighs more than the max-imum trailer weight without trailer brakesloaded, then it needs its own brakes andthey must be adequate. Be sure to readand follow the instructions for the trailerbrakes so you’ll be able to install, adjustand maintain them properly.• Don’t tap into your vehicle's brake sys-

tem.

Driving with a trailer Towing a trailer requires a certainamount of experience. Before setting outfor the open road, you must get to knowyour trailer. Acquaint yourself with thefeel of handling and braking with theadded weight of the trailer. And alwayskeep in mind that the vehicle you aredriving is now a good deal longer and notnearly so responsive as your vehicle isby itself.Before you start, check the trailer hitchand platform, safety chains, electricalconnector(s), lights, tires and mirroradjustment. If the trailer has electricbrakes, start your vehicle and trailer mov-ing and then apply the trailer brake con-troller by hand to be sure the brakes areworking. This lets you check your electri-cal connection at the same time.During your trip, check occasionally to besure that the load is secure, and that thelights and any trailer brakes are still work-ing.

WARNING - Trailer brakesDo not use a trailer with its ownbrakes unless you are absolutelycertain that you have properly setup the brake system. This is not atask for amateurs. Use an experi-enced, competent trailer shop forthis work.

4 31

Driving your vehicle

Following distance Stay at least twice as far behind the vehi-cle ahead as you would when drivingyour vehicle without a trailer. This canhelp you avoid situations that requireheavy braking and sudden turns.

Passing You’ll need more passing distance upahead when you’re towing a trailer. And,because of the increased vehicle length,you’ll need to go much farther beyond thepassed vehicle before you can return toyour lane.

Backing up Hold the bottom of the steering wheelwith one hand. Then, to move the trailerto the left, just move your hand to the left.To move the trailer to the right, move yourhand to the right. Always back up slowlyand, if possible, have someone guideyou.

Making turns When you’re turning with a trailer, makewider turns than normal. Do this so yourtrailer won’t strike soft shoulders, curbs,road signs, trees, or other objects. Avoidjerky or sudden maneuvers. Signal wellin advance.

Turn signals when towing a trailer When you tow a trailer, your vehicle hasto have a different turn signal flasher andextra wiring. The green arrows on yourinstrument panel will flash whenever yousignal a turn or lane change. Properlyconnected, the trailer lights will also flashto alert other drivers you’re about to turn,change lanes, or stop.When towing a trailer, the green arrowson your instrument panel will flash forturns even if the bulbs on the trailer areburned out. Thus, you may think driversbehind you are seeing your signalswhen, in fact, they are not. It’s importantto check occasionally to be sure the trail-er bulbs are still working. You must alsocheck the lights every time you discon-nect and then reconnect the wires.Do not connect a trailer lighting systemdirectly to your vehicle’s lighting system.Use only an approved trailer wiring har-ness.Your Authorized Kia Dealer can assistyou in installing the wiring harness.

Driving on grades Reduce speed and shift to a lower gearbefore you start down a long or steepdowngrade. If you don’t shift down, youmight have to use your brakes so muchthat they would get hot and no longeroperate efficiently.On a long uphill grade, shift down andreduce your speed to around 70 km/h (45mph) to reduce the possibility of engineand transaxle overheating.If your trailer weighs more than the max-imum trailer weight without trailer brakesand you have an automatic transaxle,you should drive in D (Drive) when tow-ing a trailer.Operating your vehicle in D (Drive) whentowing a trailer will minimize heat build upand extend the life of your transaxle.

WARNING Failure to use an approved trailerwiring harness could result in dam-age to the vehicle electrical systemand/or personal injury.

Driving your vehicle

324

Parking on hills Generally, you should not park your vehi-cle, with a trailer attached, on a hill.People can be seriously or fatally injured,and both your vehicle and the trailer canbe damaged if they begin a downhill tra-jectory.

However, if you ever have to park yourtrailer on a hill, here’s how to do it:1. Apply your brakes, but don’t shift into

gear.2. Have someone place chocks under

the trailer wheels.3. When the wheel chocks are in place,

release the brakes until the chocksabsorb the load.

4. Reapply the brakes. Apply your park-ing brake, and then shift to P (Park) foran automatic transaxle.

5. Release the brakes.

When you are ready to leave afterparking on a hill 1. With the automatic transaxle in P

(Park), apply your brakes and hold thebrake pedal down while you:• Start your engine;• Shift into gear; and• Release the parking brake.

2. Slowly remove your foot from thebrake pedal.

3. Drive slowly until the trailer is clear ofthe chocks.

4. Stop and have someone pick up andstore the chocks.

CAUTION• When towing a trailer on steep

grades (in excess of 6%) payclose attention to the enginecoolant temperature gauge toensure the engine does not over-heat. If the needle of the coolanttemperature gauge moves acrossthe dial towards “H” (HOT), pullover and stop as soon as it is safeto do so, and allow the engine toidle until it cools down. You mayproceed once the engine hascooled sufficiently.

• You must decide driving speeddepending on trailer weight anduphill grade to reduce the possi-bility of engine and transaxleoverheating.

WARNING - Parking on ahill

Parking your vehicle on a hill with atrailer attached could cause seriousinjury or death, should the trailerbreak lose.

WARNING - Parking brakeIt can be dangerous to get out ofyour vehicle if the parking brake isnot firmly set.If you have left the engine running,the vehicle can move suddenly. Youor others could be seriously orfatally injured.

4 33

Driving your vehicle

Maintenance when trailer towing Your vehicle will need service more oftenwhen you regularly pull a trailer.Important items to pay particular atten-tion to include engine oil, automatictransaxle fluid, axle lubricant and coolingsystem fluid. Brake condition is anotherimportant item to frequently check. Eachitem is covered in this manual, and theIndex will help you find them quickly. Ifyou’re trailering, it’s a good idea to reviewthese sections before you start your trip.Don’t forget to also maintain your trailerand hitch. Follow the maintenanceschedule that accompanied your trailerand check it periodically. Preferably, con-duct the check at the start of each day’sdriving. Most importantly, all hitch nutsand bolts should be tight.

If you do decide to pull a trailerHere are some important points if youdecide to pull a trailer:• State, provincial, county and municipal

government have varying traileringlaws. Make sure your hitch, mirrors,lights and wiring arrangements arelegal, not only where you live, but alsowhere you’ll be driving. A good sourcefor this information is provincial or locallaw enforcement agencies.

• Consider using a sway control.You canask a hitch dealer about sway control.

• After your odometer indicates 800 km(500 miles) or more, you can tow atrailer. For the first 800 km (500 miles)that you tow a trailer, don’t drive over80 km/h (50 mph) and don’t makestarts at full throttle. This helps yourengine and other parts of your vehicle“wear” in at the heavier loads.

• Always drive your vehicle at a moder-ate speed (less than 100 km/h (60mph)).

• On a long uphill grade, do not exceed70 km/h (45 mph) or the posted towingspeed limit, whichever is lower.

• The important considerations have todo with weight:

CAUTION• Due to higher load during trailer

usage, overheating might occurin hot days or during uphill driv-ing. If the coolant gauge indicatesover-heating, switch off the A/Cand stop the vehicle in a safe areato cool down the engine.

• When towing check transaxlefluid more frequently.

• If your vehicle is not equippedwith the air conditioner, youshould install a condenser fan toimprove engine performancewhen towing a trailer.

Driving your vehicle

344

Weight of the trailerHow heavy can a trailer safely be? Itshould never weigh more than the maxi-mum trailer weight with trailer brakes. Buteven that can be too heavy.It depends on how you plan to use yourtrailer. For example, speed, altitude, roadgrades, outside temperature and howmuch your vehicle is used to pull a trailerare all important. The ideal trailer weightcan also depend on any special equip-ment that you have on your vehicle.

Weight of the trailer tongueThe tongue load of any trailer is animportant weight to measure because itaffects the total gross vehicle weight(GVW) of your vehicle. This weightincludes the curb weight of the vehicle,any cargo you may carry in it, and thepeople who will be riding in the vehicle.And if you will tow a trailer, you must addthe tongue load to the GVW becauseyour vehicle will also be carrying thatweight.

The trailer tongue should weigh a maxi-mum of 10% of the total loaded trailerweight. After you've loaded your trailer,weigh the trailer and then the tongue,separately, to see if the weights are prop-er. If they aren’t, you may be able to cor-rect them simply by moving some itemsaround in the trailer.

WARNING - Trailer• Never load a trailer with more

weight in the rear than in thefront. The front should be loadedwith approximately 60% of thetotal trailer load; the rear shouldbe loaded with approximately40% of the total trailer load.

• Never exceed the maximumweight limits of the trailer or trail-er towing equipment. Improperloading can result in damage toyour vehicle and/or personalinjury. Check weights and loadingat a commercial scale or highwaypatrol office equipped withscales.

• An improperly loaded trailer cancause loss of vehicle control.

WARNING - Vehicle weightThe gross axle weight rating(GAWR) and the gross vehicleweight rating (GVWR) for your vehi-cle are on the manufacturer's labelattached to the driver's door.Exceeding these ratings can causean accident or vehicle damage. Youcan calculate the weight of yourload by weighing the items (andpeople) before putting them in thevehicle. Be careful not to overloadyour vehicle.

OVERLOADING

4 35

Driving your vehicle

Vehicle identification number(VIN) The vehicle identification number (VIN) isthe number used in registering your carand in all legal matters pertaining to itsownership, etc.The number is punched on the enginecompartment bulkhead.

The VIN is also on a plate attached to thetop of the dashboard. The number on theplate can easily be seen through thewindshield from outside.

Vehicle certification labelThe vehicle certification label attachedon the driver's side center pillar gives thevehicle identification number (VIN).

LABEL INFORMATION There are several important labels and identification numbers located on your vehicle. The label locations are identified in the illus-trations shown.

OVQ076001N OVQ076002N

Frame number VIN (if equipped)

OVQ066023N

Identification label (if equipped)

Driving your vehicle

364

Tire specification / pressure labelThe tires supplied on your new vehicleare chosen to provide the best perform-ance for normal driving.The tire label located on the driver's sidecenter pillar gives the tire pressures rec-ommended for your vehicle.

Engine numberThe engine number is stamped on theengine block as shown in the drawing.

OVQ081005OVQ066022N

5

Road warning / 5-2

In case of an emergency while driving / 5-2

Emergency starting / 5-3

If the engine overheats / 5-5

If you have a flat tire / 5-6

Towing / 5-15

What to do in an emergency

What to do in an emergency

25

ROAD WARNING

Hazard warning flasher The hazard warning flasher serves as awarning to other drivers to exerciseextreme caution when approaching,overtaking, or passing your vehicle.

It should be used whenever emergencyrepairs are being made or when the vehi-cle is stopped near the edge of a road-way.Depress the flasher switch with the igni-tion switch in any position. The flasherswitch is located in the center consoleswitch panel. All turn signal lights willflash simultaneously.

• The hazard warning flasher operateswhether your vehicle is running or not.

• The turn signals do not work when thehazard flasher is on.

• Care must be taken when using thehazard warning flasher while the vehi-cle is being towed.

If the engine stalls at a crossroador crossingIf the engine stalls at a crossroad orcrossing, set the shift lever in the N(Neutral) position and then push the vehi-cle to a safe place.

If you have a flat tire while drivingIf a tire goes flat while you are driving:1. Take your foot off the accelerator pedal

and let the car slow down while drivingstraight ahead. Do not apply thebrakes immediately or attempt to pulloff the road as this may cause a loss ofcontrol. When the car has slowed tosuch a speed that it is safe to do so,brake carefully and pull off the road.Drive off the road as far as possibleand park on firm, level ground.If you are on a divided highway, do notpark in the median area between thetwo traffic lanes.

2. When the car is stopped, turn on youremergency hazard flashers, set theparking brake and put the transaxle inP (automatic transaxle) or reverse(manual transaxle).

OVQ049031

OVQ049032

Type A

Type B

IN CASE OF AN EMERGENCYWHILE DRIVING

5 3

What to do in an emergency

3. Have all passengers get out of the car.Be sure they all get out on the side ofthe car that is away from traffic.

4. When changing a flat tire, follow theinstruction provided later in this sec-tion.

If engine stalls while driving1. Reduce your speed gradually, keeping

a straight line. Move cautiously off theroad to a safe place.

2. Turn on your emergency flashers.3. Try to start the engine again. If your

vehicle will not start, contact an autho-rised Kia dealer or seek other qualifiedassistance.

Jump starting Jump starting can be dangerous if doneincorrectly. Therefore, to avoid harm toyourself or damage to your vehicle orbattery, follow the jump starting proce-dures. If in doubt, we strongly recom-mend that you have a competent techni-cian or towing service jump start yourvehicle. WARNING - Battery

• Keep all flames or sparks awayfrom the battery. The battery pro-duces hydrogen gas which mayexplode if exposed to flame orsparks.

• Do not attempt to jump start thevehicle if the discharged batteryis frozen or if the electrolyte levelis low; the battery may rupture orexplode.

EMERGENCY STARTING

WARNING - BatteryNever attempt to check the elec-trolyte level of the battery as thismay cause the battery to rupture orexplode causing serious injury.

CAUTIONUse only a 12-volt jumper system.You can damage a 12-volt startingmotor, ignition system, and otherelectrical parts beyond repair byuse of a 24-volt power supply (eithertwo 12-volt batteries in series or a24-volt motor generator set).

What to do in an emergency

45

Connecting jumper cables Jump starting procedure 1. Make sure the booster battery is 12-

volt and that its negative terminal isgrounded.

2. If the booster battery is in another vehi-cle, do not allow the vehicles to touch.

3. Turn off all unnecessary electricalloads.

4. Connect the jumper cables in the exactsequence shown in the previous illus-tration. First connect one end of ajumper cable to the positive terminal ofthe discharged battery (1), then con-nect the other end to the positive termi-nal on the booster battery (2). Proceedto connect one end of the other jumpercable to the negative terminal of thebooster battery (3), then the other endto a solid, stationary, metallic point (forexample, the engine lifting bracket)away from the battery (4). Do not con-nect it to or near any part that moveswhen the engine is cranked.

CAUTION - Battery cablesDo not connect the jumper cablefrom the negative terminal of thebooster battery to the negative ter-minal of the discharged battery.This can cause the discharged bat-tery to overheat and crack, releas-ing battery acid.

1VQA4001

Connect cables in numerical order anddisconnect in reverse order.

Discharged battery

Jumper Cables

Booster battery

(-)

(+)

(+)(-)

5 5

What to do in an emergency

Do not allow the jumper cables to con-tact anything except the correct bat-tery terminals or the correct ground.Do not lean over the battery whenmaking connections.

5. Start the engine of the vehicle with thebooster battery and let it run at 2,000rpm, then start the engine of the vehi-cle with the discharged battery.

If the cause of your battery discharging isnot apparent, you should have your vehi-cle checked by an Authorized Kia Dealer.

Push-starting Vehicles equipped with automatictransaxle cannot be push-started.Follow the directions in this section forjump-starting.

If your temperature gauge indicates over-heating, if you experience a loss ofpower, or if you hear a loud knocking orpinging noise, the engine has probablyoverheated. Should any of these symp-toms occur, use the following procedure:1. Turn on the hazard warning flasher,

then drive to the nearest safe locationand stop your vehicle; set the auto-matic transaxle in P (Park) and applythe parking brake.

2. Make sure the air conditioner is off.3. If coolant or steam is boiling out of the

radiator, stop the engine and call anAuthorized Kia Dealer for assistance.If coolant is not boiling out, allow theengine to idle and open the hood topermit the engine to cool gradually.If the temperature does not go downwith the engine idling, stop the engineand allow sufficient time for it to cool.

4. The coolant level should then bechecked. If the level in the reservoir islow, look for leaks at the radiatorhoses and connections, heater hosesand connections, radiator, and waterpump. If you find a major leak oranother problem that may havecaused the engine to overheat, do notoperate the engine until it has beencorrected. Call an Authorized KiaDealer for assistance. If you do notfind a leak or other problem, carefullyadd coolant to the reservoir.

If the engine frequently overheats, havethe cooling system checked and repairedby an Authorized Kia Dealer.

CAUTIONNever tow a vehicle to start itbecause the sudden surge forwardwhen the engine starts could causea collision with the tow vehicle.

WARNING - Removingradiator cap

Do not remove the radiator capwhen the engine and radiator arehot. Scalding hot coolant and steammay blow out under pressure. Thiscould cause serious injury.

IF THE ENGINE OVERHEATS

What to do in an emergency

65

IF YOU HAVE A FLAT TIRE

The jack, jack handle, wheel lug nutwrench are stored in the luggagecompartment. Remove the panelindicated in the illustration.

Removing the spare tire Your spare tire is stored underneathyour vehicle, directly below the rightsliding door (on the cargo).1. Open the right sliding door (or the

tailgate) and find the plastic hexbolt cover on the floor.

2. Remove the cover.

3. Use the wheel lug nut wrench toloosen the bolt enough to lowerthe spare tire.Turn the wrench counterclockwiseuntil the spare tire reaches theground.

1VQA4035

OVQ056002N

OVQ056003N OVQ056004N

5 7

What to do in an emergency

4. After the spare tire reaches theground, continue to turn thewrench counterclockwise, anddraw the spare tire outside. Neverrotate the wrench excessively, oth-erwise the spare tire carrier maybe damaged.

5. Remove the retainer from the cen-ter of the spare tire.

Storing the spare tire 1. Lay the tire on the ground with the

valve stem facing down.

2. Place the wheel under the vehicleand install the retainer through thewheel center.

3. Turn the wrench clockwise until itclicks.

OVQ056005N OVQ056006N OVQ057016N

What to do in an emergency

85

Important - use of compact sparetireYour vehicle is equipped with a com-pact spare tire. This compact sparetire takes up less space than a regu-lar-size tire. This tire is smaller than aconventional tire and is designed fortemporary use only.

The compact spare should be inflat-ed to 420 kPa (60 psi).

✽✽ NOTICECheck the inflation pressure afterinstalling the spare tire. Adjust it tothe specified pressure, as necessary.

When using a compact spare tire,observe the following precautions:• Under no circumstances should

you exceed 80 km/h (50 mph); ahigher speed could damage thetire.

• Ensure that you drive slowlyenough for the road conditions toavoid all hazards. Any road hazard,such as a pothole or debris, couldseriously damage the compactspare.

• Any continuous road use of this tirecould result in tire failure, loss ofvehicle control, and possible per-sonal injury.

• Do not exceed the vehicle’s maxi-mum load rating or the load-carry-ing capacity shown on the sidewallof the compact spare tire.

• Avoid driving over obstacles. Thecompact spare tire diameter issmaller than the diameter of a con-ventional tire and reduces theground clearance approximately25 mm (1 inch), which could resultin damage to the vehicle.

CAUTION• You should drive carefully

when the compact spare is inuse. The compact spareshould be replaced by theproper conventional tire andrim at the first opportunity.

• The operation of this vehicleis not recommended withmore than one compact sparetire in use at the same time.

WARNINGThis spare tire should be usedonly for VERY short distances.Compact spares should NEVERbe used for long drives orextended distances.

WARNINGEnsure the spare tire retainer isproperly aligned with the centerof the spare tire to prevent thespare tire “rattling”. Otherwise, itmay cause the spare tire to falloff the carrier and lead to anaccident.

5 9

What to do in an emergency

• Do not take this vehicle through anautomatic car wash while the com-pact spare tire is installed.

• Do not use tire chains on the com-pact spare tire. Because of thesmaller size, a tire chain will not fitproperly. This could damage thevehicle and result in loss of thechain.

• The compact spare tire should notbe installed on the front axle if thevehicle must be driven in snow oron ice.

• Do not use the compact spare tireon any other vehicle because thistire has been designed especiallyfor your vehicle.

• The compact spare tire’s tread lifeis shorter than a regular tire.Inspect your compact spare tireregularly and replace worn com-pact spare tires with the same sizeand design, mounted on the samewheel.

Changing tires Jacking instructions The jack is provided for emergencytire changing only.To prevent the jack from “rattling”while the vehicle is in motion, lowerthe jack to the lowest position, placethe jack in the luggage side trim andturn the wing bolt (1) clockwise firmly.Make sure the jack is secured firmlyby trying to move the jack forwardand backward.

Follow jacking instructions to reducethe possibility of personal injury.

WARNING - Changing tires• Never attempt vehicle repairs

in the traffic lanes of a publicroad or highway.

• Always move the vehicle com-pletely off the road and ontothe shoulder before trying tochange a tire. The jack shouldbe used on level firm ground.If you cannot find a firm, levelplace off the road, call a tow-ing service company forassistance.

• Be sure to use the correctfront and rear jacking posi-tions on the vehicle; never usethe bumpers or any other partof the vehicle for jack support.

(Continued)

OVQ059007N

What to do in an emergency

105

Tire replacement 1. Park on a level surface and apply

the parking brake firmly.2. Shift the shift lever into P (Park)

with automatic transaxle.3. Activate the hazard warning flash-

er.

4. Remove the wheel lug nut wrench,jack, jack handle, and spare tirefrom the vehicle.

5. Block both the front and rear of thewheel that is diagonally oppositethe jack position.

1VQA4022 1VQA4023

(Continued)• The vehicle can easily roll off

the jack causing seriousinjury or death. No personshould place any portion oftheir body under a vehicle thatis supported only by a jack;use vehicle support stands.

• Do not start or run the enginewhile the vehicle is on thejack.

• Do not allow anyone to remainin the vehicle while it is on thejack.

• Make sure any children pres-ent are in a secure place awayfrom the road and from thevehicle to be raised with thejack.

5 11

What to do in an emergency

6. Loosen the wheel lug nuts coun-terclockwise one turn each, but donot remove any nut until the tirehas been raised off the ground.

7. Place the jack at the front or rearjacking position closest to the tireyou are changing. Place the jackat the designated locations underthe frame. The jacking positionsare plates welded to the framewith two tabs and a raised dot toindex with the jack.

WARNING - Jack locationTo reduce the possibility ofinjury, be sure to use only thejack provided with the vehicleand in the correct jack position;never use any other part of thevehicle for jack support.

1VQA4024 OVQ049406

WARNING - Changing a tire• To prevent vehicle movement

while changing a tire, alwaysset the parking brake fully, andalways block the wheel diago-nally opposite the wheel beingchanged.

• We recommend that thewheels of the vehicle bechocked, and that no personremain in a vehicle that isbeing jacked.

What to do in an emergency

125

8. Insert the jack handle into the jackand turn it clockwise, raising thevehicle until the tire just clears theground. This measurement isapproximately 30 mm (1.2 in).Before removing the wheel lugnuts, make sure the vehicle is sta-ble and that there is no chance formovement or slippage.

9. Remove the wheel lug nuts byturning them counterclockwise,then remove the wheel.

10. Mount the spare tire into positionand install the wheel lug nutswith the beveled edge inward.

11. Once the wheel lug nuts havebeen tightened, lower the vehiclefully to the ground and continue totighten the lug nuts until they arefully secured. Tighten the wheellug nuts firmly in a “ ” pattern.If you are unsure of the tightnessof the wheel lug nuts, have themchecked at the nearest servicestation. The specified tighteningtorque is 9~11 kg•m (65-79 lb•ft,88-107 N•m). Improperly tight-ened wheel lug nuts could causebrake pedal vibration while brak-ing.

CAUTIONYour vehicle has metric threadson the wheel studs and nuts.Make certain during wheelremoval that the same nutsremoved are reinstalled - or, ifreplaced, that nuts with metricthreads and the same chamferconfiguration are used.Installation of a non-metricthread nut on a metric stud orvice-versa will not secure thewheel to the hub properly andwill damage the stud so that itmust be replaced.Note that most lug nuts do nothave metric threads. Be sure touse extreme care in checkingfor thread style before installingaftermarket lug nuts or wheels.If in doubt, consult anAuthorized Kia Dealer.

OVQ056008N1VQA4026

X

5 13

What to do in an emergency

To prevent the jack, jack handle,wheel lug nut wrench and spare tirefrom rattling while the vehicle is inmotion, store them properly.

Carrying a flat tire Do not store the flat tire on the com-pact spare tire carrier underneathyour vehicle. The full size flat tireshould be stored and fixed in thevehicle until you reach a service sta-tion.

To place a flat tire in the vehicle:1. Wrap the flat tire with the cover

with the valve stem facing up.

WARNING - Wheel studsIf the studs are damaged, theymay lose their ability to retainthe wheel.This could lead to theloss of the wheel and a collisionresulting in serious injuries.

WARNING - Inadequatespare tire pressure

Check the inflation pressures assoon as possible after installingthe spare tire. Adjust it to thespecified pressure, if necessary.Refer to Section 8, Specifications.

OVQ056010N

What to do in an emergency

145

2. Place the flat tire in the cargo areawhen the 3rd row seat is uprightposition or on the floor when the3rd row seat is stowed in the cargoarea.

3. If necessary, connect the twostraps with the buckle.Pass one end of the strap throughthe wheel center and connect bothstrap hooks to each striker of the3rd row seat on the floor.

4. Tighten the strap firmly pulling thestrap out of the buckle.

5. Make sure the flat tire is properlysecured by trying to move it.

OVQ056013N

OVQ056014N

OVQ056011N

OVQ056012N

OVQ059300A

WARNING - Flat tireNever leave the flat tire unfixedin the vehicle to prevent the tire“rattling”. Otherwise, the unse-cured flat tire may be thrownabout inside the vehicle whichcan cause damage to the vehi-cle and serious injury or deathto the vehicle occupants in caseof a sharp turn, a sudden stopor an accident.

5 15

What to do in an emergency

TOWING

If emergency towing is necessary, werecommend having it done by an author-ized Kia dealer or a commercial tow-truckservice. Proper lifting and towing proce-dures are necessary to prevent damageto the vehicle. The use of wheel dollies orflatbed is recommended.For trailer towing guidelines information,refer to section 4 “Driving your vehicle”.

It is acceptable to tow the vehicle with therear wheels on the ground (without dol-lies) and the front wheels off the ground.When being towed by a commercial towtruck and wheel dollies are not used, thefront of the vehicle should always be lift-ed, not the rear.

1VQA40291VQA4028

1VQA4030

1GHA4105A

CAUTION• Do not tow the vehicle backwards

with the front wheels on theground as this may cause dam-age to the vehicle.

• Do not tow with sling-type equip-ment. Use wheel lift or flatbedequipment.

What to do in an emergency

165

When towing your vehicle in an emer-gency without wheel dollies :1. Set the ignition switch in the ACC posi-

tion.2. Place the transaxle shift lever in N

(Neutral).3. Release the parking brake.

If your car must be towedTowing with a vehicle other than atow truck

If towing is necessary, we recommendyou to have it done by an AuthorizedKia dealer or a commercial tow truckservice.If towing service is not available in anemergency, your vehicle may be tem-porarily towed using a cable or chainsecured to the emergency towing hookunder the rear of the vehicle. Useextreme caution when towing the vehicle.A driver must be in the vehicle to steer itand operate the brakes.

Towing in this manner may be done onlyon hard-surfaced roads for a short dis-tance and at low speeds. Also, thewheels, axles, power train, steering andbrakes must all be in good condition.• Do not use the tow hooks to pull a vehi-

cle out of mud, sand or other condi-tions from which the vehicle cannot bedriven out under its own power.

• Avoid towing a vehicle heavier than thevehicle doing the towing.

• The drivers of both vehicles shouldcommunicate with each other frequent-ly.

CAUTIONFailure to place the transaxle shiftlever in N (Neutral) may cause inter-nal damage to the transaxle. OVQ056016N

5 17

What to do in an emergency

• Before emergency towing, check thatthe hook is not broken or damaged.

• Fasten the towing cable or chainsecurely to the hook.

• Do not jerk the hook. Apply steady andeven force.

• To avoid damaging the hook, do notpull from the side or at a vertical angle.Always pull straight ahead.

WARNING Use extreme caution when towingthe vehicle.• Avoid sudden starts or erratic

driving maneuvers which wouldplace excessive stress on theemergency towing hook and tow-ing cable or chain. The hook andtowing cable or chain may breakand cause serious injury or dam-age.

• If the disable vehicle is unable tobe moved, do not forcibly contin-ue the towing. Contact anAuthorized Kia dealer or a com-mercial tow truck service forassistance.

• Tow the vehicle as straight aheadas possible.

• Keep away from the vehicle dur-ing towing.

CAUTIONTo prevent internal damage to thetransaxle, never tow your vehiclefrom the rear (backwards) with allfour tires in contact with the sur-face.

CAUTION• Attach a towing strap to the tow

hook.• Using a portion of the vehicle

other than the tow hooks for tow-ing may damage the body of yourvehicle.

• Use only a cable or chain specifi-cally intended for use in towingvehicles. Securely fasten thecable or chain to the towing hookprovided.

What to do in an emergency

185

Tips for towing a stuck vehicleThe following methods are effectivewhen your vehicle is stuck in mud, sandor similar substances that prevent thevehicle from being driven out under itsown power.• Remove the soil and sand, etc. from

the front and the back of the tires.• Place a stone or wood under the tires.

Tie-down hook (for flatbed towing)

1VQA4033

WARNING Do not use the hooks under thefront of the vehicle for towing pur-poses. These hooks are designedONLY for transport tie-down. If thetie-down hooks are used for towing,the tie-down hooks or front bumperwill be damaged and this could leadto serious injury.

6

Maintenance services / 6-2Maintenance schedule / 6-3Owner maintenance / 6-10Engine compartment / 6-12Engine oil / 6-13Engine coolant / 6-14Air cleaner / 6-16Brakes / 6-17Lubricants and fluids / 6-18Power steering / 6-19Climate control air filter / 6-19Wiper blades / 6-20Fuses / 6-22Battery / 6-30Tires and wheels / 6-32

Lubricant / 6-43Appearance care / 6-46Emission control system / 6-49

Maintenance

Maintenance

26

MAINTENANCE SERVICESYou should exercise the utmost care toprevent damage to your vehicle andinjury to yourself whenever performingany maintenance or inspection proce-dures.Should you have any doubts concerningthe inspection or servicing of your vehi-cle, we strongly recommend that youhave an Authorized Kia Dealer performthis work.An Authorized Kia Dealer has factory-trained technicians and genuine Kiaparts to service your vehicle properly. Forexpert advice and quality service, see anAuthorized Kia Dealer.Inadequate, incomplete or insufficientservicing may result in operational prob-lems with your vehicle that could lead tovehicle damage, an accident, or person-al injury.

Owner’s responsibility

Maintenance Service and RecordRetention are the owner's responsibil-ity.

You should retain documents that showproper maintenance has been performedon your vehicle in accordance with thescheduled maintenance service chartsshown on the following pages. You needthis information to establish your compli-ance with the servicing and maintenancerequirements of your Kia warranties.Detailed warranty information is providedin your Warranty & Consumer Informationmanual.

Repairs and adjustments required as aresult of improper maintenance or a lackof required maintenance are not covered.We strongly recommend that all vehiclemaintenance be performed by an author-ized Kia dealer using genuine Kia parts.

6 3

Maintenance

MAINTENANCE SCHEDULE

Kilometers or time in months, whichever comes first

× 1,000 km 12 24 36 48 60 72 84 96 108 120 132 144 156 168 180 192

# Months 6 12 18 24 30 36 42 48 54 60 66 72 78 84 90 96

Engine oil and oil filter

Add fuel additive (1)

Fuel filter (2) I I I I

I I I I

Fuel tank air filer (CCV filter) (2) I I I I

MAINTENANCEINTERVALS

MAINTENANCE ITEM

Replace every 12,000 km or 12 months

Add every 12,000 km or 12 months

(1) If TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline is not available, one bottle of additive is recommended. Additives ars available from your authorized KIA deal-er along with information on how to use them. Do not mix other additives.

(2) Fuel filter & Fuel tank air filter are considered to be maintenance free but periodic inspection is recommended for this maintenance scheduledepends on fuel quality. If there are some important safety matters like fuel flow restriction, surging, loss of power, hard starting problem etc,replace the fuel filter immediately regardless of maintenance schedule and consult an authorized KIA dealer for details.

The following maintenance services must be performed to ensure good emission control and performance. Keep receipts for all vehicle emissionservices to protect your warranty. Where both kilometrage and time are shown, the frequency of service is determined by whichever occurs first.R : Replace or change I : Inspect and if necessary, adjust, correct, clean or replace.

NORMAL MAINTENANCE SCHEDULE

Fuel tank, fuel filler cap, canister, vapor hose, fuel line, fuel hoses and connections of each part.

Maintenance

46

Kilometers or time in months, whichever comes first

× 1,000 km 12 24 36 48 60 72 84 96 108 120 132 144 156 168 180 192

# Months 6 12 18 24 30 36 42 48 54 60 66 72 78 84 90 96

Vaccum hoses I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I

Air cleaner element I I I R I I I R I I I R I I I R

Spark plugs R

Valve clearance (3) I I

MAINTENANCEINTERVALS

MAINTENANCE ITEM

(3) Inspect for excessive valve noise and/or engine vibration and adjust if necessary. A qualified technician should perform the operation.

R : Replace or change I : Inspect and if necessary, adjust, correct, clean or replace.

NORMAL MAINTENANCE SCHEDULE (CONT.)

6 5

Maintenance

NORMAL MAINTENANCE SCHEDULE (CONT.)

MAINTENANCEINTERVALS

MAINTENANCE ITEM

R : Replace or change I : Inspect and if necessary, adjust, correct, clean or replace.

* if equipped

(4) The drive belt should be replaced when cracks occur or tension is reduced excessively.

(5) When adding coolant, use only deionizes water or soft water for your vehicle and never mix hard water in the coolant filled at the factory.An inproper coolant mixture can result in serious maifunction or engine damage.

Kilometers or time in months, whichever comes first

× 1,000 km 12 24 36 48 60 72 84 96 108 120 132 144 156 168 180 192

# Months 6 12 18 24 30 36 42 48 54 60 66 72 78 84 90 96

Drive belts (4)

Engine coolant (5)

Cooling system hoses & connections I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I

Automatic transaxle oil

Brake/clutch* fluid I I I I

Brake lines/lines & connectionsI I I I I I I I

(including booster)

Clutch* & brake pedal free play I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I

At first, inspect the drive belt at 96,000 km or 72 months;

after that, inspect it 24,000 km or 24 months

At first, replace at 192,000 km or 120 months;

after that, replace every 48,000 km or 24 months

No check, No service required

Maintenance

66

Kilometers or time in months, whichever comes first

× 1,000 km 12 24 36 48 60 72 84 96 108 120 132 144 156 168 180 192

# Months 6 12 18 24 30 36 42 48 54 60 66 72 78 84 90 96

Front brake disc/pads, calipers I I I I I I I I

Rear brake disc/pads I I I I I I I I

Parking brake I I I I

Exhaust pipes, heat shield & mountings I I I I I I I I

Front suspension ball jonts I I I I I I I I

Steering gear box, linkage & boots/I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I

lower arm ball joint, upper arm ball joint

Drive shaft dust boots I I I I I I I I

All latch, hinges and locks I I I I I I I I

Battery condition I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I

MAINTENANCEINTERVALS

MAINTENANCE ITEM

NORMAL MAINTENANCE SCHEDULE (CONT.)R : Replace or change I : Inspect and if necessary, adjust, correct, clean or replace.

6 7

Maintenance

Kilometers or time in months, whichever comes first

× 1,000 km 12 24 36 48 60 72 84 96 108 120 132 144 156 168 180 192

# Months 6 12 18 24 30 36 42 48 54 60 66 72 78 84 90 96

Power steering fluid and lines* I I I I I I I I

Power steering pump, belt and hoses I I I I I I I I

Climate contol air filter R R R R R R R R

Air conditioner compressor operation & I I I I I I I I

refrigerant amount

Rotate tires I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I

Tire condition & inflation pressure I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I I

MAINTENANCEINTERVALS

MAINTENANCE ITEM

NORMAL MAINTENANCE SCHEDULE (CONT.)R : Replace or change I : Inspect and if necessary, adjust, correct, clean or replace.

* if equipped

Maintenance

86

MAINTENANCE UNDER SEVERE USAGE CONDITIONSThe following items must be serviced more frequently on cars normally used under severe driving conditions. Refer to the chartbelow for the appropriate maintenance intervals.

R : Replace I : Inspect and, after inspection, clean, adjust, repair or replace if necessary

R

R

R

R

I

I

I

I

I

EVERY 6,000 km OR 6 MONTHS

MORE FREQUENTLY

MORE FREQUENTLY

EVERY 96,000 km

MORE FREQUENTLY

MORE FREQUENTLY

MORE FREQUENTLY

MORE FREQUENTLY

EVERY 12,000 km OR 6 MONTHS

A, B, C, D, E, F, G, H, I, K

C, E

B, H

A, C, D, E, F, G, H, I

C, D, G, H

C, D, G, H

C, D, G, H

C, D, E, F, G, H, I

C, D, E, F, G

ENGINE OIL AND OIL FILTER

AIR CLEANER ELEMENT

SPARK PLUGS

AUTOMATIC TRANSAXLE FLUID

FRONT BRAKE DISC/PADS, CALIPERS

REAR BRAKE DISC/PADS

PARKING BRAKE

STEERING GEAR BOX, LINKAGE & BOOTS/

LOWER ARM BALL JOINT, UPPER ARM BSALL JOINT

DRIVE SHAFTS AND BOOTS

MAINTENANCE ITEM MAINTENANCEOPERATION

MAINTENANCEINTERVALS

DRIVINGCONDITION

6 9

Maintenance

SEVERE DRIVING CONDITIONS

A - Repeatedly driving shorts distanse of less than 8 km (5 miles) innormal temperature or less than 16 km (10 miles) in freezing tem-perature

B - Extensive engine idling or low speed driving for long distancesC - Driving on rough, dusty, muddy, unpaved, graveled or salt-spread

roadsD - Driving in areas using salt or other corrosive materials or in very

cold weather

E - Driving in sandy areasF - Driving in heavy traffic area over 32°C (90°F)G - Driving on uphill, downhill, or mountain roadH - Towing a Trailer, or using a camper, or roof rackI - Driving as a patrol car, taxi, other commercial use or vehicle towingJ - Driving over 170 km/h (100 mph)K - Frequently driving in stop-and-go conditions

R MORE FREQUENTLY C, ECLIMATE CONTROL AIR FILTER

(FOR EVAPORATOR AND BLOWER UNIT)

MAINTENANCE ITEM MAINTENANCEOPERATION

MAINTENANCEINTERVALS

DRIVINGCONDITION

Maintenance

106

OWNER MAINTENANCE Owner maintenance schedule The following lists are vehicle checks andinspections that should be performed bythe owner or an Authorized Kia Dealer atthe frequencies indicated to help ensuresafe, dependable operation of your vehi-cle.Any adverse conditions should bebrought to the attention of your dealer assoon as possible.These Owner Maintenance Checks aregenerally not covered by warranties andyou may be charged for labor, parts andlubricants used.

When you stop for fuel:• Check the engine oil level.• Check coolant level in coolant reser-

voir.

• Check the windshield washer fluidlevel.

• Look for low or under-inflated tires.

While operating your vehicle:• Note any changes in the sound of the

exhaust or any smell of exhaust fumesin the vehicle.

• Check for vibrations in the steeringwheel. Notice any increased steeringeffort or looseness in the steeringwheel, or change in its straight-aheadposition.

• Notice if your vehicle constantly turnsslightly or “pulls” to one side when trav-eling on smooth, level road.

• When stopping, listen and check forunusual sounds, pulling to one side,increased brake pedal travel or “hard-to-push” brake pedal.

• If any slipping or changes in the oper-ation of your transaxle occurs, checkthe transaxle fluid level.

• Check automatic transaxle P (Park)function.

• Check parking brake.• Check for fluid leaks under your vehicle

(water dripping from the air condition-ing system during or after use is nor-mal).

At least monthly:• Check coolant level in the coolant

recovery reservoir.• Check the operation of all exterior

lights, including the stoplights, turn sig-nals and hazard warning flashers.

• Check the inflation pressures of alltires including the spare.

At least twice a year (i.e., every Spring and Fall):• Check radiator, heater and air condi-

tioning hoses for leaks or damage.• Check windshield washer spray and

wiper operation. Clean wiper bladeswith clean cloth dampened with wash-er fluid.

• Check headlight alignment.• Check muffler, exhaust pipes, shields

and clamps.• Check the lap/shoulder belts for wear

and function.• Check for worn tires and loose wheel

lug nuts.

WARNING Be careful when checking yourengine coolant level when theengine is hot. Scalding hot coolantand steam may blow out underpressure.This could cause burns orother serious injury.

6 11

Maintenance

At least once a year:• Clean body and door drain holes.• Lubricate door hinges and checks, and

hood hinges.• Lubricate door and hood locks and

latches.• Lubricate door rubber weatherstrips.• Check the air conditioning system

before the warm weather season.• Check the power steering fluid level.• Inspect and lubricate automatic

transaxle linkage and controls.• Clean battery and terminals.• Check the brake fluid level.

Owner maintenance precautions Improper or incomplete service mayresult in problems. This section givesinstructions only for the maintenanceitems that are easy to perform.As explained earlier in this section, sev-eral procedures can be done only by anAuthorized Kia Dealer with special tools.

Improper owner maintenance duringthe warranty period may affect war-ranty coverage. For details, read theseparate Kia Warranty & ConsumerInformation Manual provided with thevehicle. If you're unsure about anyservicing or maintenance procedure,have it done by an Authorized KiaDealer.

WARNING - Maintenancework

• Performing maintenance work ona vehicle can be dangerous. Youcan be seriously injured while per-forming some maintenance pro-cedures. If you lack sufficientknowledge and experience or theproper tools and equipment to dothe work, have it done by anAuthorized Kia Dealer.

• Working under the hood with theengine running is dangerous. Itbecomes even more dangerouswhen you wear jewelry or looseclothing. These can becomeentangled in moving parts andresult in injury. Always remove allloose or hanging clothing and alljewelry before working on theengine.

Maintenance

126

ENGINE COMPARTMENT

OVQ060001N

1. Engine coolant reservoir

2. Engine oil filler cap

3. Brake fluid reservoir

4. Air cleaner

5. Fuse box

6. Negative battery terminal

7. Positive battery terminal

8. Radiator cap

9. Engine oil dipstick

10. Power steering fluid reservoir

11. Windshield washer fluid reservoir

* The actual engine room in the vehicle may differ from the illustration.

6 13

Maintenance

ENGINE OIL

Checking the engine oil level 1. Be sure the vehicle is on level ground.2. Start the engine and allow it to reach

normal operating temperature.3. Turn the engine off and wait for a few

minutes (about 5 minutes) for the oil toreturn to the oil pan.

4. Pull the dipstick out, wipe it clean, andre-insert it fully.

5. Pull the dipstick out again and checkthe level. The level should be betweenF and L.

If it is near or at L, add enough oil to bringthe level to F. Do not overfill.

Use a funnel to refill the new oil com-fortably.

Use only the specified engine oil. (Referto “Recommended Lubricants” later inthis section.)

Have engine oil and filter changed by anAuthorized Kia Dealer according to theMaintenance Schedule at the beginningof this section.

WARNINGUsed engine oil may cause irritationor cancer of the skin if left in con-tact with the skin for prolongedperiods of time. Used engine oilcontains chemicals that havecaused cancer in laboratory ani-mals. Always protect your skin bywashing your hands thoroughlywith soap and warm water as soonas possible after handling used oil.

WARNING - Radiator hoseBe very careful not to touch theradiator hose when checking oradding the engine oil as it may behot enough to burn you.

OVQ066002N OXM079005

CAUTIONDo not spill engine oil, when addingor changing engine oil. If you dropthe engine oil on the engine room,wipe it off immediately.

Maintenance

146

ENGINE COOLANTThe high-pressure cooling system has areservoir filled with year-round antifreezecoolant. The reservoir is filled at the fac-tory.Check the antifreeze protection andcoolant level at least once a year, at thebeginning of the winter season, andbefore traveling to a colder climate.

Checking the coolant level

Check the condition and connections ofall cooling system hoses and heaterhoses. Replace any swollen or deterio-rated hoses.

WARNINGRemoving radiatorcap

• Never attempt to remove the radi-ator cap while the engine is oper-ating or hot. Doing so might leadto cooling system and enginedamage and could result in seri-ous personal injury from escap-ing hot coolant or steam.

• Turn the engine off and wait untilit cools down. Use extreme carewhen removing the radiator cap.Wrap a thick towel around it, andturn it counterclockwise slowly tothe first stop.

(Continued)

(Continued)Step back while the pressure isreleased from the cooling system.When you are sure all the pres-sure has been released, pressdown on the cap, using a thicktowel, and continue turning coun-terclockwise to remove it.

• Even if the engine is not operat-ing, do not remove the radiatorcap or the drain plug while theengine and radiator are hot. Hotcoolant and steam may still blowout under pressure, causing seri-ous injury.

OVQ066004N

WARNING The electric motor (cool-ing fan) is controlled byengine coolant tempera-ture, refrigerant pres-sure and vehicle speed.

It may sometimes operate evenwhen the engine is not running. Useextreme caution when working nearthe blades of the cooling fan so thatyou are not injured by a rotating fanblades. As the engine coolant tem-perature decreases, the electricmotor will automatically shut off.This is a normal condition.

6 15

Maintenance

The coolant level should be filledbetween F and L marks on the side of thecoolant reservoir when the engine iscool.If the coolant level is low, add enoughspecified coolant to provide protectionagainst freezing and corrosion. Bring thelevel to F, but do not overfill. If frequentadditions are required, see an AuthorizedKia Dealer for a cooling system inspec-tion.

Have coolant changed by an AuthorizedKia Dealer according to the MaintenanceSchedule at the beginning of this section.• When adding coolant, use only deion-

ized water or soft water for your vehicleand never mix hard water in thecoolant filled at the factory. An improp-er coolant mixture can result in seriousmalfunction or engine damage.

• The engine in your vehicle has alu-minum engine parts and must be pro-tected by an ethylene-glycol-basedcoolant to prevent corrosion and freez-ing.

• DO NOT USE alcohol or methanolcoolant or mix them with the specifiedcoolant.

• Do not use a solution that containsmore than 60% antifreeze or less than35% antifreeze, which would reducethe effectiveness of the solution.

For mixture percentage, refer to the fol-lowing table.

-15°C (5°F) 35 65

-25°C (-13°F) 40 60

-35°C (-31°F) 50 50

-45°C (-49°F) 60 40

AmbientTemperature

Mixture Percentage (volume)

CoolantSolution

Water

OVQ066021N

Maintenance

166

Element replacement Have the air cleaner element checkedand replaced in accordance with themaintenance schedule.

OVQ066005N

WARNINGRadiator cap

Do not remove the radiator capwhen the engine and radiator arehot. Scalding hot coolant and steammay blow out under pressure caus-ing serious injury.

OVQ066010N

WARNING - EngineDriving without an air cleanerencourages backfiring, which couldcause a fire in the engine compart-ment.

CAUTION - EngineDo not drive with the air cleanerremoved; this will result in exces-sive engine wear.

AIR CLEANER

6 17

Maintenance

BRAKES

Checking brake fluid level Check the fluid level in the reservoir peri-odically. The fluid level should bebetween MAX and MIN marks on theside of the reservoir.Before removing the reservoir cap andadding brake fluid, clean the area aroundthe reservoir cap thoroughly to preventbrake fluid contamination.If the level is low, add fluid to the MAXlevel. The level will fall with accumulatedmileage. This is a normal condition asso-ciated with the wear of the brake linings.If the fluid level is excessively low, havethe brake system checked by anAuthorized Kia Dealer.

Use only the specified brake fluid. (Referto “Recommended Lubricants” later inthis section.)

Never mix different types of fluid.

WARNING - Brake fluidWhen changing and adding brakefluid, handle it carefully. Do not let itcome in contact with your eyes. Ifbrake fluid should come in contactwith your eyes, immediately flushthem with a large quantity of freshtap water. Have your eyes examinedby a doctor as soon as possible.

WARNING - Loss of brakefluid

In the event the brake systemrequires frequent additions of fluid,the vehicle should be inspected byan Authorized Kia Dealer.

CAUTION Do not allow brake fluid to contactthe vehicle's body paint, as paintdamage will result. Brake fluid,which has been exposed to open airfor an extended time should neverbe used as its quality cannot beguaranteed. It should be thrownout. Don't put in the wrong kind offluid. A few drops of mineral-basedoil, such as engine oil, in your brakesystem can damage brake systemparts.

OVQ067024N

Maintenance

186

LUBRICANTS AND FLUIDS

Checking the washer fluid level The reservoir is translucent so that youcan check the level with a quick visualinspection.Check the fluid level in the washer fluidreservoir and add fluid if necessary. Plainwater may be used if washer fluid is notavailable. However, use washer solventwith antifreeze characteristics in cold cli-mates to prevent freezing.

This warning light indicatesthe washer fluid reservoir isnear empty. Refill the washerfluid as soon as possible.

Body lubrication All moving points of the body, such asdoor hinges, hood hinges, and locks,should be lubricated each time theengine oil is changed. Use a non-freez-ing lubricant on locks during cold weath-er.Make sure the engine hood secondarylatch keeps the hood from opening whenthe primary latch is released.

WARNING - Coolant• Do not use radiator coolant or

antifreeze in the washer fluidreservoir.

• Radiator coolant can severelyobscure visibility when sprayedon the windshield and may causeloss of vehicle control or damageto paint and body trim.

• Windshield washer fluid agentscontain some amounts of alcoholand can be flammable under cer-tain circumstances. Do not allowsparks or flame to contact thewasher fluid or the washer fluidreservoir. Damage to the vehicleor it's occupants could occur.

• Windshield washer fluid is poi-sonous to humans and animals.Do not drink and avoid contactingwindshield washer fluid. Seriousinjury or death could occur.

OVQ066013N

6 19

Maintenance

POWER STEERING

Checking the power steering fluidlevel With the vehicle on level ground, checkthe fluid level in the power steering reser-voir periodically. The fluid should bebetween MAX and MIN marks on theside of the reservoir at the normal tem-perature.Before adding power steering fluid, thor-oughly clean the area around the reser-voir cap to prevent power steering fluidcontamination.If the level is low, add fluid to the MAXlevel.In the event the power steering systemrequires frequent addition of fluid, thevehicle should be inspected by anAuthorized Kia Dealer.

Use only the specified power steeringfluid. (Refer to "RecommendedLubricants" later in this section.)

Power steering hosesCheck the connections for oil leaks,severe damage and twists in the powersteering hose before driving.

The climate control air filter installedbehind the glove box filters the dust orother pollutants that come into the vehi-cle from the outside through the heatingand air conditioning system. If dust orother pollutants accumulate in the filterover a period of time, the air flow from theair vents may decrease, resulting inmoisture accumulation on the inside ofthe windshield even when the outside(fresh) air position is selected. If this hap-pens, have the climate control air filterreplaced by an Authorized Kia Dealer.

CAUTION• To avoid damage to the power

steering pump, do not operate thevehicle for prolonged periodswith a low power steering fluidlevel.

• Never start the engine when thereservoir tank is empty.

• When adding fluid, be careful thatdirt does not get into the tank.

• Too little fluid can result inincreased steering effort and/ornoise from the power steering sys-tem.

• The use of the non-specified fluidcould reduce the effectiveness ofthe power steering system andcause damage to it.

OVQ066012N

CLIMATE CONTROL AIR FILTER

1LDA5047

Outside air

Recirculatedair

Climate controlair filter

Blower

Evaporatorcore

Heater core

Maintenance

206

The climate control air filter should bereplaced every 15,000 km (10,000miles). If the vehicle is operated in theseverely air-polluted cities or on dustyrough roads for a long period, it shouldbe inspected more frequently andreplaced earlier. When you try to replacethe climate control air filter by ownermaintenance, replace it performing thefollowing procedure, and in this case, becareful to avoid damaging other compo-nents.

Maintenance Commercial hot waxes applied byautomatic car washes have beenknown to make the windshield diffi-cult to clean.

Contamination of either the windshield orthe wiper blades with foreign matter canreduce the effectiveness of the wind-shield wipers. Common sources of con-tamination are insects, tree sap, and hotwax treatments used by some commer-cial car washes. If the blades are not wip-ing properly, clean both the window andthe blades with a good cleaner or milddetergent, and rinse thoroughly withclean water.

Replacement When the wipers no longer clean ade-quately, the blades may be worn orcracked, and require replacement.

WIPER BLADES

1VQA5022

CAUTIONTo prevent damage to the wiperblades, do not use gasoline,kerosene, paint thinner, or othersolvents on or near them.

CAUTIONTo prevent damage to the wiperarms or other components, do notattempt to move the wipers manual-ly.

CAUTIONThe use of a non-specified wiperblade could result in wiper malfunc-tion and failure.

6 21

Maintenance

Front windshield wiper blade1. Raise the wiper arm and turn the wiper

blade assembly to expose the plasticlocking clip.

2. Compress the clip and slide the bladeassembly downward.

3. Lift it off the arm.4. Install the blade assembly in the

reverse order of removal.

Rear window wiper blade replace-ment To prevent damage to the wiper arms orother components, have an authorizedKia dealer replace the wiper blade.

1LDA5023

1LDA5024

1LDA5025

CAUTIONDo not allow the wiper arm to fallagainst the windshield, since it maychip or crack the windshield.

Maintenance

226

FUSES

A vehicle’s electrical system is protectedfrom electrical overload damage byfuses.

This vehicle has three fuse panels, onelocated in the driver’s side panel bolster,another in the cargo area, the other inthe engine compartment near the bat-tery.If any of your vehicle’s lights, acces-sories, or controls do not work, check theappropriate circuit fuse. If a fuse hasblown, the element inside the fuse will bemelted.If the electrical system does not work,first check the driver’s side fuse panel.Always replace a blown fuse with one ofthe same rating.If the replacement fuse blows, this indi-cates an electrical problem. Avoid usingthe system involved and immediatelyconsult an Authorized Kia Dealer.Three kinds of fuses are used: blade typefor lower amperage rating and cartridgetype, fusible link for higher amperage rat-ings.

Fuse replacement

1VQA4037

Normal

Normal

Blade type

Cartridge type

Fusible link

Blown

Blown

Normal Blown

WARNING - Fuse replace-ment

• Never replace a fuse with any-thing but another fuse of thesame rating.

• A higher capacity fuse couldcause damage possibly a fire.

• Never install a wire or aluminumfoil instead of the proper fuse -even as a temporary repair. It maycause extensive wiring damageand a possible fire.

CAUTIONDo not use a screwdriver or anyother metal object to remove fusesbecause it may cause a short circuitand damage the system.

6 23

Maintenance

Engine compartment1. Turn the ignition switch and all other

switches off.2. Remove the fuse box cover by press-

ing the tap and pulling up.3. Check the removed fuse; replace it if it

is blown. To remove or insert the fuse,use the fuse puller in the main fusebox in the engine compartment.

4. Push in a new fuse of the same rating,and make sure it fits tightly in the clips.

If it fits loosely, consult an Authorized KiaDealer. Inner panel

1. Turn the ignition switch and all otherswitches off.

2. Open the fuse panel cover.

1VQA4006

CAUTIONAfter checking the fuse box in theengine compartment, securelyinstall the fuse box cover. If not,electrical failures may occur fromwater leaking in.

1VQA4002

OVQ059016N

Driver’s side panel

Rear cargo area panel

Maintenance

246

3. Pull the suspected fuse straight out.Use the removal tool provided on themain fuse box in the engine compart-ment.

4. Check the removed fuse; replace it if itis blown.Spare fuses are provided in the mainfuse box in the engine compartment.

5. Push in a new fuse of the same rating,and make sure it fits tightly in the clips.

If it fits loosely, consult an Authorized KiaDealer.If you do not have a spare, use a fuse ofthe same rating from a circuit you maynot need for operating the vehicle, suchas the cigar lighter fuse.

If the headlights or other electrical com-ponents do not work and the fuses areOK, check the fuse block in the enginecompartment. If a fuse is blown, it mustbe replaced.

Main fuseIf the main fuse is blown, it must beremoved as follows:1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.2. Remove the nuts shown in the picture

above.3. Replace the fuse with a new one of the

same rating.4. Reinstall in the reverse order of

removal.

✽✽ NOTICEIf the main fuse is blown, consult anAuthorized Kia Dealer.

1VQA40081VQA4004

6 25

Maintenance

Fuse/Relay panel descriptionInside the fuse/relay box covers, you can find the fuse/relay label describing fuse/relayname and capacity.

Driver’s side panel Engine compartment

OVA067012/OVQ069017N/OVQ067104N/OVQ046010N

Rear cargo area panel

Maintenance

266

Driver's side fuse panel

Description Fuse rating Protected componentAUDIO 15A Audio, Step lampMEMORY 7.5A Climate control module, Clock, Cluster, Trip computer, Front area module, Power sliding door module, Power

tailgate module, Driver's door module, Front passenger door module, Driver's power seat module, Driver position memory system unit

VRS 10A Variable rack stroke system module, Variable rack stroke system control buttonIG2-1 7.5A Air conditioner control module, Multi function switch, Inside relay box, ECM mirror, Rain sensor, Seat WarmerIG2-2 7.5A Rear climate control button, Front area module, Power sliding door module, Power tailgate module, Driver's door

module, Front passenger door module, Driver's power seat module, Driver position memory system unitOBD-II 7.5A OBD-II, Diagonosis connectorROOM 7.5A Vanity mirror, Map lamp, Overhead console, Room lamp switch, Climate control module, HomelinkK/LOCK 7.5A Key interlock solenoidILLUMI 7.5A Instrument panel illuminationAMP 25A AmplifierSEAT WARMER 20A Inside relay box(Seat warmer)SUNROOF 25A Sunroof moduleDDM 30A Driver's door moduleTPMS 7.5A Tire pressure monitoring systemPEDAL 15A Power adjustable pedal relay(None-driver position memory system only)P/OUTLET 1 15A Power outlet(Front)ASS P/SEAT 20A Front passenger's power seat moduleDRV P/SEAT 30A Driver's power seat moduleADM 30A Front passenger door moduleACC 7.5A Audio, Clock, Outside rearview mirror control and folding switchP/OUTLET 2 15A Cigar lighter, Power outletSTART 7.5A Start relayAIRBAG IND 7.5A Cluster

6 27

Maintenance

Description Fuse rating Protected componentENG 7.5A Automatic shift lever switch, Vehicle speed sensor, Inhibitor switch, Transaxle control module,

Input speed sensor, Output speed sensor, Back-up lamp switch, Fuel filterIG1 7.5A Trip computer, Buzzer(Back warning system), Cluster, ESC switch, Ambient temperature sensor, GeneratorABS 7.5A ABS control module, ESC control module, Yaw rate sensor, Steering angle sensorAIRBAG 15A Air bag control moduleALTERNATOR - Generator relaySHUNT - Shunt connector

Description Fuse rating Protected componentRR D/LOCK 20A Sliding door lock relay, Sliding door unlock relay, Sliding door lock actuator, Tailgate lock actuatorRR WIPER 15A Rear wiper relay, Rear wiper motorRR DEFOG 25A Rear window defroster relay, Rear window defrosterPOWER TAIL GATE 30A Power tailgate moduleP/QUARTER 10A Power rear quarter glass open relay, Power rear quarter glass close relay, Power rear quarter glass motorRR P/WIN-RH 25A Sliding door power window relay(Right), Sliding door power window motor(Right)RR P/WIN-LH 25A Sliding door power window relay(Left), Sliding door power window motor(Left)PSD-RH 30A Power sliding door module(Right)PSD-LH 30A Power sliding door module(Left)LUGGAGE 7.5A Step lamp, Power tailgate ON/OFF switch, Tailgate lampFUEL DOOR 15A Fuel filler lid relay, Fuel filler lid actuatorRR P/OTLT-LH 15A Rear power outlet(Left)RR P/OTLT-RH 15A Rear power outlet(Right)RR DEFOG RELAY - Rear window defroster relay

Rear cargo area panel

Maintenance

286

Description Fuse rating Protected componentP/TRAIN 7.5A Theft alarm relay, Main relay,

TCM, Generator, ECM, Injector15A, ECU 2 15A, ECU 1 10A,Air conditioner compressor relay,Inlet metering valve, EGR sole-noid valve, Air flow sensor, Diesel box, Immobilizer module

FUEL PUMP 15A Fuel pump motorSP 7.5A Spare fuseSP 10A Spare fuseSP 15A Spare fuseSP 20A Spare fuseSP 25A Spare fuseABS 1 40A ABS control module,

ESC control moduleABS 2 20A ABS control module,

ESC control moduleFRT WIPER 30A Front wiper ON relayKEY SW 2 30A Start relay, IG2 Load(Variable

rack stroke, ECM mirror, Rainsensor, Seat warmer)

RAM 1 50A Rear area moduleRAM 2 50A Rear area moduleRAM 3 50A Rear area module

Engine compartment

Description Fuse rating Protected componentFRT/RR WASHER 10A Front washer motor relay,

Rear washer motor relayIG 2 7.5A Fuel filterSTOP LAMP 20A Stop lamp,

High mounted stop lampFUEL HEATER 20A Fuel filter heaterKEY SW 1 25A Instrument panel moduleSTOP SIGNAL 7.5A TCU, PCU/ECU, ABS/ESC UnitA/C COMP 7.5A Air conditioner compressor relayATM 15A ATM solenoidFRT DEICER 15A Front deicerHORN 15A Horn relayECU 1 10A PCU/ECU, A/C comp relay, Mass

air flow sensor, Immobilizer unitO2 DN 10A O2 sensor(RL, RR)ECU 2 15A PCU/ECU, Oil control valve 1/2,

Variable intake manifold valve 1/2,Canister purge solenoid valve,Canister close valve, Pulse width modulation relay

O2 UP 10A O2 sensor(FL, FR)IGN COIL 20A Ignition coil 1/2/3/4/5/6, CondensorINJECTOR 15A PCU/ECU, Injector 1/2/3/4/5/6,

Glow relay 1/2, Intake manifoldvalve, EGR Solenoid valve,Cooling fan relay, Air flow sen-sor, Intake throttle valve

6 29

Maintenance

Description Fuse rating Protected componentIPM 1 50A Instrument panel moduleIPM 2 50A Instrument panel moduleIPM 3 50A Instrument panel moduleFRT BLOWER 40A Inside relay box(Front blower

relay)RR BLOWER 30A Inside relay box(Rear blower

relay)IG 2 RELAY - Ignition relayA/C COMP RELAY - Air conditioner compressor relayMAIN RELAY - Main relaySTART RELAY - Start relayFUEL PUMP RELAY - Fuel pump relay

Engine compartment (main fuse)

Description Fuse rating Protected componentALT 150A/200A GeneratorC/FAN 60A Cooling fan

Maintenance

306

OVQ066018N

Shunt connector Your vehicle is equipped with a shuntconnector to prevent battery discharge ifyour vehicle is parked without beingoperated for prolonged periods. Use thefollowing procedures before parking thevehicle for prolonged periods.

1. Turn off the engine.2. Turn off the headlights and tail lights.3. Open the driver’s side panel cover and

pull up the shunt connector.

✽✽ NOTICE• If the shunt connector is pulled up

from the fuse panel, the warningchime, audio, clock and interiorlamps, etc., will not operate. Someitems must be rest after replacement.

• Even though the shunt connector ispulled up, the battery can still be dis-charged by operation of the head-lights or other electrical devices.

1VQA4005

Shunt connector

BATTERY

WARNING - Battery dangers

Always read the followinginstructions carefully whenhandling a battery.

Keep lighted cigarettes andall other flames or sparksaway from the battery.

Hydrogen, a highly com-bustible gas, is alwayspresent in battery cells andmay explode if ignited.

(Continued)

6 31

Maintenance

For best battery service:• Keep the battery securely mounted.• Keep the battery top clean and dry.• Keep the terminals and connections

clean, tight, and coated with petroleumjelly or terminal grease.

• Rinse any spilled electrolyte from thebattery immediately with a solution ofwater and baking soda.

• If the vehicle is not going to be used foran extended time, disconnect the bat-tery cables.

Battery recharging Your vehicle has a maintenance-free,calcium-based battery.• If the battery becomes discharged in a

short time (because, for example, theheadlights or interior lights were left onwhile the vehicle was not in use),recharge it by slow charging (trickle)for 10 hours.

(Continued)

Keep batteries out of thereach of children becausebatteries contain highlycorrosive SULFURIC ACID.Do not allow battery acid tocontact your skin, eyes,clothing or paint finish.If any electrolyte gets intoyour eyes, flush your eyeswith clean water for at least15 minutes and get immedi-ate medical attention. Ifpossible, continue to applywater with a sponge orcloth until medical attentionis received. If electrolytegets on your skin, thor-oughly wash the contactedarea. If you feel a pain or aburning sensation, get med-ical attention immediately.Wear eye protection whencharging or working near abattery. Always provideventilation when working inan enclosed space.

(Continued)

(Continued)An inappropriately dis-posed battery can be harm-ful to the environment andhuman health. Dispose thebattery according to yourlocal law(s) or regulation.

• When lifting a plastic-cased bat-tery, excessive pressure on thecase may cause battery acid toleak, resulting in personal injury.Lift with a battery carrier or withyour hands on opposite corners.

• Never attempt to recharge thebattery when the battery cablesare connected.

• The electrical ignition systemworks with high voltage. Nevertouch these components with theengine running or the ignitionswitched on.

Failure to follow the above warn-ings can result in serious bodilyinjury or death.

CAUTIONIf you connect unauthorized elec-tronic devices to the battery, thebattery may be discharged. Neveruse unauthorized devices.

Maintenance

326

• If the battery gradually dischargesbecause of high electric load while thevehicle is being used, recharge it at 20-30A for two hours.

Items to be reset after the batteryhas been discharged or the bat-tery has been disconnected.• Clock (See Chapter 3)• Sunroof (See Chapter 3)• Trip computer (See Chapter 3)• Climate control system (See Chapter

3)• Audio (See Chapter 3)• Power sliding door and power tailgate

(See Chapter 3)

Tire care For proper maintenance, safety, andmaximum fuel economy, you mustalways maintain recommended tireinflation pressures and stay withinthe load limits and weight distributionrecommended for your vehicle.

Recommended cold tire inflationpressures All tire pressures (including thespare) should be checked every daywhen the tires are cold. “Cold Tires”means the vehicle has not been driv-en for at least three hours or drivenless than 1.6 km (one mile).Recommended pressures must bemaintained for the best ride, top vehi-cle handling, and minimum tire wear.

CAUTION• Before performing maintenance

or recharging the battery, turn offall accessories and stop theengine.

• The negative battery cable mustbe removed first and installed lastwhen the battery is disconnected.

WARNING - Rechargingbattery

When recharging the battery,observe the following precautions:• The battery must be removed

from the vehicle and placed in anarea with good ventilation.

• Do not allow cigarettes, sparks, orflame near the battery.

(Continued)

(Continued)

• Watch the battery during charg-ing, and stop or reduce the charg-ing rate if the battery cells begingassing (boiling) violently or ifthe temperature of the electrolyteof any cell exceeds 49°C (120°F).

• Wear eye protection when check-ing the battery during charging.

• Disconnect the battery charger inthe following order.

1. Turn off the battery charger mainswitch.

2. Unhook the negative clamp fromthe negative battery terminal.

3. Unhook the positive clamp fromthe positive battery terminal.

TIRES AND WHEELS

6 33

Maintenance

All specifications (sizes and pres-sures) can be found on a labelattached to the vehicle.

WARNING - Tire underin-flation

Severe underinflation (70 kPa(10 psi) or more) can lead tosevere heat build-up, causingblowouts, tread separation andother tire failures that can resultin the loss of vehicle controlleading to severe injury ordeath. This risk is much higheron hot days and when drivingfor protracted periods at highspeeds.

OVQ066022N

CAUTION• Underinflation also results in

excessive wear, poor handlingand reduced fuel economy.Wheel deformation also ispossible. Keep your tire pres-sures at the proper levels. If atire frequently needs refilling,have it checked by anAuthorized Kia Dealer.

(Continued)

OVQ051100/OVQ051101

Maintenance

346

Checking tire inflation pressureCheck your tires once a month ormore.Also, check the tire pressure of thespare tire.

How to checkUse a good quality gage to check tirepressure.You can not tell if your tiresare properly inflated simply by look-ing at them. Radial tires may lookproperly inflated even when they'reunderinflated.Check the tire's inflation pressurewhen the tires are cold. - "Cold"means your vehicle has been sittingfor at least three hours or driven nomore than 1.6 km (1 mile).

WARNING - Tire InflationOverinflation or underinflationcan reduce tire life, adverselyaffect vehicle handling, and leadto sudden tire failure.This couldresult in loss of vehicle controland potential injury.

CAUTION - Tire pressureAlways observe the following:• Check tire pressure when the

tires are cold. (After vehiclehas been parked for at leastthree hours or hasn't beendriven more than 1.6 km (onemile) since startup.)

• Check the pressure of yourspare tire each time you checkthe pressure of other tires.

• Never overload your vehicle.Be careful not to overload avehicle luggage rack if yourvehicle is equipped with one.

• Worn, old tires can cause acci-dents. If your tread is badlyworn, or if your tires havebeen damaged, replace them.

CAUTION• Warm tires normally exceed

recommended cold tire pres-sures by 28 to 41 kPa (4 to 6psi). Do not release air fromwarm tires to adjust the pres-sure or the tires will be under-inflated.

• Be sure to reinstall the tireinflation valve caps. Withoutthe valve cap, dirt or moisturecould get into the valve coreand cause air leakage. If avalve cap is missing, install anew one as soon as possible.

(Continued)• Overinflation produces a

harsh ride, excessive wear atthe center of the tire tread, anda greater possibility of dam-age from road hazards.

6 35

Maintenance

Remove the valve cap from the tirevalve stem. Press the tire gage firm-ly onto the valve to get a pressuremeasurement. If the cold tire inflationpressure matches the recommendedpressure on the tire and loadinginformation label, no further adjust-ment is necessary. If the pressure islow, add air until you reach the rec-ommended amount.If you overfill the tire, release air bypushing on the metal stem in thecenter of the tire valve. Recheck thetire pressure with the tire gage. Besure to put the valve caps back onthe valve stems. They help preventleaks by keeping out dirt and mois-ture.

Tire rotation To equalize tread wear, it is recom-mended that the tires be rotatedevery 12,000 km (7,500 miles) orsooner if irregular wear develops.During rotation, check the tires forcorrect balance.When rotating tires, check for unevenwear and damage. Abnormal wear isusually caused by incorrect tire pres-sure, improper wheel alignment, out-of-balance wheels, severe braking orsevere cornering. Look for bumps orbulges in the tread or side of tire.Replace the tire if you find either ofthese conditions. Replace the tire iffabric or cord is visible. After rotation,be sure to bring the front and rear tirepressures to specification and checklug nut tightness.Refer to Section 7, Specifications.

S2BLA790

S2BLA790A

CBGQ0707A

Without a spare tire

With a full-size spare tire (if equipped)

Directional tires (if equipped)

Maintenance

366

Disc brake pads should be inspectedfor wear whenever tires are rotated.Rotate radial tires that have anasymmetric tread pattern onlyfrom front to rear and not fromright to left.

Tire replacementIf the tire is worn evenly, a tread wearindicator will appear as a solid bandacross the tread. This shows there isless than 1.6 mm (1/16 inch) of treadleft on the tire. Replace the tire whenthis happens.Do not wait for the band to appearacross the entire tread before replac-ing the tire.

Compact spare tire replacementA compact spare tire has a shortertread life than a regular size tire.Replace it when you can see thetread wear indicator bars on the tire.The replacement compact spare tireshould be the same size and designtire as the one provided with yournew Kia and should be mounted onthe same compact spare tire wheel.The compact spare tire is notdesigned to be mounted on a regularsize wheel, and the compact sparetire wheel is not designed for mount-ing a regular size tire.

WARNING• Do not use the compact spare

tire for tire rotation• Do not mix bias ply and radial

ply tires under any circum-stances. This may causeunusual handling characteris-tics that could result in death,severe injury, or propertydamage.

1LDA5026

Tread wear indicator WARNINGThe ABS works by comparingthe speed of the wheels.Tire sizecan affect wheel speed. Whenreplacing tires, all 4 tires mustuse the same size originally sup-plied with the vehicle. Using tiresof a different size can cause theABS (Anti-lock Brake System)and ESC (Electronic StabilityControl) to work irregularly.

6 37

Maintenance

Wheel replacement When replacing the metal wheels forany reason, make sure the newwheels are equivalent to the originalfactory units in diameter, rim widthand offset.

Wheel alignment and tire balance The wheels on your vehicle werealigned and balanced carefully at thefactory to give you the longest tire lifeand best overall performance.In most cases, you will not need tohave your wheels aligned again.

However, if you notice unusual tirewear or your vehicle pulling one wayor the other, the alignment may needto be reset.If you notice your vehicle vibratingwhen driving on a smooth road, yourwheels may need to be rebalanced.

WARNINGA wheel that is not the correctsize may adversely affect wheeland bearing life, braking andstopping abilities, handling char-acteristics, ground clearance,body-to-tire clearance, snowchain clearance, speedometercalibration, headlight aim andbumper height.

WARNING - Replacingtires

• Driving on worn-out tires isvery hazardous and will reducebraking effectiveness, steeringaccuracy, and traction.

• Your vehicle is equipped withtires designed to provide forsafe ride and handling capa-bility.

(Continued)

(Continued)Do not use a size and type oftire and wheel that is differentfrom the one that is originallyinstalled on your vehicle. It canaffect the safety and perform-ance of your vehicle, whichcould lead to handling failureor rollover and serious injury.When replacing the tires, besure to equip all four tires withthe tire and wheel of the samesize, type, tread, brand andload-carrying capacity.

• The use of any other tire sizeor type may seriously affectride, handling, ground clear-ance, stopping distance, bodyto tire clearance, snow tireclearance, and speedometerreliability.

• It is best to replace all four tiresat the same time. If that is notpossible, or necessary, thenreplace the two front or tworear tires as a pair. Replacingjust one tire can seriouslyaffect your vehicle’s handling.

CAUTIONImproper wheel weights candamage your vehicle's alu-minum wheels. Use onlyapproved wheel weights.

aaa

Maintenance

386

Tire tractionTire traction can be reduced if youdrive on worn tires, tires that areimproperly inflated or on slipperyroad surfaces. Tires should bereplaced when tread wear indicatorsappear. To reduce the possibility oflosing control, slow down wheneverthere is rain, snow or ice on the road.

Tire maintenance In addition to proper inflation, correctwheel alignment helps to decreasetire wear. If you find a tire is wornunevenly, have your dealer check thewheel alignement.When you have new tires installed,make sure they are balanced. Thiswill increase vehicle ride comfort andtire life. Additionally, a tire shouldalways be rebalanced if it is removedfrom the wheel.

Tire sidewall labelingFederal law requires tire manufactur-ers to place standardized informationon the sidewall of all tires. This infor-mation identifies and describes thefundamental characteristics of thetire and also provides the tire identifi-cation number (TIN) for safety stan-dard certification. The TIN can beused to identify the tire in case of arecall.

1. Manufacturer or brand nameManufacturer or Brand name isshown.

2. Tire size designation A tire’s sidewall is marked with a tiresize designation. You will need thisinformation when selecting replace-ment tires for your car. The followingexplains what the letters and num-bers in the tire size designationmean.Example tire size designation:(These numbers are provided as anexample only; your tire size designa-tor could vary depending on yourvehicle.)P185/65R14 86H

P - Applicable vehicle type (tiresmarked with the prefix “P’’ areintended for use on passengercars or light trucks; however, notall tires have this marking).

185 - Tire width in millimeters.65 - Aspect ratio. The tire’s section

height as a percentage of itswidth.

R - Tire construction code (Radial).14 - Rim diameter in inches.

I030B04JM

1

1

23

4

5,6

7

6 39

Maintenance

86 - Load Index, a numerical codeassociated with the maximumload the tire can carry.

H - Speed Rating Symbol. See thespeed rating chart in this sectionfor additional information.

Wheel size designation Wheels are also marked with impor-tant information that you need if youever have to replace one. The follow-ing explains what the letters andnumbers in the wheel size designa-tion mean.

Example wheel size designation:5.5JX14

5.5 - Rim width in inches.J - Rim contour designation.14 - Rim diameter in inches.

Tire speed ratings The chart below lists many of the dif-ferent speed ratings currently beingused for passenger cars. The speedrating is part of the tire size designa-tion on the sidewall of the tire. Thissymbol corresponds to that tire'sdesigned maximum safe operatingspeed.

3. Checking tire life (TIN : TireIdentification Number)

Any tires that are over 6 years, basedon the manufacturing date, tirestrength and performance, declinewith age naturally (even unusedspare tires). Therefore, the tires(including the spare tire) should bereplaced by new ones. You can findthe manufacturing date on the tiresidewall (possibly on the inside of thewheel), displaying the DOT Code.The DOT Code is a series of num-bers on a tire consisting of numbersand English letters. The manufactur-ing date is designated by the last fourdigits (characters) of the DOT code.

DOT : XXXX XXXX OOOOThe front part of the DOT means aplant code number, tire size andtread pattern and the last four num-bers indicate week and year manu-factured.For example:DOT XXXX XXXX 1611 representsthat the tire was produced in the 16thweek of 2011.

S 180 km/h (112 mph)T 190 km/h (118 mph)H 210 km/h (130 mph)V 240 km/h (149 mph)Z Above 240 km/h (149 mph)

Maximum SpeedSpeedRatingSymbol

Maintenance

406

4. Tire ply composition and materialThe number of layers or plies of rub-ber-coated fabric in the tire. Tiremanufacturers also must indicate thematerials in the tire, which includesteel, nylon, polyester, and others.The letter "R" means radial ply con-struction; the letter "D" means diago-nal or bias ply construction; and theletter "B" means belted-bias ply con-struction.

5. Maximum permissible inflationpressure

This number is the greatest amountof air pressure that should be put inthe tire. Do not exceed the maximumpermissible inflation pressure. Referto the Tire and Loading Informationlabel for recommended inflationpressure.

6. Maximum load ratingThis number indicates the maximumload in kilograms and pounds thatcan be carried by the tire. Whenreplacing the tires on the vehicle,always use a tire that has the sameload rating as the factory installedtire.

7. Uniform tire quality grading Quality grades can be found whereapplicable on the tire sidewallbetween tread shoulder and maxi-mum section width.For example:TREADWEAR 200 TRACTION AA TEMPERATURE A

Tread wearThe tread wear grade is a compara-tive rating based on the wear rate ofthe tire when tested under controlledconditions on a specified govern-ment test course. For example, a tiregraded 150 would wear one-and-a-half times as well on the governmentcourse as a tire graded 100.The relative performance of tiresdepends upon the actual conditionsof their use. However, performancemay differ from the norm because ofvariations in driving habits, servicepractices and differences in roadcharacteristics and climate.These grades are molded on theside-walls of passenger vehicle tires.The tires available as standard oroptional equipment on Kia vehiclesmay vary with respect to grade.

WARNING - Tire ageTires degrade over time, evenwhen they are not being used.Regardless of the remainingtread, it is recommended thattires generally be replaced aftersix (6) years of normal service.Heat caused by hot climates orfrequent high loading conditionscan accelerate the agingprocess. Failure to follow thiswarning can result in sudden tirefailure, which could lead to aloss of control and an accidentinvolving serious injury or death.

6 41

Maintenance

Traction - AA, A, B & C The traction grades, from highest tolowest, are AA, A, B and C. Thegrades represent the tires ability tostop on wet pavement as measuredunder controlled conditions on spec-ified government test surfaces ofasphalt and concrete. A tire markedC may have poor traction perform-ance.Temperature -A, B & C The temperature grades are A (thehighest), B and C. The grades repre-sent the tire’s resistance to the gen-eration of heat and its ability to dissi-pate heat when tested under con-trolled conditions on a specifiedindoor laboratory test wheel.Sustained high temperature cancause the material of the tires todegenerate and reduce tires life, andexcessive temperature can lead tosudden tires failure. Grades A and Brepresent higher levels of perform-ance on the laboratory test wheel thanthe minimum required by the law.

Tire terminology and definitionsAir Pressure: The amount of airinside the tire pressing outward onthe tire. Air pressure is expressed inkilopascal (kPa) or pounds persquare inch (psi).Accessory Weight: This means thecombined weight of optional acces-sories. Some examples of optionalaccessories are, automatic transmis-sion, power seats, and air condition-ing.Aspect Ratio: The relationship of atire's height to its width.Belt: A rubber coated layer of cordsthat is located between the plies andthe tread. Cords may be made fromsteel or other reinforcing materials.Bead: The tire bead contains steelwires wrapped by steel cords thathold the tire onto the rim.Bias Ply Tire: A pneumatic tire inwhich the plies are laid at alternateangles less than 90 degrees to thecenterline of the tread.

WARNING - Tire temperature

The temperature grade for thistire is established for a tire thatis properly inflated and notoverloaded. Excessive speed,underinflation, or excessiveloading, either separately or incombination, can cause heatbuild-up and possible suddentire failure. This can cause lossof vehicle control and seriousinjury or death.

Maintenance

426

Cold Tire Pressure: The amount ofair pressure in a tire, measured inkilopascals (kPa) or pounds persquare inch (psi) before a tire hasbuilt up heat from driving.Curb Weight: This means the weightof a motor vehicle with standard andoptional equipment including themaximum capacity of fuel, oil andcoolant, but without passengers andcargo.DOT Markings: The DOT codeincludes the Tire IdentificationNumber (TIN), an alphanumeric des-ignator which can also identify thetire manufacturer, production plant,brand and date of production.GVWR: Gross Vehicle Weight RatingGAWR FRT: Gross Axle WeightRating for the front Axle.GAWR RR: Gross Axle WeightRating for the rear axle.

Intended Outboard Sidewall: Theside of an asymmetrical tire, thatmust always face outward whenmounted on a vehicle.Kilopascal (kPa): The metric unit forair pressure.Load Index: An assigned numberranging from 1 to 279 that corre-sponds to the load carrying capacityof a tire.Maximum Inflation Pressure: Themaximum air pressure to which acold tire may be inflated. The maxi-mum air pressure is molded onto thesidewall.Maximum Load Rating: The loadrating for a tire at the maximum per-missible inflation pressure for thattire.Maximum Loaded Vehicle Weight:The sum of curb weight; accessoryweight; vehicle capacity weight; andproduction options weight.Normal Occupant Weight: Thenumber of occupants a vehicle isdesigned to seat multiplied by 68 kg(150 pounds).

Occupant Distribution: Designatedseating positions.Outward Facing Sidewall: The sideof a asymmetrical tire that has a par-ticular side that faces outward whenmounted on a vehicle. The outwardfacing sidewall bears white letteringor bears manufacturer, brand, and/ormodel name molding that is higher ordeeper than the same moldings onthe inner facing sidewall.Passenger (P-Metric) Tire: A tireused on passenger cars and somelight duty trucks and multipurposevehicles.Recommended Inflation Pressure:Vehicle manufacturer's recommend-ed tire inflation pressure and shownon the tire placard.Radial Ply tire: A pneumatic tire inwhich the ply cords that extend to thebeads are laid at 90 degrees to thecenterline of the tread.Rim: A metal support for a tire andupon which the tire beads are seat-ed.Sidewall: The portion of a tirebetween the tread and the bead.

6 43

Maintenance

Speed Rating: An alphanumericcode assigned to a tire indicating themaximum speed at which a tire canoperate.Traction: The friction between thetire and the road surface. Theamount of grip provided.Tread: The portion of a tire thatcomes into contact with the road.Treadwear Indicators: Narrowbands, sometimes called "wearbars," that show across the tread of atire when only 2/32 inch of treadremains.UTQGS: Uniform Tire QualityGrading Standards, a tire informationsystem that provides consumers withratings for a tire's traction, tempera-ture and treadwear. Ratings aredetermined by tire manufacturersusing government testing proce-dures. The ratings are molded intothe sidewall of the tire.Vehicle Capacity Weight: The num-ber of designated seating positionsmultiplied by 68 kg (150 lbs.) plus therated cargo and luggage load.

Vehicle Maximum Load on theTire: Load on an individual tire due tocurb and accessory weight plusmaximum occupant and cargoweight.Vehicle Normal Load on the Tire:That load on an individual tire that isdetermined by distributing to eachaxle its share of the curb weight,accessory weight, and normal occu-pant weight and driving by 2.Vehicle Placard: A label permanent-ly attached to a vehicle showing theoriginal equipment tire size and rec-ommended inflation pressure.

All season tires Kia specifies all season tires onsome models to provide good per-formance for use all year round,including snowy and icy road condi-tions. All season tires are identifiedby ALL SEASON and/or M+S (Mudand Snow) on the tire sidewall. Snowtires have better snow traction thanall season tires and may be moreappropriate in some areas.

Summer tires Kia specifies summer tires on somemodels to provide superior perform-ance on dry roads. Summer tire per-formance is substantially reduced insnow and ice. Summer tires do nothave the tire traction rating M+S(Mud and Snow) on the tire side wall.if you plan to operate your vehicle insnowy or icy conditions. Kia recom-mends the use of snow tires or allseason tires on all four wheels.

Snow tiresIf you equip your car with snow tires,they should be the same size andhave the same load capacity as theoriginal tires. Snow tires should beinstalled on all four wheels; other-wise, poor handling may result.Snow tires should carry 28 kPa (4psi) more air pressure than the pres-sure recommended for the standardtires on the tire label on the driver'sside of the center pillar, or up to themaximum pressure shown on the tiresidewall, whichever is less.Do not drive faster than 120 km/h (75mph) when your car is equipped withsnow tires.

Maintenance

446

LUBRICANTRecommended lubricants To help achieve proper engine and powertrain performance anddurability, use only lubricants of the proper quality. The correctlubricants also help promote engine efficiency that results inimproved fuel economy.Engine oils labeled Energy Conserving Oil are now available.Along with other additional benefits, they contribute to fueleconomy by reducing the amount of fuel necessary to over-come engine friction. Often, these improvements are difficult tomeasure in everyday driving, but in a year’s time, they can offersignificant cost and energy savings.

*1 Refer to the recommended SAE viscosity numbers.

*2 If the API service SM engine oil is not available in your country, you are able touse API service SL.

These lubricants and fluids are recommended for use in yourvehicle.

Lubricant Classification

Engine oil *¹(drain and refill)

API Service SM*2,ILSAC GF-4 or above

Automatic transaxle fluid

MICHANG ATF SP-IVSK ATF SP-IVNOCA ATF SP-IVKIA genuine ATF SP-IV or otherbrands meeting the above specifica-tion approved by Kia motors corp.

Power steering fluid PSF-III

Brake fluid FMVSS116 DOT-3 or DOT-4

6 45

Maintenance

Recommended SAE viscositynumber

CAUTIONAlways be sure to clean the areaaround any filler plug, drain plug, ordipstick before checking or drain-ing any lubricant. This is especiallyimportant in dusty or sandy areasand when the vehicle is used onunpaved roads. Cleaning the plugand dipstick areas will prevent dirtand grit from entering the engineand other mechanisms that couldbe damaged.

Temperature Range for SAE Viscosity Numbers

Temperature

Engine Oil *1

°C(°F)

-30 -20 -10 0 10 20 30 40 50-10 0 20 40 60 80 100 120

10W-30

5W-20, (5W-30)

*1 For better fuel economy, it is recommended to use the engine oil of a viscosi-ty grade SAE 5W-20 (API SM / ILSAC GF-4). However, if the engine oil is notavailable in your country, select the proper engine oil using the engine oil vis-cosity chart.

Engine oil viscosity (thickness) has an effect on fuel economy and cold weather oper-ating (starting and oil flow). Lower viscosity engine oils can provide better fuel econ-omy and cold weather performance, however, higher viscosity engine oils arerequired for satisfactory lubrication in hot weather. Using oils of any viscosity otherthan those recommended could result in engine damage.When choosing an oil, consider the range of temperature your vehicle will be operat-ed in before the next oil change. Proceed to select the recommended oil viscosity fromthe chart.

Maintenance

466

APPEARANCE CAREExterior care Exterior general caution It is very important to follow the labeldirections when using any chemicalcleaner or polish. Read all warning andcaution statements that appear on thelabel.

Finish maintenanceWashing To help protect your vehicle’s finish fromrust and deterioration, wash it thoroughlyand frequently at least once a month withlukewarm or cold water.If you use your vehicle for off-road driv-ing, you should wash it after each off-road trip. Pay special attention to theremoval of any accumulation of salt, dirt,mud, and other foreign materials. Makesure the drain holes in the lower edges ofthe doors and rocker panels are keptclear and clean.

Insects, tar, tree sap, bird droppings,industrial pollution and similar depositscan damage your vehicle’s finish if notremoved immediately.Even prompt washing with plain watermay not completely remove all thesedeposits. A mild soap, safe for use onpainted surfaces, may be used.After washing, rinse the vehicle thor-oughly with lukewarm or cold water. Donot allow soap to dry on the finish.

WARNING - Wet brakesAfter washing the vehicle, test thebrakes while driving slowly to see ifthey have been affected by water. Ifbraking performance is impaired,dry the brakes by applying themlightly while maintaining a slow for-ward speed.

CAUTION• Do not use strong soap, chemical

detergents or hot water, and donot wash the vehicle in directsunlight or when the body of thevehicle is warm.

• Do not wash the side windowstoo close with high pressurewater. Water may leak through thewindows and wet the interior.

• To prevent damage to the plasticparts and lamps, do not cleanwith chemical solvents or strongdetergents.

6 47

Maintenance

WaxingWax the vehicle when water will nolonger bead on the paint.Always wash and dry the vehicle beforewaxing. Use a good quality liquid orpaste wax, and follow the manufacturer’sinstructions. Wax all metal trim to protectit and to maintain its luster.Removing oil, tar, and similar materialswith a spot remover will usually strip thewax from the finish. Be sure to re-waxthese areas even if the rest of the vehicledoes not yet need waxing.

Finish damage repair Deep scratches or stone chips in thepainted surface must be repairedpromptly. Exposed metal will quickly rustand may develop into a major repairexpense.

✽✽ NOTICEIf your vehicle is damaged and requiresany metal repair or replacement, be surethe body shop applies anti-corrosionmaterials to the parts repaired orreplaced.

Bright-metal maintenance• To remove road tar and insects, use a

tar remover, not a scraper or othersharp object.

• To protect the surfaces of bright-metalparts from corrosion, apply a coating ofwax or chrome preservative and rub toa high luster.

• During winter weather or in coastalareas, cover the bright metal parts witha heavier coating of wax or preserva-tive. If necessary, coat the parts withnon-corrosive petroleum jelly or otherprotective compound.

CAUTION• Wiping dust or dirt off the body

with a dry cloth will scratch thefinish.

• Do not use steel wool, abrasivecleaners, or strong detergentscontaining highly alkaline orcaustic agents on chrome-platedor anodized aluminum parts. Thismay result in damage to the pro-tective coating and cause discol-oration or paint deterioration.

CAUTION• Water washing in the engine com-

partment including high pressurewater washing may cause the fail-ure of electrical circuits located inthe engine compartment.

• Never allow water or other liquidsto come in contact with electri-cal/electronic components insidethe vehicle as this may damagethem.

OJB037800

Underbody maintenanceCorrosive materials used for ice andsnow removal and dust control may col-lect on the underbody. If these materialsare not removed, accelerated rusting canoccur on underbody parts such as thefuel lines, frame, floor pan and exhaustsystem, even though they have beentreated with rust protection.Thoroughly flush the vehicle underbodyand wheel openings with lukewarm orcold water once a month at the end ofeach winter. Pay special attention tothese areas because it is difficult to seeall the mud and dirt. It will do more harmthan good to wet down the road grimewithout removing it. The lower edges ofdoors, rocker panels, and frame mem-bers have drain holes that should not beallowed to clog with dirt; trapped water inthese areas can cause rusting.

Aluminum wheel maintenance The aluminum wheels are coated with aclear protective finish.• Do not use any abrasive cleaner, pol-

ishing compound, solvent, or wirebrushes on aluminum wheels. Theymay scratch or damage the finish.

• Use only a mild soap or neutral deter-gent, and rinse thoroughly with water.Also, be sure to clean the wheels afterdriving on salted roads. This helps pre-vent corrosion.

• Avoid washing the wheels with high-speed car wash brushes.

• Do not use any acid detergent. It maydamage and corrode the aluminumwheels coated with a clear protectivefinish.

Interior care Interior general precautions Prevent caustic solutions such as per-fume and cosmetic oil from contactingthe dashboard because they may causedamage or discoloration. If they do con-tact the dashboard, wipe them off imme-diately. See the instructions that follow forthe proper way to clean vinyl.

✽✽ NOTICENever allow water or other liquids tocome in contact with electrical/ electron-ic components inside the vehicle as thismay damage them.

CAUTIONWhen cleaning leather products(steering wheel, seats etc.), useneutral detergents or low alcoholcontent solutions. If you use highalcohol content solutions oracid/alkaline detergents, the colorof the leather may fade or the sur-face may get stripped off.

WARNINGAfter washing the vehicle, test thebrakes while driving slowly to see ifthey have been affected by water. Ifbraking performance is impaired,dry the brakes by applying themlightly while maintaining a slow for-ward speed.

6 48

Maintenance

Cleaning the upholstery and interiortrim Vinyl Remove dust and loose dirt from vinylwith a whisk broom or vacuum cleaner.Clean vinyl surfaces with a vinyl cleaner.

Fabric Remove dust and loose dirt from fabricwith a whisk broom or vacuum cleaner.Clean with a mild soap solution recom-mended for upholstery or carpets.Remove fresh spots immediately with afabric spot cleaner. If fresh spots do notreceive immediate attention, the fabriccan be stained and its color can beaffected. Also, its fire-resistant propertiescan be reduced if the material is notproperly maintained.

Cleaning the lap/shoulder belt web-bing Clean the belt webbing with any mildsoap solution recommended for cleaningupholstery or carpet. Follow the instruc-tions provided with the soap. Do notbleach or re-dye the webbing becausethis may weaken it.

Cleaning the interior window glass If the interior glass surfaces of the vehi-cle become fogged (that is, covered withan oily, greasy or waxy film), they shouldbe cleaned with glass cleaner. Follow thedirections on the glass cleaner container.

The emission control system of yourvehicle is covered by a written limitedwarranty. Please see the warranty infor-mation contained in the Warranty &Consumer Information Manual in yourvehicle.

Vehicle modifications • This vehicle should not be modified.

Modification of your Kia could affect itsperformance, safety or durability andmay even violate governmental safetyand emissions regulations.In addition, damage or performanceproblems resulting from any modifica-tion may not be covered under warran-ty.

• If you use unauthorized electronicdevices, it may cause the vehicle tooperate abnormally, wire damage, bat-tery discharge and fire. For your safety,do not use unauthorized electronicdevices.

CAUTIONDo not scrape or scratch the insideof the rear window. This may resultin damage to the rear windowdefroster grid.

EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM

CAUTIONUsing anything but recommendedcleaners and procedures may affectthe fabric’s appearance and fire-resistant properties.

Maintenance

496

Engine exhaust gas precautions(carbon monoxide) • Carbon monoxide can be present with

other exhaust fumes. Therefore, if yousmell exhaust fumes of any kind insideyour vehicle, have it inspected andrepaired immediately. If you ever sus-pect exhaust fumes are coming intoyour vehicle, drive it only with all thewindows fully open. Have your vehiclechecked and repaired immediately.

• Do not operate the engine in confinedor closed areas (such as garages) anymore than what is necessary to movethe vehicle in or out of the area.

• When the vehicle is stopped in anopen area for more than a short timewith the engine running, adjust theventilation system (as needed) to drawoutside air into the vehicle.

• Never sit in a parked or stopped vehi-cle for any extended time with theengine running.

• When the engine stalls or fails to start,excessive attempts to re-start theengine may cause damage to theemission control system.

Operating precautions for catalyt-ic converters (if equipped)

Your vehicle is equipped with a catalyticconverter emission control device.Therefore, the following precautionsmust be observed:• Use only UNLEADED FUEL for gaso-

line engine.• Do not operate the vehicle when there

are signs of engine malfunction, suchas misfire or a noticeable loss of per-formance.

• Do not misuse or abuse the engine.Examples of misuse are coasting withthe ignition off and descending steepgrades in gear with the ignition off.

• Do not operate the engine at high idlespeed for extended periods (5 minutesor more).

• Do not modify or tamper with any partof the engine or emission control sys-tem. All inspections and adjustmentsmust be made by an authorized Kiadealer.

• Avoid driving with a very low fuel level.If you run out of gasoline, it couldcause the engine to misfire and resultin excessive loading of the catalyticconverter.

Failure to observe these precautionscould result in damage to the catalyticconverter and to your vehicle.Additionally, such actions could void yourwarranties.

WARNING - Fire• A hot exhaust system can ignite

flammable items under your vehi-cle. Do not park, idle or drive thevehicle over or near flammableobjects, such as grass, vegeta-tion, paper, leaves, etc.

• The exhaust system and catalyticsystem are very hot while theengine is running or immediatelyafter the engine is turned off. Keepaway from the exhaust system andcatalytic, you may get burned.Also, do not remove the heat sinkaround the exhaust system, donot seal the bottom of the vehicleor do not coat the vehicle for cor-rosion control. It may present afire risk under certain conditions.

WARNING - ExhaustEngine exhaust gases contain car-bon monoxide (CO). Though color-less and odorless, it is dangerousand could be lethal if inhaled.Follow the instructions following toavoid CO poisoning.

6 50

Maintenance

7

Dimensions / 7-2Bulb wattage / 7-2Tires / 7-3Capacities / 7-4

Specifications

Specifications

27

Item mm (in)

Overall length 5130 (202.0)

Overall width 1985 (78.1)*1 / 1940 (76.4)

Overall height 1805 (71.1)*2 / 1760 (69.3)

Front tread 1685 (66.3)

Rear tread 1685 (66.3)

Wheelbase 3020 (118.9)

DIMENSIONS

Light Bulb WattageHeadlights (Low) 55Headlights (High) 55Front turn signal/Position lights 28/8 (Amber)Side mark lights 5Side repeater lights LED*1

Front fog lights 35Stop and tail lights 27/8Rear turn signal lights 27 (Amber)Back-up lights 16High mounted stop light LED*1

License plate lights 5Front map lamps 10Center dome lamps 10Tailgate lamp 10Door courtesy lamps 5Glove box lamp 5Vanity mirror lamps 3

BULB WATTAGE

*1 LED : Light-emitting diode

*1 With door handle *2 With roof rack

7 3

Specifications

Inflation pressure

kPa (psi)

Front Rear

225/70R16 6.5J×16 240 240

235/60R17 6.5J×17 (35) (35)

T135/90R17 4.0T×17420 420

(60) (60)

Full size tire

Compactspare tire

Wheel lug nut torque kg•m

(N•m, lb•ft)

9~11

(88~107, 65~79)

TIRES

ItemTire

sizeWheel size

Specifications

47

CAPACITIES

Lubricant Volume Classification

5.5 l (5.81 US qt.)

MICHANG ATF SP-IV, SK ATF SP-IV

Automatic transaxle fluid 7.8 l (8.24 US qt.) NOCA ATF SP-IV, KIA genuine ATF SP-IV or other brands

meeting the above specification approved by Kia motors corp.

Power steering 1.0 l (1.06 US qt.) PSF-III

Coolant 8.6 l (9.09 US qt.) Ethylene glycol base for aluminum radiator

Brake fluid0.7~0.8 l

FMVSS116 DOT-3 or DOT-4(0.7~0.8 US qt.)

Fuel 75 l (19.8 US gal.) -

Engine oil *1

(drain and refill)Recommended(or equivalent)

API Service SM*2, ILSAC GF-4 or above

*1 Refer to the recommended SAE viscosity numbers on the page 6-45.

*2 If the API service SM engine oil is not available in your country, you are able to use API service SL.